Path: ns-mx!hobbes.physics.uiowa.edu!zaphod.mps.ohio-state.edu!mips!spool.mu.edu!olivea!sgigate!odin!ratmandu.esd.sgi.com!dave
From: [email protected] (dave "who can do? ratmandu!" ratcliffe)
Newsgroups: alt.activism,alt.conspiracy.jfk,alt.conspiracy
Subject: Book Intro:  "The Taking Of America, 1-2-3"
Summary: we were robbed of our capability of electing a president we wanted
Keywords: our electoral system was taken away from us starting in 1963
Message-ID: <[email protected]>
Date: 4 Jun 92 22:37:39 GMT
Sender: [email protected] (Net News)
Organization: Silicon Graphics, Inc.
Lines: 244
Xref: ns-mx alt.activism:27137 alt.conspiracy.jfk:1493 alt.conspiracy:15372
Nntp-Posting-Host: ratmandu.esd.sgi.com


    This is an introduction to the book "The Taking of America, 1-2-3,"
    by Richard E. Sprague, self-published by the author first in 1976,
    revised in 1979, and updated in 1985.  There will be eleven posts
    following this one that will comprise the complete 1985 updated
    third edition which I will be sending out with the permission of
    the author.  From the book's own introduction,

          This book is not about assassinations, at least not
       solely about assassinations.  It is not just another book
       about who murdered President Kennedy or how or why.  It is a
       book about power, about who really controls the United
       States policies, especially foreign policies.  It is a book
       about the process of control through the manipulation of the
       American presidency and the presidential election process.
       The objective of the book is to expose the clandestine,
       secret, tricky methods and weapons used for this
       manipulation, and to reveal the degree to which these have
       been hidden from the American public.
          Assassinations are only one of many techniques used in
       this control process.  They have been important only in the
       sense that they are the ultimate method used in the control
       of the election process.  Viewed in this way, an
       understanding of what happened to John or Robert Kennedy
       becomes more important because it leads to a total
       understanding of what has happened to our country, and to
       us, since 1960.  But the important thing to understand is
       the control and the power and all of the clandestine methods
       put together.


    Two men named Richard Sprague have been involved in examining the
    assassination of John F. Kennedy and its ensuing cover-up through the
    years.  Richard A. Sprague, the former district attorney from
    Philadelphia, and the fearless prosecutor of the Yablonski murderers,
    was named on October 4, 1976, by Congressperson Thomas Downing, to be
    chief counsel of the just-then forming House Select Committee on
    Assassinations.  Richard E. Sprague was a pioneer in the field of
    computers starting in the 1940s.  His involvement studying the
    photographic evidence in the assassination of President Kennedy goes
    back to 1966:

          From the day it happened I was skeptical about what was
       being said on the TV and radio with regard to how the
       president was killed.  But when the "Warren Report" was
       issued I became non-skeptical and accepted it pretty much as
       it was.  However, when the 26 volumes became available in
       late 1964 and I started reading through them, I became
       skeptical again because I could not find confirmation of
       most of the so-called facts presented by the "Warren Report"
       and purported to be backed up by the evidence in the 26
       volumes, or any other evidence.
          So I started work again, which caused me to need an index
       to the 26 volumes.  This in turn lead to my contacting
       Sylvia Meagher and asking where I could get her index having
       discovered that she had created and published one that the
       Warren Commission hadn't seen fit to provide.  She told me
       where I could get it and suggested we have lunch.  This was
       in early November, 1966.  She asked, "Why don't you do some
       real research?" and I said, "like what?" and she responded
       "how about the photographic evidence?  A couple of people
       have started work on it but haven't finished."  I asked her
       who and she said "Harold Weisberg and Ray Marcus."  I
       contacted both men and that's more or less how I stuck my
       foot in the quicksand.
          At the time the 26 volumes became available there were
       only 8,000 copies printed for the whole country.  The time I
       managed to get hold of one of these sets of all 26 volumes
       was when I had moved to the University Club in New York City
       and they had a complete set donated to the University Club
       by non other than John J. McCloy.  So I was using John J.
       McCloy's personal copies for the beginnings of my research.
          Now, the most important thing initially that happened in
       finding the photos was discovering a number of photographs-
       -films and still photos--that showed the sixth floor window
       empty with nobody in it.  This is what originally convinced
       me that we had a different sort of conspiracy going than one
       involving Lee Harvey Oswald, because if he wasn't in the
       window--and nobody was in the window--then what happened?
       Who fired the shots?  And where from?
          Confirming that the films and photographs I was looking
       at were taken at the critical time the shots were fired, or
       immediately before or after that, involved a lot of work:
       work with plat maps, other photos, and other materials.  I
       got hold of a map made by the surveyor for Dealey Plaza (I
       believe his name was Clarence West) which was drawn to
       scale, and Bob Cutler helped me draw onto it all of the
       various things that happened including all the vehicles that
       were moving through.  And I managed to lay a set of films
       end-to-end starting with one rounding the turn onto Houston
       Street all the way through Dealey Plaza so I could track any
       vehicle that was in view eighteenth-of-a-second by
       eighteenth-of-a-second (Zapruder film speed) all the way
       through Dealey Plaza.  This enabled me to determine where
       Kennedy was at all times and where anybody else was that
       showed up in any of the photos--particularly moving
       pictures--at times Kennedy was at spot so-and-so or spot
       such-and-such.
          By doing this, with some triangulation, I was able to pin
       down the exact timing of two particular sets of photos:  a
       film--the Hughes film--the last frame of which shows the
       sixth floor window empty and ends 5.7 seconds ahead of the
       first shot--the first shot being fired/tied down at frame
       189 of the Zapruder film;  and two photos taken after the
       shots were fired by Dillard and, believe it or not, an
       intelligence man from Navy intelligence named Powell.
       Powell's and Dillard's photos were taken almost at the same
       time, 3.5 seconds after the fatal and last shot (Z-313).
          So that total time span is less than 17 seconds--if you
       add up the 5.7 seconds after the end of the Hughes film,
       plus the 6-plus seconds while the shots were being fired,
       plus the 3.5 seconds before Dillard and Powell's photos were
       taken--of blank, non-coverage of that window and there's no
       way Oswald could have gotten into the window, aimed, fired
       three shots, and gotten out of the window so you that
       couldn't see him in 17 seconds.
          But anyway there was another film taken by Beverly Oliver
       otherwise known as the Babushka lady that was confiscated by
       News Orleans FBI agent Regis Kennedy, and a still photograph
       taken by Norman Similas, confiscated by the Royal Canadian
       Mounted Police from "Liberty" magazine (which was going to
       publish the photo), who then turned the photo and its
       negative over to the FBI.  I interviewed Similas and the
       "Liberty" magazine editor both of whom told me they had
       carefully examined the photograph and had seen no one in the
       photograph appearing in the eastern-most sixth floor window,
       which I calculated had been taken about half-way into the
       17-second interval.
          I made two attempts soon after the Freedom of Information
       Act "viewing room" in the FBI office in Washington, D.C. was
       created, to request to see the Similas photograph and
       Beverly Oliver film, but each time the FBI person assigned
       to me was not able to find these photograhs.  But the
       testimony of the people involved was good enough for me to
       conclude that there was nobody in that window ever.
          Once I got to that point I started looking for other
       evidence that would show where the shots did come from and I
       started finding all kinds of evidence of shots from the
       grassy knoll, and from the Dal Tex building, and from the
       roof or the seventh floor of the western end of the
       depository building--both photographs as well as witness
       testimony--and that lead me to decide that this was a
       powerful conspiracy which had involved at least four gunmen
       firing shots.  This then lead me to decide that I should
       pursue the whole pattern of conspiracy including,
       eventually, the Martin Luther King assassination, the Bobby
       Kennedy assassination and the George Wallace attempt.  And
       that led to the book.
          Through all of this, I just know I never would have
       concluded that it was a powerful and well-planned conspiracy
       if I had not determined that Oswald wasn't in that window--
       nobody was in that window.  That was the first key.
          There's one other thing I'd like to point out.  The title
       of the book has more than just simple significance and it
       shows up in all the chapters that link all these
       assassinations and their cover-ups.  Namely, our country has
       been taken from us.  Us being the citizens of the United
       States as of 1963, and any time after that, by robbing us of
       our capability of electing a president we wanted for at
       least three, and more likely four, elections.  One way of
       taking the country away, is to control the elections and
       that's really, at least part of the essence of the book.
       It's close to what Henry Gonzalez proposed in his original
       bill.  He wanted the Congress to look into all four of the
       major assassinations--the fourth being the attempted
       assassination of George Wallace--and find the links between
       and among them, and the cover-ups, and particularly the
       links between the intelligence agencies and the cover-ups
       that he was sure were involved in all of them.  And if we
       had had a committee which had done that, well then, we'd
       have been a lot further along than we are 13 years later.

                   -- phone interview with the author, June 3, 1992





       The assassination of President John F. Kennedy was the most
    photographed murder in history.  Approximately 75 photographers took
    a total of approximately 510 photographs, either before or during or
    within an hour after the events in Dealey Plaza, and either there or
    nearby or related to those events.  The word "photograph" in this
    context includes both still photos and movie sequences.  The number
    of frames in a movie sequence ranges from about 10 to about 500;  and
    in the count of 510 photographs, given above, the 10 to 500 frames of
    a single movie sequence are counted just as *one* photograph.  The
    total number of frames is over 25,000.
       The Warren Commission examined 26 photographs, about 5 percent of
    the 510.  The FBI examined about 50 photographs, or about 10 percent.
    The most famous of all the photographs is the Zapruder film, which
    had over 480 frames.
       Many of the photographs were taken by professional photographers.
    About 30 of the photographers were professionals who worked for
    newspapers, television networks, and photographic agencies.
       The Warren Commission did not interview a single one of the
    professional photographers, nor did the Warren Commission see any
    complete, uncropped copies of their photographs.
       Fifteen of these professionals were actually in the Kennedy
    motorcade, no further than 6 car lengths behind the Kennedy car.
    Five of these photographers were television network cameramen.  The
    Warren Commission looked at none of their photographs.
       [.....]
       Because the professionals used movie cameras of professional
    quality, their films are exceedingly revealing and valuable as
    primary evidence.  The Warren Commission looked at none of these
    films.
       During the past several years, I have collected copies of over 200
    of these photographs, and I have looked at and taken notes of another
    200 of these photographs, without obtaining copies of them.  Some of
    the remaining 100 have either not been found or have been locked up
    or destroyed by the owners, who are fearful of the information they
    show.  Or they have been locked up by the FBI, who have either placed
    them in files inaccessible to the public or possibly have destroyed
    them.

                from, "The Assassination of President John F. Kennedy:
                       The Application of Computers to the Photographic
                       Evidence" Richard E. Sprague, "Computers and
                       Automation," May, 1970, p. 34.






    for those interested, i have created a raw PostScript version of this
    complete book which can simply be lp'd to a PostScript laser printer
    for "prettified" hardcopy output.  the combined size of the two
    PostScript files comprising the book is 1055954 bytes (1007753 and
    48201 bytes for the main portion and appendix respectively).



--
                                            daveus rattus

                                  yer friendly neighborhood ratman

                              KOYAANISQATSI

  ko.yaa.nis.qatsi (from the Hopi Language)  n.  1. crazy life.  2. life
      in turmoil.  3. life out of balance.  4. life disintegrating.
        5. a state of life that calls for another way of living.
Path: ns-mx!uunet!olivea!sgigate!odin!ratmandu.esd.sgi.com!dave
From: [email protected] (dave "who can do? ratmandu!" ratcliffe)
Newsgroups: alt.activism,alt.conspiracy,alt.conspiracy.jfk
Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (1/11)
Summary: we were robbed of our capability of electing a president we wanted
Keywords: part 1 of 11:  beginning thru chapter 3
Message-ID: <[email protected]>
Date: 5 Jun 92 14:29:54 GMT
Sender: [email protected] (Net News)
Organization: Silicon Graphics, Inc.
Lines: 1113
Xref: ns-mx alt.activism:27177 alt.conspiracy:15386 alt.conspiracy.jfk:1506
Nntp-Posting-Host: ratmandu.esd.sgi.com



                       THE TAKING OF AMERICA, 1-2-3

                          by Richard E. Sprague
   Reprinted here with permission of the author.  Permission to distribute
  this book is freely given so long as no modification of the text is done.


                         Richard E. Sprague 1976
                        Limited First Edition 1976
                       Revised Second Edition 1979
                        Updated Third Edition 1985




               About the Author

               Publisher's Word

               Introduction

       1.      The Overview and the 1976 Election

       2.      The Power Control Group

       3.      You Can Fool the People

       4.      How It All Began--The U-2 and the Bay of Pigs

       5.      The Assassination of John Kennedy

       6.      The Assassinations of Robert Kennedy and
               Dr. Martin Luther King and
               Lyndon B. Johnson's Withdrawal in 1968

       7.      The Control of the Kennedys--Threats & Chappaquiddick

       8.      1972--Muskie, Wallace and McGovern

       9.      Control of the Media--1967 to 1976

      10.      Techniques and Weapons and 100 Dead Conspirators
               and Witnesses

      11.      Nixon and Ford - The Pardon and the Tapes

      12.      The Second Line of Defense and Cover-Ups in 1975-1976

      13.      The 1976 Election and Conspiracy Fever

      14.      Congress and the People

      15.      The Select Committee on Assassinations, The Intelligence
               Community and The News Media

      16.      1984 Here We Come--

      17.      The Final Cover-Up:  How The CIA Controlled
               The House Select Committee on Assassinations

               Appendix






                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *




                             About the Author


        Richard E. Sprague is a pioneer in the field of electronic
     computers and a leading American authority on Electronic Funds
     Transfer Systems (EFTS).  Receiving his BSEE degreee from Purdue
     University in 1942, his computing career began when he was
     employed as an engineer for the computer group at Northrup
     Aircraft.  He co-founded the Computer Research Corporation of
     Hawthorne, California in 1950, and by 1953, serving as Vice
     President of Sales, the company had sold more computers than any
     competitor.  In 1960, he became the Director of Computer Systems
     Consulting for Touche, Ross, Bailey, and Smart.  He became a
     partner in that company in 1963, and started its Advanced Business
     Systems Department in 1964 where he stayed until 1968.  In 1968 he
     established Sprague Research and Consulting for Computer
     Information Systems Consultation.  He is currently also Consultant
     to the President's Commission on EFTS and full time consultant to
     Battelle Memorial Institute of Frankfurt, Germany.
        In 1966, Mr. Sprague commenced an intensive program of research
     into the photographic evidence associated with the assassination of
     John Kennedy.  He served a year as photographic expert advisor in
     the investigations conducted by New Orleans District Attorney Jim
     Garrison and had amassed and analyzed a majority of the known
     evidence on film by 1968 when he co-founded the Committee to
     Investigate Assassinations.  He served with CTIA as an active
     researcher, board member and Secretary from 1968 to 1974.
        Following numerous radio and television appearances and
     extensive lecture tours of the United States and Canada (where
     slides and films were used to demonstrate the basic evidence of
     conspiracy), he began, in 1974, working toward a Congressional
     investigation of all four major political assassinations and the
     cover-ups and links among these interrelated events.  He was an
     advisor to Representative Henry B. Gonzales (D-Texas) on House
     Resolution 203 which proposed the appointment of a committee to
     investigate the circumstances surrounding the deaths of JFK, RFK,
     Martin Luther King and the attempt upon the life of Presidential
     Candidate George Wallace.  He served as a consultant to Richard
     A. Sprague and G. Robert Blakey, the first and second General
     Counsels of the House Select Committee on Assassinations, and
     served through the end of the Committee's existence.
        He is author of "Electronic Business Systems" (Ronald Press)
     1962, "Information Utilities" (Prentice Hall) 1969, and a
     celebrated series of articles which appeared in "Computers &
     Automation" Magazine beginning in 1970.  He is also co-author with
     Dick Russell of "In Search of the Assassins" which is scheduled for
     publication by the Dial Press in 1977.
        The materials presented in this book are drawn from an analysis
     of the photographic evidence, personal knowledge and records of the
     Garrison investigation, research files of the Committee to
     Investigate Assassinations and Congressional Committees.






                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *






                               Introduction

        This book is not about assassinations, at least not solely about
     assassinations.  It is not just another book about who murdered
     President Kennedy or how or why.  It is a book about power, about
     who really controls the United States policies, especially foreign
     policies.  It is a book about the process of control through the
     manipulation of the American presidency and the presidential
     election process.  The objective of the book is to expose the
     clandestine, secret, tricky methods and weapons used for this
     manipulation, and to reveal the degree to which these have been
     hidden from the American public.
        Assassinations are only one of many techniques used in this
     control process.  They have been important only in the sense that
     they are the ultimate method used in the control of the election
     process.  Viewed in this way, an understanding of what happened to
     John or Robert Kennedy becomes more important because it leads to a
     total understanding of what has happened to our country, and to us,
     since 1960.  But the important thing to understand is the control
     and the power and all of the clandestine methods put together.
        Much of the information in the book has been published before in
     the magazines "Computer and Automation" and "People and the Pursuit
     of Truth," both edited and published by Edmund C. Berkeley,
     Newtonville, Mass.  The material on assassination and other events
     covered is based on evidence collected by the author individually
     or through the Committee to Investigate Assassinations.  References
     to documentation of this evidence are given throughout the book.
        I am indebted to the following people for assistance in the
     research work involved and the preparation of the book itself:
        Special thanks go to Mary Ferrell who typed the original of the
     book.
        Jerry Policoff, Mark Lane, Ed Berkeley, Bob Cutler, Jim
     Garrison, Bill Turner, Wayne Chastain, Bob Richter, Gary Shaw,
     Fletcher Prouty, Rush Harp, Jones Harris, Bob Saltzman, Penn Jones,
     Larry Harris, Sylvia Meagher, Ray Marcus, Harold Weisberg, Hal
     Dorland, Paris Flammonde, Tink Thompson, Bob Katz, Joachim Joesten,
     Peter Downay, Harry Irwin, Dick Billings, Jim Lesar, Fred Newcomb,
     Lillian Castellano, Dick Russell, Tris Coffin, Mae Brussell, Bill
     Barry, Gary Roberts and most of all to my wife Gloria whose hard
     work and infinite patience made it all possible.
        The book is dedicated to Representative Henry B. Gonzalez for
     his singular courage in standing against the forces of evil.


                                              Richard E. Sprague


                                              Hartsdale, New York
                                              July 4, 1976






                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *




                             Publisher's Word

        We published "The Taking Of America 1 2 3" during the winter of
     1976-77.  It was typed under the guns in Dallas, Texas, and offset
     printed in Woodstock, N.Y.  A few weeks later--five hundred copies
     in all, 24 of which were fired off to the two House Committees
     involved in the investigation of the assassinations.  Our elation
     with this `coup-de-truth' evaporated as we saw the committee
     destroyed at the starting line.
        The following summer, while motoring across our sadly taken
     America, I experienced a tremendous synchroneity of events which
     lead to my discovering the Power Control Group's secret team of
     murderer's and their patsies.  This knowledge caused me to come out
     in the open even further and place a sign on route 28 enroute to
     Woodstock.  "Who Killed J.F.K., R.F.K., M.L.K., M.J.K.?" in
     reflecting letters on a blood-red field.  The Modjeska Sign Studios
     estimated 1.2 million sightings per month.  And we then watched the
     committee suppress and muddle the evidence while chanting the
     Katydid like cry, of the tremendous big lie--Oswald did it, Oswald
     did it, Oswald did it, did it, did it.
        So we are bringing our knowledge up to date with the closing of
     the new "Warren Report" which now, due to The Witness They Could
     Not Kill (the sound tape that proved conclusively that more than
     one gun was involved in the president's assassination), at last
     admits conspiracy.  Where do we go from here?  We reach out now for
     a courageous commercial publisher to spread these truths that we
     hold self-evident out to our duped, betrayed, and steadily lied-to
     Americans.

                                                     Rush Harp
                                                  Barbara Black






                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *




                        THE TAKING OF AMERICA, 1-2-3


                                 Chapter 1
                  The Overview and the the 1976 Election

        The taking of America has been both a simple and a very complex
     process.  It has not been the result of a coup d'etat, although
     some aspects of the process resemble a coup.  It has not been a
     process similar to the dictatorship takeovers in Germany, Italy and
     other fascist regimes.  It has not been a process like the
     Communist "uprisings" in Russia, Hungary and other Eastern European
     countries.
        The taking of America has been a process unique in the history
     of the world.  The one feature that makes it unique is that what
     was once the greatest democracy in the world has been taken over by
     a power control group without the knowledge of most of the American
     people, their congressional representatives, or the rest of the
     world.
        The group has taken America in this fashion because manipulation
     of the American presidency and the presidential electoral procedure
     is enough to control America.  Two fiendishly clever stratagems
     were used to keep the fact that control had been seized from being
     obvious to the people.  The first of these was control of the
     established media in the dissemination of both true (blocking) and
     false (flooding) information.  The second was the use of
     clandestine and secret weapons and techniques developed during
     World War Two and perfected during the Korean and Viet Nam wars.
     These techniques are so new and unusual as to be unbelievable to
     most citizens.  Thus, the incredibility of such weapons as
     hypnosis, brainwashing and "programming" of patsies as assassins
     became a psychological tool in the bag of techniques of the power
     control group.  The average American has shrugged off the
     possibility of the takeover with the belief that, "That's not
     possible here."
        The use of such weapons, coupled with a tremendous campaign
     through the controlled media that both whitewashes any signs of
     conspiracies and spreads disinformation throughout the country, has
     successfully blocked any serious or official attempts to get at the
     truth.  Unofficial investigators, private researchers, and even
     Congressional representatives have been ridiculed and completely
     blocked by both the power control group and their media allies.
        To take over a real democracy without letting the people know it
     has been taken over is a fantastic achievement.  A list of the
     accomplishments of the power control group illustrates the point.
     Since 1963, they have:


         1.  Assassinated John F. Kennedy;

         2.  Controlled Lyndon B. Johnson as president;

         3.  Forced LBJ out of the presidency;

         4.  Assassinated Robert F. Kennedy, assuring Nixon's
             election in 1968;

         5.  Assassinated Dr. Martin Luther King;

         6.  Eliminated Ted Kennedy as a contender in the 1972
             elections by framing him at Chappaquiddick and
             threatening his children;

         7.  Stopped George Wallace's campaign, assuring Nixon's
             election in 1972;

         8.  Knocked Edmund Muskie out of the 1972 election campaign
             by using dirty tricks;

         9.  Covered up all of the above;

        10.  Controlled the 15 major news media organizations;

        11.  Made Gerald Ford vice president and then president;

        12.  Insured continuity of the cover-ups by forcing Ford to
             pardon Nixon;

        13.  Murdered about 100 witnesses and participants in the
             three assassinations and one attempted assassination;

        14.  Blocked efforts by private citizens and organizations
             to reveal the take-over;  discredited, ruined or
             infiltrated these individuals or groups;  murdered or
             were accomplices to the murders of the operating
             assassins;

        15.  Blocked efforts by members of the Senate and House to
             initiate investigations of the assassinations and
             attempted to whitewash, ridicule or eliminate these
             efforts (their influence and infiltration has been
             particularly effective in the Church Committee and in
             the House Rules Committee);

        16.  Controlled the presidential election procedure since
             1964 by eliminating the candidates who might expose the
             truth and insuring the election or appointment of
             candidates already committed to covering up the truth
             about the take-over.

        The question for 1976 was:  Could the power control group
     continue the take-over during that year's elections?  Would they be
     successful in blocking efforts to expose the take-over by congress?
     Would they be able to fool the American public again, control the
     media, and eliminate the contenders for the presidency in 1976 who
     might have threatened their secure position?  The answer to these
     questions was "Yes."
        The candidates on the scene during the 1976 primaries fell into
     three categories according to the control group's point of view.
     Category 1 included candidates that would continue the cover-up of
     the take-over.  Gerald Ford led this group with Ronald Reagan not
     far behind him.  Henry Jackson was a probable ally because of his
     backing of the CIA, an important organization in the cover-ups and
     the takeover.  Category 2 included those candidates who would
     probably try to expose the take-over and the power control group if
     elected.  Morris Udall, Fred Harris and George Wallace fell into
     this category.  The third category included candidates whose
     intentions were not clear, or unknown at the time.  Jimmy Carter,
     Franck Church and Hubert Humphrey remained in this group, and
     Sergeant Shriver and Birch Bayh were also in this category before
     they dropped out of the race.
        Efforts would have been made to eliminate Udall, Harris or
     Wallace if any one of them was nominated at the Democratic
     convention.  Carter must certainly have been put to some kind of
     loyalty test before being permitted to continue as the Democratic
     nominee.  Reagan and Ford were, no doubt, already "safe" candidates
     for the control group because of their demonstrated cover-up
     performances.
        Ford had cooperated fully in at least four ways.  He was on the
     Warren Commission and played a leading role in the cover-up.  He
     wrote the cover-up book "Portrait of the Assassin."  He pardoned
     Nixon and protected the Nixon tapes.  And he formed the Rockefeller
     Commission, appointing David Belin as head of the staff to continue
     the cover-up of the JFK conspiracy.
        Reagan had cooperated in at least three ways.  He protected
     important witnesses from extradition from California between 1967
     and 1969 for testimony before the grand jury in New Orleans and at
     the trial of Clay Shaw.  He assisted Evelle Younger, then district
     attorney in Los Angeles and later California state attorney
     general, in covering up the assassination conspiracy in the Robert
     Kennedy case.  And he has consistently supported the foreign and
     domestic clandestine activities of the CIA, FBI and other
     intelligence agencies both nationally and in California.
        A later chapter will describe just how the Democratic candidate
     may be eliminated and when.  Congressman Henry B. Gonzalez from San
     Antonio, Texas, who introduced House Resolution 204 to reopen the
     two Kennedy assassination cases, the Dr. King case and the George
     Wallace shooting, took a public position on the possibility that
     the 1976 election was controlled.  Gonzalez said "If we find the
     answers--the truth--to the questions I have raised (about the
     assassinations of JFK, RFK, MLK and the Wallace attempt), as well
     as those many others have raised, will the truth make us free?
     Yes, it will, for the truth will make us free to pursue democracy-
     -our system of government--through the ballot box, and we will not
     be subject to government by bullets.  The truth will enable us to
     prevent such a series of events from happening again.  Some of the
     supporters of the investigation have written to me recently of
     their hope that the investigation will get underway right away
     (March 1976) because they are concerned that there is great danger
     in store for the Democratic nominee for the President, whoever he
     turns out to be.  I hope very much that these fears do not turn out
     to have a basis in fact."






                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *




                                 Chapter 2
                          The Power Control Group

        Just who and what is the Power Control Group?  Some have said
     it's the military industrial complex.  Some prefer to put the blame
     on the Rockefellers and the Council on Foreign Relation.  Others
     have talked about control shifting from the "Yankees" to the
     "Cowboys" and back again.  The term "The Cabal," first used in an
     obscure paper by an unknown author in 1968,[1] described a high
     level conspiracy group that planned, financed and carried out the
     assassination of John F. Kennedy.  The word Cabal has been used
     since then by some authors and researchers and applied to all of
     the major domestic assassinations.
        The idea of a Cabal raises more questions than it answers.  Who
     is in the Cabal?  Was the same Cabal behind the planning and
     financing of all five (Chappaquiddick being the fifth) major
     eliminations?  Or are there several interlocking Cabals?  What
     about the Warren and Rockefeller Commissions?  Were they part of
     the Cabal?  Which Cabal controls and infiltrated the media and
     organized the disinformation that poured forth in 1975 and 1976?
     Was Ford a Cabal member?  Was Nixon?  How about Johnson and
     Kissinger?  Has one Cabal commanded the executions of the 100
     witnesses and lower level participants?
        The mistake made by researchers in postulating higher level
     groups is that they simplify a very complex situation.  To draw a
     distinct line between those involved in an overt conspiracy to
     assassinate a leader and those involved afterward in covering up
     the first group's actions is a mistake.  The cover-ups are far more
     important than the original assassinations.  Each assassination or
     attempted assassination, or other form of elimination of a leader,
     is only part of a greater whole.  The 16 accomplishments of the
     power control group listed in Chapter 1, plus those now taking
     place and those scheduled for the future, should be considered as a
     continuum.  The control group membership may contain individuals in
     various categories, some of whom planned assassinations, some of
     whom knew about the assassinations, and some of whom did not know
     about assassinations in advance.  Some may have been on the firing
     line but have had nothing to do with the cover-ups.  Some of them
     are victims of later eliminations.  Somewhere in the power control
     group's hierarchy is a sub-group or perhaps several sub-groups that
     have been responsible for the attempted assassinations of
     presidential candidates, earlier assassins, witnesses, and earlier
     middle-to-higher level members in the power control group.  These
     sub-groups might be thought of as intelligence-style task forces or
     mini-Cabals.  There is little question that many of the individuals
     in these task forces are from organized crime and from the
     intelligence community, or both.  They have had access to
     intelligence techniques and weapons that have frequently been used
     in the the elimination process.
        A second mistake made by some researchers is to assume that the
     Cabal's shape remains static through time.  Evidence shows that the
     Power Control Group has been a living organism that both shrinks
     and grows as a function of time.  The shrinkages take place through
     eliminations and a few natural deaths.  The growth takes place for
     several reasons.  It is necessary to use new techniques and new
     people for the group's activities as time passes in order to
     continue effective control of the media and to continue to fool the
     people and Congress.  It's also necessary to bring new high level
     people into the group from time to time.  Candidates for president
     acceptable to the group must be sworn in and must agree to continue
     the cover-ups.  New media lackeys or new special committees or
     commissions are also needed.  Once in a while an individual
     blackmails his way in.  Some come in on a de facto basis.
     (Protectors of the Kennedys and their children fall into this
     category.)
        The very nature of the cover-up procedure has made it necessary
     to expose at least some of the truth to vice presidents and vice
     presidential candidates, in addition to presidents Johnson, Nixon,
     and Ford.  Each vice president elected or appointed since 1963 has
     had to know the truth about the cover-ups in the event he became
     president (Humphrey under Johnson, Agnew under Nixon, and then Ford
     and Rockefeller).  Ford was the most important of these since he
     had to agree to pardon Nixon and to protect the tapes.
        The heads of the FBI and CIA, selected trusted second-level men,
     and the deputy director of plans (DDP) in the CIA have all had to
     know some of the truth.  The members of the 40 group and their
     successors who presumably know all intelligence secrets of the
     country are, no doubt, brought into this "inner circle" of
     knowledgeable people.
        The Warren Commissioners were split.  Warren, Dulles McCloy and
     Ford all knew the truth;  Cooper, Boggs and Russell did not.  The
     Rockefeller Commission was also split.  Rockefeller certainly knows
     and so does Ford's man on that Commission, David Belin.  Kissinger
     must have known the truth;  so must have the officers in the
     Department of Defense.  Then there are the Secret Team members,
     planted in the various media organizations, who know the truth.  A
     later chapter will describe who they are and how they lead the
     media cover-up and disinformation mill.
        This living organism view of the Power Control Group can best be
     constructed and proven by starting with the cover-up efforts and
     the control of the media, as opposed to examining the conspiracies
     to assassinate each leader.  It is much easier to show how Gerald
     Ford, for example, led the cover-up in the JFK conspiracy than it
     is to determine who the members of the Power Control Group were who
     planned and financed the assassination.
        It is difficult to show evidence of higher level participation
     in the assassinations of Robert Kennedy, Dr. King and in the
     attempted assassination of George Wallace.  It is not difficult to
     prove that many high level individuals conspired to cover-up the
     conspiracies in each of the three cases.  It is not difficult to
     prove that they helped frame at least one of the patsies (James
     Earl Ray).
        Much of the content of this book will show evidence of the
     cover-ups and discuss the actions that are still taking place that
     protect the Power Control Group.  Only summary information is
     included on the original conspiracies, except where there is a lack
     of published data.



____________________

[1] "Nomenclature of an Assassination Cabal", Torbett, 1968 (Copeland
    Document)






                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *




                                 Chapter 3
                          You Can Fool the People

        One of the questions always asked by the beginning student of
     America's political assassinations is, "How is it possible that all
     of this could be happening in our country without our knowing about
     it?"  The "It couldn't happen here" belief has been extended to,
     "It couldn't happen here without our knowing about it."  This is
     usually buttressed by such arguments as, "The Kennedys would have
     done something about it, if it were true", or "Such a giant
     conspiracy would have been exposed by someone within the
     conspiratorial group", or "The news media would have found out
     about it and told all of us by now."
        The fact that it is possible to fool a majority of the American
     people for a long period of time and to cover-up a high level
     conspiracy involving many, many individuals, can easily be
     demonstrated by using Watergate as an example.  In fact, some
     published articles[1] show that the entire truth about Watergate
     has yet to be revealed.
        We do know now about the cover-up of the original crimes in
     Watergate and the cover-up of the cover-up.  We tend to forget the
     attitude of the majority of the American people, the Congress and
     the media, toward Richard Nixon and the Nixon administration during
     the period between the June 1972 Watergate break-in and the
     November 1972 election and beyond into 1973.  Long before Woodward
     and Bernstein and others began the Watergate expose, a few
     researchers were calling the Watergate conspiracies to the
     attention of a small portion of the public.[2]  It was not until
     late 1973 that the research done by these researchers and their
     hypotheses about high-level conspiracies were proven correct and
     were generally accepted.  How did it happen that for more than a
     year a majority of the American people were not only fooled by Mr.
     Nixon and his friends, but also re-elected him?  Some of the same
     ingredients present in that situation were like those used in the
     taking of America.  We can all learn a lot by observing what they
     were.
        What follows is a reproduction of an article by the author.
     (Because the article was written in l972, some of the material in
     it is now obsolete.  However, it is reproduced here without changes
     to illustrate the situation and attitudes of the pre-Watergate
     revelation era.)  It was originally written during the Watergate
     cover-up era (late 1972), after Nixon was re-elected and before
     Bernstein and Woodward were noticed by anyone.  It should be noted
     that even in 1976, Mr. Nixon still had his vehement supporters who
     were blind to the ingredients required to fool the people.


                        You Can Fool the People

            You can fool all of the people some of the time
            You can fool some of the people all of the time
            But you can't fool all of the people all of the time.
                                               Abraham Lincoln, 1864

        The decade of 1963 to 1973 in the United State of America
        will go down in history for many things.  In the long run
        it will be known through the world as the period which
        demonstrated that it is possible to fool most of the
        people all of the time.
           Adolph Hitler didn't fool very many people.  He cowed
        them, frightened them, and killed them.  But most Germans
        knew what was happening even though they chose to do
        nothing about it until it was too late.
           The exercise of power to control what happens and to
        restrict liberties is much more difficult in a Democracy
        or a Republic.  The United States is always held up as the
        model case in which the guaranteed election of the
        president every four years and the two-party system, will
        prevent the country from being run by dictators.  The
        people are represented by the Congress and also elect the
        President.
           A person or a group planning a coup d'etat in the U.S.
        would have a completely different job on their hands than
        Germany in the 1930's, South American or African countries
        in the twentieth century, or France in the 1890's or
        Russia in 1918.
           It would be necessary to fool a majority of the
        American people into believing that they were well
        represented, and that a democracy still existed, while at
        the same time the coup group were in reality changing the
        country to suit their own tastes.
           It is the contention of the writer that this is exactly
        what has happened over a period of time following World
        War II.  The methods used to fool the American people,
        certainly since 1963 and to some extent also since the end
        of World War I, have varied slightly as administrations
        changed.  The main thrust however has been a constant
        erosion of civil rights, and a swing of government away
        from the best interests of the people and toward big
        companies, banks, the military and rich individuals and
        families.  The trend was slowed down only briefly between
        1960 and 1963 when Jack Kennedy attempted to alter the
        situation.  He was assassinated because he did so.
           To fool the American people is not easy.  It requires
        immense capabilities, tricky, secret methods, hidden
        resources, great wealth and the equivalent of brainwashing
        or mind control on a grand scale.  Yet that type of
        resource is precisely what has accomplished the deed.  It
        is probable that, like Germany, the American people will
        awaken to what has been happening to them and to who has
        been doing it.  It is also very likely, now that the Nixon
        administration has been restored for four more years, that
        by 1976 it will be too late, in spite of Watergate.
           George McGovern's speech on ABC Television, the evening
        of October 25, 1972, was a warning for those citizens who
        were awake, that "it can happen here."  It's happening
        here, was his basic message.  Yet, unlike Germany, the
        people were silent, and fooled.  They didn't believe him
        when he said, "Your liberties are being removed, one by
        one."  The Supreme Court by 1976 will be so packed with
        Nixon appointees that we will never get our liberties
        back.  McGovern covered most of the areas in which the
        people have been fooled.  The major area he didn't cover
        was that of assassination.  This tool represents only the
        end of the spectrum of techniques used by those in control
        to remain in control.  It has been used four times very
        effectively, on both Kennedys, on Martin Luther King, and
        in the attempt on George Wallace.  In the case of Wallace,
        crippling was sufficient to change the political outcome
        in 1972.



        More important than the use of assassinations has been the
     ability to fool the American people into believing there were four
     lone madmen involved--and no conspiracies.  The techniques involved
     in fooling people are more complex and subtle than those involved
     in the crime itself.  In the Watergate case, the original crime was
     the use of every trick and technique necessary to re-elect Nixon.
     The people had to be fooled into believing that Nixon and the CIA
     had nothing to do with Watergate and the broader plan of which it
     was part.
        That the fooling part turned out to be so easy is due to a long
     series of conditioning steps taken with the American news media and
     the people over the preceding years.  The Pentagon Papers case
     reveals how the people were fooled by several (successive CIA)
     administrations over a long period of time.  Efforts against
     Ellsberg and the press continued in order to prevent further decay
     of the fooling process.
        How is it possible in the 20th century USA--with TV and high
     levels of communication, with freedom of the press, freedom of
     speech--to fool most of the people all of the time?  Here is how it
     is done.  Five ingredients are required.

        INGREDIENT 1.  A PATRIOTIC ISSUE.  A fundamental issue
     permeating nearly all conditions of life in the U.S. is needed,
     around which the rest of the fooling can be constructed.  The
     perfect issue since 1947 has been "The Red Menace," or "Communism"
     or "The Radical Communist Left Conspiracy."  No one is more adept
     at using this issue than Richard Nixon.
        The people, to be fooled, have to really believe in the issue,
     from the heart, from the gut.  In a democracy this is the most
     essential ingredient.  In the U.S. many, many people believe it.
     Some believe it because they have never heard or read anything
     other than "The Communists are going to take over."  Others believe
     it because they or their parents or relatives came from Europe and
     "know what it's like to live under Naziism or Communism."  (They
     don't distinguish.)
        Some believe because they are religious, and somehow religion is
     always linked to anti-communism.  Others aren't sure, but they
     think "radical" groups might be Communist controlled.  The flag
     waving, the national anthem, the American Legion, our prisoners of
     war, the draft of the past--all of these symbols are linked to the
     one big issue of "Communism."
        There can be several sub-issues of lesser significance than the
     fundamental issue.  Some of these might be related to the main
     issue.  Others may be unrelated.  Some are used to appeal to
     certain segments of the population.  They can be carefully
     exploited and added together with the main issue in a way which
     enhances it.  Some are useful with low-intelligence-level people.
     Others appeal to bigots.  Some are fearful issues which people
     would rather avoid.  Others hit the individual right in his
     pocketbook or his security.
        If played one against the other, very carefully, many of these
     sub-issues can be blamed on Communism.  Archie Bunker, of the TV
     series, "All In The Family", was not exaggerating when he blamed
     his white niece's dancing with a black neighbor boy on "a Communist
     plot."
        Examples of sub-issues used by those controlling Nixon
     administration to fool the people include:

          The black-white issue
          The busing issue
          The young radical issue
          The law and order issue
          The national security issue
          The old-fashioned American work ethic versus
             poverty and welfare issue

        INGREDIENT 2.  REACHING THE MINDS OF THE PEOPLE.  To fool a
     majority of the people all of the time it is necessary to reach
     into their minds over a relatively long period of time.  Make an
     analysis of what you, the reader, believe today or disbelieve,
     along with the mental condition you are in when you enter a polling
     booth, or write a letter to your Congressman.  After some thought
     list all of the ways in which information might reach you today.
     You will list all of the environmental factors, self images,
     motivations, ego factors and acquired beliefs that make you do what
     you do, and make you think what you think.
        You will realize that your heritage, your schooling, your life's
     experience, and the present bombardment of information have an
     impact on how you vote.  If your father and grandfather before you
     were strong Republicans or Democrats, you may well vote the same
     "pull one lever" way.  You might close your mind to any messages of
     imminent disaster, and think, "I'm better off not knowing and just
     voting straight Republican." (In 1972)
        You might have strong faith in the "American way of life" and
     pay no attention to the people who go around claiming that John
     Kennedy, Martin Luther King and Robert Kennedy were all murdered by
     elements of an invisible government to keep the U.S. on the
     military, wealthy, conservative track.
        You might ignore solid evidence regarding Lee Harvey Osward's,
     James Earl Ray's or Sirhan Sirhan's actions and instead rely on a
     long-term, well engineered faith that something like that "couldn't
     happen here."
        Go back in time to 1935, if you are over 50, or go back to 1945,
     if you are over 40, or back to 1955, if you are over 30.  Examine
     your general overall attitudes, beliefs and prejudices as developed
     over that period of time between then and now.  You will discover
     that your political beliefs about the U.S., the Presidency, foreign
     policy, wage and price controls, and your own economic conditions,
     etc., have been strongly influenced by the various news media.

        INGREDIENT 3.  CONTROLLING THE NEWS MEDIA.  In Chapter 9, the
     author proves that it has been possible for a very small group of
     people in power to control or fool nearly all of the major news
     media in the U.S. about the assassination of John F. Kennedy and
     subsequent investigations conducted by groups other than the
     sources of power (Warren Commission, FBI, Secret Service, CIA,
     Justice Department, the President).
        According to polls taken between 1963 and 1970, 50% to 80% of
     the public at one time or another during this period believed there
     was a conspiracy.  Nevertheless, the major news media took the
     opposite position.  A poll conducted today would, no doubt, show
     about one-half of the people believing there was no conspiracy.
     How did this happen?  Is it conceivable that the power sources of
     two succeeding administrations (Johnson and Nixon) fooled or
     controlled the news media to that extent?
        The problem is not so difficult as it seems.  Only sixteen media
     organizations are involved.  These sixteen provide each of us with
     nearly all of the news we either read, see or hear.  It is only
     necessary to control the sixteen men at the very top and that is
     exactly what happened.  The proof contained in Chapter 9 contains
     specific facts about what happened inside of eleven of the sixteen
     organizations.
        Some of them maintained an editorial position oriented toward
     the possibility of conspiracy for several years.  The last ones to
     convert because of high level command decisions (at the *owner*
     level--not the editorial level) did not do so until 1969, 5 1/2
     years after the assassination.  Several of the eleven conducted
     their own independent investigations and discovered conspiracy
     evidence sufficient to take that stand.  Among these were CBS,
     Life Magazine, and "The New York Times."

          The sixteen media organizations are:

           1. NBC-TV and Radio
           2. CBS-TV and Radio
           3. ABC-TV and Radio
           4. Associated Press
           5. United Press International
           6. Time-Life
           7. McGraw Hill - Business Week
           8. Newsweek
           9. U.S. News and World Report
          10. New York Times and their news service
          11. Washington Post and their news service
          12. Metromedia News Network TV and Radio
          13. Westinghouse Radio News Network
          14. Capital City Broadcasting Radio Network
          15. North American Newspaper Alliance
          16. Gannett News Service


        Controlling the news media to that extent in order to fool the
     people is an extreme act.  It is a last resort in an extremely
     serious situation.  Such a situation arose when it became obvious
     to those in power that Jim Garrison was going to expose the truth
     about the assassination in court.  He had to be destroyed, and he
     was, by fooling the news media as well as the people.
        Control of the press by the power group slipped a little with
     the Pentagon Papers, the Mylai episode, the Green Berets, the FBI
     use of spying, and the Watergate caper.  But effective control over
     the fooling of the people nevertheless remains.  With Watergate,
     people fooling shifted from controlling the news media, which
     suddenly awakened a little too late, to the control of the the
     legal system.

        INGREDIENT 4.  CONTROLLING THE LEGAL SYSTEM.  Perhaps the most
     important long-range ingredient in fooling the people of America is
     the control and influence over the legal system.  The U.S. in the
     post-war era has reached the stage where, in case of doubt on a
     major issue, the people will wait to see how it is resolved by the
     courts.  The American people in general have always had tremendous
     faith in their own legal system.
        With the exception of the South taking issue with the Warren
     court over black rights, the American people tend to believe that
     the Supreme Court will eventually right any wrongs.  The faith goes
     much further than adjudication of crimes or disputes.  People have
     come to rely on the legal system to tell them where the truth lies
     on a major issue when two sides differ completely on the facts.
     They believe that the adversary procedure and the perjury penalty
     system will ferret out the truth.
        Thus, to fool the people, and make them believe lies, it is
     essential to control the legal system.  The Nixon and Johnson
     administrations and the Invisible Government lying underneath or
     off to one side of both administrations became very adept at
     controlling the legal system.  It can be done, and has been done in
     several ways.  Nixon, of course, loaded the Supreme Court.  That is
     important.  The complete control of the Justice Department and the
     FBI is also obvious.  Not so obvious is the need to control Federal
     judges throughout the land.  Truth might leak out in a trial at a
     local level, so U.S. courts in each area must be controlled.
        The Federal grand jury scheme worked out by Nixon, Mitchell and
     Robert Mardian is a beautiful way to guide, direct and control the
     legal system.  It more than proved its worth in fooling the people
     in cases involving classified documents, the Black Panthers and
     other situations where the truth had to be obscured.
        Control over the American Bar Association and individual lawyers
     and district attorneys is another method used.  And finally, it is
     often useful to control local and state police, either individually
     or in groups.
        The exercise of control is important.  It may be desirable to
     suppress truth in a court situation during a trial or hearings.
     The judge can do this very effectively.  It may also be desirable
     to delay a trial or a hearing in which the truth might be exposed.
     Judges and lawyers can do this quite easily.  It may be desirable
     to entirely shut off a trial or an appeal where truth could be
     exposed.  Nixon was able to do this to perfection.
        Lies and fake cases may be presented as truth in court while
     truth is attacked as being falsehood.  This technique has been very
     successful.
        All of this takes both money and power.  Judges and lawyers,
     must either be paid a lot of money, or frightened about their
     career and health.  The CIA conduits used for espionage financing
     have been used extensively in controlling the legal system.  Power
     has been used to control lower courts and local police or district
     attorneys from the highest source of power in America, the
     invisible government.
        A few examples will suffice to demonstrate how the legal system
     is used to fool the people.
        The 1972 election demonstrated that two-thirds of the people
     either did not associate Mr. Nixon with the Watergate affair and
     the Chapin-Segretti sabotage project, or else they didn't know
     about it or didn't care.
        Surely, you say, a traditional American patriot would not vote
     for a man who did all of the things the Watergate 7 and Chapin-
     Segretti and company did.  But wait!  The situation as of January
     1973 had not yet reached the courts.  Except for Bernard Barker's
     conviction for falsely using his notary public seal to stamp a
     check from Kenneth Dahlberg in Florida, no court actions had taken
     place.
        Wasn't that lucky for the Republicans, you say.  It wasn't luck.
     The Watergate arrests took place in June 1972.  By successfully
     delaying a whole series of trials and court actions, Mr. Nixon,
     through control of the courts, kept the truth away from the people
     until after the election on November 7.  Perhaps some of the people
     who voted for him had doubts, but if court cases had been conducted
     before November 7, and conducted fairly by uncontrolled judges, the
     truth would have been exposed in all of its glory.
        Now that he had a powerful mandate from the people, it was
     likely that other forms of control would be used to continue
     fooling the people about Watergate.  Some of these were covered in
     the prior chapters.  Executive privilege has been used to a major
     extent.
        Clay Shaw was actually defended and Garrison, in effect, was put
     on trial, through CIA money and CIA lawyers.  Garrison's attempts
     to bring Shaw to trial for perjury were successfully blocked by
     Federal courts and judges.
        Sirhan Sirhan's trial for the murder of Robert Kennedy was
     controlled by the Nixon administration in order to hide the truth
     from the people.  The case involved controlling the judge at the
     trial, the district attorney, the lawyers for Sirhan, the Los
     Angeles police, the FBI, and some of the officials of the state of
     California.  The control exercised has continued to prevent Sirhan
     from receiving a new trial based on new evidence of what happened
     in the assassination.

        THE FIVE BIG EVENTS.  The five events since World War II about
     which the power control group must continue to fool the American
     people about are the assassinations of John Kennedy, Robert Kennedy
     and Martin Luther King;  the attempted assassination of George
     Wallace;  and the Watergate episode.  (In 1973, the truth about
     Chappaquiddick and its importance, together with the threats
     against Jackie Kennedy, Ethel Kennedy, Ted Kennedy and all of the
     Kennedy children, had not been exposed.  Chappaquiddick is the
     sixth big event.)
        All other things this group has done since 1947 fade into
     insignificance compared to these five.  The reason is that the
     American people may accept such things as the Pueblo incident, the
     Gulf of Tonkin fake, the Mylai incident, the Pentagon Papers, the
     Kent State killings, the frame-ups of the Black Panthers and their
     murders, and even the whole Viet Nam war, but they would rise up in
     wrath if the truth about any one or all of those five events were
     exposed.
        Thus, Mr. Hanson for Sirhan, Mr. Fensterwald for James Earl Ray,
     Mr. Lawrence O'Brien and the Watergate suit--anyone opposing the
     findings of the Warren Commission with national prominence and
     success--and anyone who begins to pry too much into George
     Wallace's brush with death will be opposed with all the power those
     in control can muster.  Each will be dealt with if he comes too
     close, just as Jim Garrison was dealt with by both the Johnson and
     Nixon administrations.  Garrison managed to beat out the Nixon-
     controlled Justice Department in his own trial in September 1973.
     The jury in New Orleans found him innocent in spite of the fact
     that the prosecuting attorney, the judge, the key witness, Pershing
     Gervais, and the news media were all controlled by Nixon and
     Mitchell.  By late 1973 it was becoming a little more difficult to
     fool the people.

        INGREDIENT 5.  PAID COLUMNISTS OR LACKEYS.  Control of the news
     media includes controlling or hiring selected columnists, newsmen,
     commentators, and lackeys.  Sometimes these people are called
     "spokesmen for the administration."  Many of them are supposedly
     independent.  Their importance in the process of fooling the people
     has increased as the number of independent news media organizations
     has decreased and the number of organizations relying on
     syndicated, national columnists or commentators has increased.
        The Nixon administration managed to corral a great many more of
     these types than did the administrations of Johnson, Kennedy, or
     Eisenhower.  In the newspaper field, there were four to five times
     as many columnists writing "fool the people" type news for Nixon as
     against Nixon.  Alsop was at one extreme.  More subtle were writers
     like C.L. Sulzberger in the "New York Times" and Gary Wills in
     various conservative papers.  On radio, the Westinghouse network
     used four commentators who appeared to be liberal at first glance,
     but who adhered to the party line when the time came to get at the
     truth about the five key events mentioned earlier.  These four were
     Peter Lisagor, Rod McCleish, Simeon Booker and Irwin Cannon.
        William Safire, Evans and Novak, Mary McCarthy, and occasionally
     Jack Anderson also fall into the "fool the people" column.  The
     impact of these columnists on the American people has not really
     been measured.  Alsop's and Evans and Novak's columns appear in
     Republican and right-wing newspapers all across the U.S.  The
     election poll that indicated over 700 newspapers supported Nixon
     while fewer than 50 supported McGovern provides some estimate of
     how influential these papers and columnists can be.  With the
     exception of two or three stories by Jack Anderson about Robert
     Kennedy and plots to assassinate Castro, none of the evidence about
     the truth pertaining to the assassinations has ever appeared in any
     of these columns.  Yet the American people read these columns more
     faithfully than they read the front page.

        HOW THE PEOPLE HAVE BEEN FOOLED. Now that the ingredients for
     fooling the people have been discussed, let's examine the net
     results over the past twenty-five years.  Between 1957 and 1972,
     there was a culmination in the use of these ingredients, many of
     which were developed with the end of World War II.
        Through a succession of presidencies and political party
     administrations from Truman to Nixon a mixture of wealthy, military
     and espionage individuals developed a power base and used the five
     ingredients to fool the people.  Except for John Kennedy, none of
     the presidents tried very hard to resist this power.  The book
     "Farewell America" (by James Hepburn--a pseudonym--Frontiers
     Press), which has been reprinted in sections in "Computers and
     Automation" (1973) shows clearly what kind of power JFK tried to
     resist and how it resulted in his death.
        The American people aren't familiar with this book any more than
     they are familiar with a movie made from the book, with the same
     title.  And as long as the group remains in power, the book and
     movie will be banned from the United States, just as "Z" was banned
     in Greece.
        The people of America were fooled into believing each of the
     following untruths:

     Kent State:

        The National Guard fired under intense pressure and attack
        by a bunch of hoodlums at Kent State University.  The
        various grand juries have vindicated the Guard.  There was
        no White House influence involved in the killings, or in
        the aftermath.

     Mylai:

        Calley was justified in shooting the civilians at Mylai
        because those were his orders.  You can't tell a "gook"
        from a Viet Cong and, after all, war is war.

     Communism:

        The greatest threat to American freedom is still a world-
        wide Communist take-over.  The domino theory may or may not
        be correct, but we must never give up a fight.  "Peace
        with honor" was essential in Viet Nam.

     Pentagon Papers:

        Few people have taken the time to read the Pentagon Papers
        and have understood their significance.  The two-thirds
        majority who elected Nixon in 1972 may have been puzzled
        by the papers or they may not have cared.  No doubt, most
        of them believed Ellsberg a traitor and worthy of jail.
        It is very unlikely they will ever believe they were duped
        by Truman, Eisenhower, Kennedy, Johnson and Nixon and most
        particularly by the CIA and allies in matters pertaining
        to the cold war and Communism.  The fundamental, gut issue
        of the Communist conspiracy overrides any other revelation
        in this field.

     Assassinations:

        In spite of polls and uneasy feelings, at least half and
        perhaps a majority of the American people still believe
        that John Kennedy, Robert Kennedy and Martin Luther King
        were assassinated by Lee Harvey Oswald, Sirhan Sirhan and
        James Earl Ray, respectively, and that the assassination
        attempt on George Wallace was solely Arthur Bremer's
        doing.  They believe these men acted alone and that they
        were madmen. (This statement pertains to the period of
        1972-73.)

     Watergate:

        Prior to the election in November 1972, a majority of the
        American people believed that Richard Nixon, John
        Mitchell, Maurice Stans and everyone else of importance in
        the White House had nothing to do with the Watergate
        affair or the activities of Donald Segretti and others
        prior to the election.  Almost no one believed that the
        CIA was involved in setting up Nixon so as to capture and
        control the executive to an even greater degree.

     Democracy and Freedom:

        By the end of 1973 a relatively large percentage of the
        American people still did not relate any of the foregoing
        incidents or situations to their own individual liberties.
        They believed patriotically in America;  they believed we
        still had a democracy;  they believed that President
        Nixon, with his wise ways and business experience would
        pull us out of whatever problems we had.  From the time he
        nailed Alger Hiss and the day he won the great kitchen
        debate with Kruschev, Nixon was believed to be the leader
        who would secure our eventual victory over Communism.  The
        people refuse to consider the possibility that unknown
        forces have seized control over the U.S. for the last
        fifteen years and that our liberties and democracy are
        fading away.



____________________

[1] "Nixon and the Mafia" -- Jeff Gerth, "Sundance Magazine," December
    1972.  Charles Colson Interview, by Dick Russell - "Argosy Magazine,"
    March 1976

[2] "Why Was Martha Mitchell Kidnapped?" -- Mae Brussell, "The Realist,"
    August 1972

    "The June 1972 Raid on Democratic Party Headquarters -- Part 1" --
    R.E. Sprague, "Computers & Automation," August 1972

    "The Raid on Democratic Party Headquarters -- The Watergate
    Incident -- Part 2", Ibid.









--
                                            daveus rattus

                                  yer friendly neighborhood ratman

                              KOYAANISQATSI

  ko.yaa.nis.qatsi (from the Hopi Language)  n.  1. crazy life.  2. life
      in turmoil.  3. life out of balance.  4. life disintegrating.
        5. a state of life that calls for another way of living.
Path: ns-mx!hobbes.physics.uiowa.edu!zaphod.mps.ohio-state.edu!uwm.edu!spool.mu.edu!olivea!sgigate!odin!ratmandu.esd.sgi.com!dave
From: [email protected] (dave "who can do? ratmandu!" ratcliffe)
Newsgroups: alt.activism,alt.conspiracy,alt.conspiracy.jfk
Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (2/11)
Summary: we were robbed of our capability of electing a president we wanted
Keywords: part 2 of 11:  chapter 4 thru chapter 5
Message-ID: <[email protected]>
Date: 8 Jun 92 13:49:47 GMT
Sender: [email protected] (Net News)
Organization: Silicon Graphics, Inc.
Lines: 969
Xref: ns-mx alt.activism:27281 alt.conspiracy:15429 alt.conspiracy.jfk:1550
Nntp-Posting-Host: ratmandu.esd.sgi.com


                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *




                                 Chapter 4
              How It All Began - The U-2 and the Bay of Pigs

        To understand the origins of the Power Control Group, it is
     necessary to return to the last years of the Eisenhower
     administration and examine what was going on in the Cold War.
        Eisenhower had suffered several strokes and a heart attack.  He
     was partially immobilized, and entrusted a major share of the
     coordination of clandestine activities being conducted by the CIA
     against the "Red Menace" to Richard Nixon, his vice president.
     While Ike was warning against the military-industrial-complex's
     domestic influence, and attempting to move toward detente with the
     Soviets through a summit meeting, he was being sabotaged by the
     plans section of the CIA and by Richard Nixon.
        A part of the CIA arranged for a U-2 with Gary Powers as pilot
     to go down over Russia, thus giving Khrushchev a chance to expose
     American spying and to cancel the summit meeting.  This was one of
     the earliest moves of the nucleus of what later evolved into the
     Power Control Group.  In the spring of 1960, with Ike nearly senile
     and pressured by Nixon, he approved the plan for the invasion of
     Cuba and the assassination of Castro.  Nixon was the chief White
     House action officer for what later became the Bay of Pigs
     invasion.
        The Power Control Group was beginning to organize itself with
     Nixon as part of it.  The cold warriors and strong anti-Communist
     "patriots" in the Plans or Operations part of the CIA formed the
     original nucleus.
        Their plan was to make Nixon president in 1961 and to launch a
     successful takeover of Cuba.  John Kennedy came along to upset the
     plan.  Not only did he make the takeover impossible but he soon
     discovered the evils lurking in the hearts and minds of the CIA
     clandestine operators and laid his own plans to destroy them.  The
     assassination of John Kennedy essentially became an act of survival
     for some of these individuals.
        Many citizens of America have forgotten that Richard Nixon was
     Vice President of the United States in 1959 and 1960.  As an old
     anti-communist from the Alger Hiss and Khrushchev debating days,
     Nixon was in the forefront of pressure for the Bay of Pigs invasion
     of Cuba.  What is also forgotten is that Nixon was largely
     responsible for the covert training of Cuban exiles by the CIA in
     preparation for the Bay of Pigs.  (He stated this in his book, "Six
     Crises".)
        NIXON'S LIES--OCTOBER 1960.  Mr. Nixon's capacity for truth is
     nowhere more clearly demonstrated than by the deliberate lies he
     told during the election campaign on national TV on October 21,
     1960.  He said in his book that the lies were told for a patriotic
     reason--to protect the covert operations planned for the Bay of
     Pigs at all costs.  The significance of this is that Mr. Nixon
     considers patriotism to be, in part, the protection of plans and
     actions of individuals that he considered to be working for the
     United States' best interests.
        The similarities between the actions of Everette Howard Hunt,
     Jr., James McCord, Bernard Barker, Frank Sturgis, and others in the
     1960 planning for the Bay of Pigs invasion and in the 1972 planning
     for the re-election of Richard M. Nixon are very striking.  In both
     cases, what the plotters themselves considered to be patriotic,
     anti-Communist actions were involved.  In 1960 the actions were
     directed against Fidel Castro, a man they hated as a Communist.  In
     1972 the actions were directed against Edward Kennedy, Edmund
     Muskie and George McGovern.  Bernard Barker stated the group's
     collective belief when he said after his arrest that, "We believe
     that an election of McGovern would be the beginning of a trend that
     would lead to socialism and communism, or whatever you want to call
     it."
        Nixon admitted lying to the American people to protect Hunt,
     Barker, Sturgis, and McCord in 1960.  The likelihood that he lied
     to protect them again in 1972 seems to be quite good.  There is
     some likelihood that he actually hired the same old crew he trusted
     from the Bay of Pigs days for the 1972 Watergate and other
     espionage activities.
        Here are the facts:


                    Nixon's Statements in "Six Crises"

        Richard Nixon stated in "Six Crises":  "The covert training of
     Cuban exiles by the CIA was due in substantial part, at least, to
     my efforts.  This had been adopted as a policy as a result of my
     direct support."[1]  "President Eisenhower had ordered the CIA to
     arm and train the exiles in May of 1960.  Nixon and his advisors
     wanted the CIA invasion to take place before the voters went to the
     polls on November 8, 1960."[2]
        While the Bay of Pigs operation was under the overall CIA
     direction of Allen Dulles, Richard M. Bissell, Jr. was the CIA man
     in charge, according to Ross & Wise.[3]  Charles Cabell,[4] the
     deputy director of the CIA, and a man with the code name Frank
     Bender, were also near the top of the operational planning.[5]


                              E. Howard Hunt

        Everette Howard Hunt, Jr. was in charge of the actual invasion.
     He used the code name, "Eduardo."  Bernard L. Barker, using the code
     name "Macho," worked for Hunt in the CIA Bay of Pigs planning.
     James McCord was an organizer for the invasion and was one of the
     highest ranking officials in the CIA.  Frank Sturgis, alias Frank
     Fiorini, was also involved in the Bay of Pigs operations.  Virgilio
     Gonzales was a CIA agent active in the Bay of Pigs.  So was Eugenio
     Martinez.  Charles Colson was a former CIA official who knew McCord
     and Hunt during the Bay of Pigs period.[6]
        Hunt, Barker, McCord, Sturgis, Gonzales, and Martinez were under
     indictment for the Watergate affair.  Colson was Nixon's special
     counsel who handled "touchy" political assignments.  According to
     "Time" magazine, Colson brought all of the others into the re-
     election committee espionage project at the request of Nixon.[7]
        In other words, it was basically the same group who worked for
     Nixon, Bissell and Co. in 1960 and who worked for Nixon, Colson and
     Co. in 1972.  They were all loyal, patriotic, anti-Communist, and
     anti-Castro CIA agents with covert (black) espionage training.
     They needed Nixon's protection in 1960 and 1972, and they received
     it both times.
        Here is how Nixon protected them in 1960.[8]


                        Kennedy-Nixon Debates, 1960

        John Kennedy and Richard Nixon engaged in a series of national
     TV debates during the 1960 campaign.  Kennedy was briefed by Allen
     Dulles, head of the CIA at Eisenhower's request, on secret CIA
     activities and international problems on July 23, 1960.  Nixon was
     not aware of the briefing contents and was not sure whether Dulles
     told Kennedy about the Bay of Pigs plans.  As it turned out Dulles
     had not mentioned the plans but had kept his remarks about Cuba
     rather general.
        On October 6, 1960, Kennedy gave his major speech on Cuba.  He
     said that events might create an opportunity for the U.S. to bring
     influence on behalf of the cause of freedom in Cuba.  He called for
     encouraging those liberty-loving Cubans who were leading the
     resistance against Castro.
        Nixon became very disturbed about this because he felt Kennedy
     was trying to pre-empt a policy which he claimed as his own.  Nixon
     ordered Fred Seaton, Secretary of the Interior, to call the White
     House and find out whether Dulles had briefed Kennedy on the Cuban
     invasion plans.  Seaton talked to General Andrew Goodpaster,
     Eisenhower's link to the CIA, who told Seaton that Kennedy did know
     about the Bay of Pigs plans.


                        Attack on Kennedy by Lying

        Nixon became incensed.  He said, "There was only one thing I
     could do.  The covert operation had to be protected at all costs.
     I must not even suggest by implication that the U.S. was rendering
     aid to rebel forces in and out of Cuba.  In fact, I must go to the
     other extreme:  I must attack the Kennedy proposal to provide such
     aid as wrong and irresponsible because it would violate our treaty
     commitments."[9]
        So Richard M. Nixon actually went on national TV (ABC) on
     October 21, 1960, knowing we were going to invade Cuba, and lied.
     During the fourth TV debate, Nixon attacked Kennedy's proposal as
     dangerously irresponsible and in violation of five treaties between
     the U.S. and Latin America, as well as the United Nations'
     Charter.[10]
        On October 22 at Muhlenberg College, Nixon really turned on the
     fabrication steam.  He said, "Kennedy called for--and get this--the
     U.S. Government to support a revolution in Cuba, and I say that
     this is the most shockingly reckless proposal ever made in our
     history by a presidential candidate during a campaign--and I'll
     tell you why . . ."
        The reason we should have taken with a grain of salt whatever
     words Nixon uttered about Watergate and Donald Segretti's espionage
     is clearly demonstrated in that October 22, 1960 speech.  He
     fiercely attacked John Kennedy for advocating a plan that he,
     Richard Nixon, secretly advocated and claimed as his own creation.
     He later had the sheer gall to brag about it in his own book as a
     very patriotic act.


                        Protection of Hunt and Co.

        How was Nixon protecting Hunt and company in 1972?  He was using
     the Justice Department and the Republican Congressmen, among
     others, to delay and dilute the prosecution of the Watergate seven.
     He had slowed down, suppressed, and all but stopped six separate
     investigations, suits, and trials of the affair.  Included were
     Wright Patman's House Banking Committee investigation, the FBI-
     Justice Department investigation, a White House investigation by
     John Dean, a General Accounting Office investigation, a suit by the
     Democratic Party, and a trial in criminal court of the seven
     invaders.  Only two trials or investigations had a chance of
     exposing the truth at that time.  One of these, a trial of Bernard
     Barker in Florida was not much help.  The other was an
     investigation promised by Senator Edward Kennedy and his Senate
     subcommittee.  It never occurred.  The action for impeachment came
     much later.
        Thus, the stage was set in 1961 for the group of powerful
     individuals who had planned the Bay of Pigs to gain revenge on John
     Kennedy who tried to change the overall direction of the U.S.
     battle against Communism.  After JFK refused to approve overt U.S.
     backing of the Bay of Pigs invasion, various individuals in the
     clandestine CIA forces vowed their revenge.
        In the spring of 1961, evidence had appeared indicating that
     Helms, Hunt, Sturgis and Barker tried to have JFK assassinated in
     Paris.[11]  When the attempt failed, a number of other plots and
     sub-plots developed through the next two years.  After JFK's
     blockade strategy against Castro during the missile crisis in 1962
     was implemented, some of the high-level CIA and armed forces people
     wanted even more to get him out of the White House.  They had
     favored a direct invasion or bombing of Cuba.
        And finally, when JFK found out about the CIA's plans for
     another invasion of Cuba in the spring and summer of 1963 and
     stopped them, they began in earnest to plan his death.



____________________

[1] "Six Crises," Richard M. Nixon, Doubleday, 1962.

[2] "The Invisible Government,"  Wise & Ross, Random House, 1964.

[3] Ibid.

[4] Brother of Earl Cabell, mayor of Dallas when Kennedy was assassinated.

[5] Ibid.

[6] "New York Times" articles on Watergate, June 18 to July 2, 1972.

[7] "Time" magazine, September 8, 1972.

[8] This episode is related in detail in "The Invisible Government."

[9] "Six Crises".

[10] "The Invisible Government."

[11] "400,000 Dollars Pour Abattre Kennedy a Paris," Camille Giles, Julliard
    Press, Paris 1973.







                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *




                                 Chapter 5
                     The Assassination of John Kennedy

        The assassination of President Kennedy can be considered one of
     a series of acts by the Power Control Group to regain the control
     they had lost when Nixon was defeated in 1960 and Kennedy
     threatened their existence.  The evidence pointing toward
     intelligence involvement and the use of a variety of intelligence
     techniques in the assassination is substantial.  Until and unless
     an investigation is conducted by a group with power and money
     equivalent to that of the Power Control Group, with the power to
     issue subpoenas and to protect witnesses, it will be very difficult
     to draw a completely accurate picture of the conspiracy to
     assassinate JFK.
        As a substitute, this chapter is a "probable reconstruction"--a
     scenario--about who killed John F. Kennedy.  Unlike the Warren
     Commission Report (another scenario), this report does not contain
     any physically impossible events, such as those connected with
     Commission Exhibit 399, the so-called "magic bullet."
        This scenario is based on (1) evidence gathered between 1968 and
     1975 by the Committee to Investigate Assassinations, Washington,
     D.C. and (2) evidence gathered between 1962 and 1975 by the author.
        The purpose of this scenario is as a starting point for study
     and verification by researchers, by Congressional Committees, and
     by their members and staffs.  This should be considered as a
     beginning hypothesis and scenario in contrast to the Warren and
     Rockefeller Commission scenarios.
        The best evidence available indicates the following events
     occurred in the summer and fall of 1963 and culminated in the
     assassination of President John F. Kennedy.  The basic evidence has
     been summarized in various articles published in "Computers and
     People" (formerly "Computers and Automation") since May 1970.[1]
     This can be considered as a guideline scenario which adheres to and
     explains all of the known factual evidence.


                               How It Began

        The conspiracy to assassinate John Kennedy began in a series of
     discussions held in New Orleans in the summer of 1963.  The men in
     the discussions were extremely angry that Kennedy had stopped plans
     and preparations for another invasion of Cuba (scheduled for the
     latter part of 1963.)  One of the instigators was David Ferrie, a
     CIA contract agent who had been training pilots in Guatemala for
     the invasion.  Meetings held in Ferrie's apartment in New Orleans
     were attended by Clay Shaw, William Seymour and several Cubans.
     Plans for assassinating President Kennedy developed out of those
     early meetings.  Others whose support was sought by the group
     included Guy Banister, Major L. M. Bloomfield, Loran Hall,
     Lawrence Howard, Sergio Arcacha Smith and Carlos Prio Socarras.


                               Oswald's Role

        During this period in the summer of 1963 Lee Harvey Oswald was
     working for Guy Banister on some anti-Castro projects and used the
     Communist cover of the Fair Play for Cuba Committee.  Oswald
     attended some of the meetings where JFK's assassination was
     discussed.
        Oswald either approached the FBI or they approached him in the
     later summer of 1963, and he began to tell the FBI about the plans
     of the group to assassinate JFK.  Oswald had been a secret
     informant for the FBI since mid-1962.


                                Mexico City

        In September, the group moved the scene of their planning to
     Mexico City.  There they solicited the assistance of Guy Gabaldin,
     a CIA agent.  Meetings were held in the apartment of Gabaldin,
     attended by Shaw, Ferrie, Seymour, Gabaldin and Oswald on at least
     three occasions.  Others were brought into the conspiracy at this
     point.  These included John Howard Bowen (alias Albert Osborne),
     Ronald Augustinovich, Mary Hope, Emilio Santana, Harry Dean,
     Richard Case Nagell, and "Frenchy" (an adventurer who had been
     working with Seymour, Santana, Ferrie, Howard and others on the
     Cuban invasion projects in the Florida Keys).  Fred Lee Crisman,
     Jim Hicks and Jim Braden (alias Eugene Hale Brading) were also
     recruited at this point.


                             Oswald, the Patsy

        Oswald continued to inform on the group to the FBI in Dallas.
     In mid- to late September the assassination group decided to make
     Oswald the patsy in the murder.  They had discussed the need for a
     patsy in the earliest meetings in New Orleans.  Billy Seymour, who
     resembled Oswald, was selected to use Oswald's name and to plant
     evidence in New Orleans, Dallas and Mexico, which could later be
     used to frame him.  In addition, another man under CIA surveillance
     in Mexico City also used Oswald's name in a probable attempt to
     make it appear that Oswald was headed for Cuba.  His name may have
     been Johnny Mitchell Deveraux.  His picture appears in the Warren
     Commission Volumes as CE 237.


                             Financial Support

        The team needed financial support for the assassination.  They
     received it from Carlos Prio Socarras in Miami, who brought more
     than 50 million dollars out of Cuba.  They also received money from
     Banister, and from three Texas millionaires who hated Kennedy:
     Sid Richardson, Clint Murchison, and Jean DeMenil (of the
     Schlumberger Co.).  The Murchison-Richardson contribution also
     included soliciting the assistance of high-level men in the Dallas
     police force.  They were powerful members of the Dallas Citizens
     Council that controlled the city at that time.


                          Plans for Three Cities

        The group in Mexico City planned to assassinate JFK in Miami,
     Chicago or Dallas, using different gunmen in each case.  The Miami
     plan failed because the Secret Service found out about it in
     advance and kept JFK out of the open.  The Chicago plan backfired
     when JFK cancelled his plans to attend the Army-Navy game at
     Soldiers Field in early November.  The group set up two
     assassination teams for Dallas.  One was in Dealey Plaza;  the
     second was near the International Trade Mart where JFK's luncheon
     speech was to be delivered.


                                CIA Support

        The best evidence of CIA (Deputy-Director of Plans) involvement
     is the fact that the majority of the known participants were
     contract agents or direct agents of the CIA.  In Mexico City, the
     meetings were held in the apartment of Guy Gabaldin, a CIA (DDP)
     agent, working for the Mexico City station chief.  Others attending
     the meetings who were CIA (DDP) contract or direct agents included
     Clay Shaw, David Ferrie, Albert Osborne, Harry Dean, Richard Case
     Nagell, Ronald Augustinovich, William Seymour, Emilio Santana and
     Fred Lee Crisman.  It is likely (but not yet provable by direct
     evidence) that the group sought and obtained from the acting or
     permanent CIA station chief in Mexico, assistance or approval to go
     ahead with assassination plans.  Tad Szulc claims that a CIA source
     can prove that E. Howard Hunt was acting station chief in Mexico
     City at the time of the Gabaldin apartment meetings (August and
     September 1963).  Hunt has denied under oath before the Rockefeller
     Commission that he was in Mexico.
        In 1967 Richard Helms told a group of CIA officials, including
     Victor Marchetti, that both Clay Shaw and David Ferrie were CIA
     (DDP) contract agents and that Shaw had to be given CIA protection
     and assistance in his New Orleans trial. This is a strong
     indication that Hunt and Helms gave "turn of the head" approval to
     the Shaw-Ferrie assassination plan as a minimum form of support.


                                  Dallas

        The assassination group, having failed in Miami and Chicago,
     moved an operational team into Dallas during the second week in
     November of 1963.  Shaw, Ferrie, Gabaldin and other high-level
     plotters travelled in other directions, establishing alibis as
     planned.  On November 22, Gabaldin was in Mexico City, Shaw was in
     San Francisco, and Ferrie was in New Orleans.  The team moving into
     Dallas included Albert Osborne, William Seymour, Emilio Santana,
     Frenchy, Fred Crisman, Jim Hicks, Jim Braden, and a new recruit
     from Los Angeles, Jack Lawrence.  There was also a back-up rifle
     team of Cubans to be used at a location near the International
     Trade Mart in the event something went wrong at Dealey Plaza.


                          Where the Teams Stayed

        The teams stayed at two locations in Dallas for two weeks.  One
     was a rooming house run by a woman named Tammie True.  During this
     period final preparations for the assassination in Dealey Plaza
     were made.  These included the collecting of and planting of
     evidence used to frame Oswald, the recruiting of the Dallas police
     participants, and the plans for the escape of the team members by
     car and by train.  The riflemen selected were William Seymour in
     the Depository Building, Jack Lawrence and Frenchy on the grassy
     knoll, and Emilio Santana in the Dal Tex building.  Jim Hicks was
     set up as radio coordinator and a man with each of the riflemen had
     a two-way radio.  They were Jim Braden, Dal Tex;  Fred Crisman,
     knoll;  unidentified American (tall tramp), knoll; and a man in the
     TSBD Building.  Osborne was in overall charge of the Dallas teams,
     but he did not go to Dealey Plaza.  A fifth gunman, known to
     researchers as the umbrella man, was stationed on the street with
     an umbrella weapon furnished by the CIA.  He was accompanied by
     another Cuban acting as a radio man.


                              Framing Oswald

        The people involved in framing Oswald included Seymour (who used
     his identity), someone who posed for two pictures holding a rifle,
     a photographer who took the pictures and someone who superimposed
     Oswald's head on the two negatives.  Also, someone who took
     Oswald's rifle from his garage and his pistol from his room, taking
     several bullets and shells with the pistol, fired three shells and
     one bullet through the rifle, and planted the rifle and rifle
     shells on the sixth floor of the TSBD and a rifle bullet at
     Parkland Hospital.  The pistol shells were given to William Seymour
     for planting later on.  The photographers also planted photos of
     General Walker's house and driveway to implicate Oswald in the
     Walker shooting.


                         Dallas Policemen Involved

        The policemen involved were J. D. Tippit, who was to drive two
     of the assassins, Seymour and his radio man, away in his police
     car;  Bill Alexander;  Jerry Hill;  Sergeant McDonald;  Lieutenant
     Montgomery;  Lieutenant Johnson;  and Lieutenant Batchelor, who
     escorted Jack Ruby into the jail to murder Oswald.
        McDonald was assigned to kill Oswald upon his arrest in the
     Texas Theatre.  Jerry Hill was involved in that event as well as in
     the planting of evidence against Oswald in the TSBD Building.
     Montgomery and Johnson were involved in planting the paper bag as
     evidence against Oswald.  Alexander and Batchelor were primarily
     responsible for making sure that Jack Ruby assassinated Oswald and
     that he didn't talk about it afterward.  Alexander was present on
     every occasion when Ruby was questioned or interviewed in the jail,
     in spite of Ruby's efforts to have him removed.


                 Other Persons Involved in Framing Oswald

        Also involved in framing Oswald were Marina Oswald;  her lawyer,
     James Martin;  and someone in the Dallas police force.  She was
     talked into three points of false testimony:  she said she took the
     two fake photos of Oswald with a camera she claimed was his.  She
     fabricated, or was handed, the false story about Oswald's attempt
     to shoot General Walker and taking two pictures of Walker's house
     with the same camera.  (Oswald did neither.)  She told a false
     story about a falling out she and Oswald supposedly had and
     exaggerated his mean treatment of their children.  There are good
     indications that these moves were made by the CIA operatives in the
     group who threatened to send Marina back to Russia.  (Marina's
     uncle was a high-level officer in the KGB.)


                               Dealey Plaza

        On the day of the assassination four men with rifles,
     accompanied by their radio men and several other team members,
     moved into Dealey Plaza.  Seymour and a radio man entered the TSBD
     Building through the freight entrance and worked their way to the
     roof.  Santana and Braden went into the Dal Tex building through
     the freight entrance on Houston St. and up a back staircase to the
     second floor.  Lawrence, Frenchy, Crisman and the tall tramp took
     up two positions on the grassy knoll.  Lawrence was inside the
     westernmost cupola after parking his car in the parking lot behind
     the knoll.  Frenchy, Crisman and the tall tramp were near the
     fence.  Jim Hicks was in the Adolphus Hotel a few blocks away,
     testing the two-way radio communication with the four radio men,
     until he proceeded to the Plaza and mingled with a large crowd
     (near the corner of Houston and Elm Streets).  The umbrella man
     stood near the Stemmons Freeway sign on Elm Street accompanied by
     his radio man.
        The other team members stationed themselves in the crowd (along
     Elm Street).  After the shots were fired, they circulated through
     the crowd in front of the TSBD on Elm Street, on the grassy knoll,
     and behind the TSBD Building, identifying themselves as Secret
     Service agents and asking witnesses and officials questions to find
     out whether the assassins had been detected.  There are clear
     photos of one of these men.  One other man was at the corner of the
     wall on the grassy knoll.


                                 The Shots

        Upon a visual and oral signal from the man at the wall and upon
     a radio command from Hicks, the team fired its first round of
     shots.  Crisman received the command from Hicks and caused Frenchy
     to fire a shot from a position behind the fence on the knoll, about
     twenty feet west of the corner of the fence.  This shot missed.
     The umbrella man fired a shot using his small-bore umbrella gun.
     When this shot struck JFK in the throat, the dart paralyzed JFK and
     later presented by Commander Humes to the FBI.[2]  The shot was
     fired at Zapruder frame 189:  JFK was behind a large oak tree,
     hidden from the sixth floor window of the TSBD Building.  On
     command from Braden, Emilio Santana fired his first shot two
     seconds later from the second floor window of the Dal Tex building
     at Z 225 after JFK came out from behind the sign in Zapruder's
     film.  The shot struck JFK in the back about 5 3/4" down from the
     collar line, penetrated to a depth of about two inches and stopped.
     The bullet fell out of JFK's back somewhere in or at the Parkland
     Hospital, or perhaps travelled down inside the body of the
     President, and was never recovered.
        William Seymour fired his shot from the west end of the TSBD
     Building upon command from his radio man between Z 230 and Z 237,
     after Santana's shot.  He used a Mauser rifle with no telescopic
     sight.  While he was aiming at JFK, he fired high and to the right,
     hitting John Connally in the back.  The bullet travelled through
     Connally's chest and then entered his left thigh.  The bullet fell
     out of his thigh in or near Parkland Hospital and was never
     recovered.  Governor Connally's wrist was not hit at that time.
        Jack Lawrence did not fire a shot in the first round because
     from his cupola position he did not have a clear shot.
        Hicks gave a second radio command for another round of shots as
     JFK passed the Stemmons Freeway sign.
        Emilio Santana fired his second shot between Z 265 and Z 275.
     The bullet narrowly missed JFK, passed over the top of his head and
     over the top of the limousine's windshield.  It travelled on to
     strike the south curb of Main Street, breaking off a piece of
     concrete which flew up and hit James Tague.  The bullet either
     disintegrated or flew into the area beyond the overpass.  It was
     not found.
        William Seymour may have fired a second shot which may have
     struck JFK in the upper right part of his head at Z 312.  That
     bullet disintegrated.
        Upon command from his radio man, Jack Lawrence fired his first
     shot from a pedestal on the west side of the south entrance to the
     western cupola on the grassy knoll.  The shot may have hit
     Connally's wrist.
        Frenchy fired the fatal shot through the trees from his position
     behind the fence.
        The Lawrence shot or possibly the second Seymour shot produced a
     bullet fragment that passed through Connally's right wrist at Z
     313.  At that time his wrist was elevated and nearly directly in
     front of JFK's head, in such a position that Connally's right palm
     was facing JFK as the governor fell into his wife's arms.  The
     fragment entered the front of his wrist and exited from the back.


                             Oswald's Actions

        Lee Harvey Oswald started November 22, 1963 with the knowledge
     that there might be an attempt on JFK's life during the day.  He
     had reported this possibility to the FBI in his informer's role
     five days earlier;  he undoubtedly thought the FBI and Secret
     Service would be protecting the President.  His communications with
     the assassination team had prepared him to meet with them in the
     Texas Theatre if anything happened that day.  There is also a
     possibility he received a telephone call immediately after the
     shots, telling him to go to the theatre.
        He had gone to his and Marina's rooms in Irving to pick up
     curtain rods for his bare windows in his Oak Cliff room.  He
     carried the curtain rods in a paper bag on his way to work that
     morning with Wesley Frazier.  He worked on the sixth floor of the
     TSBD as well as on the other floors that morning.  He helped a crew
     of men lay a new floor on the sixth floor, move a large number of
     book cartons and school supplies over to the eastern side of the
     floor, including some cartons near the southeastern window that
     faced Elm Street.
        Oswald went to the first floor of the building at approximately
     12:15 p.m. and returned to the second floor lunchroom just before
     12:30.  He was drinking a coke there at 12:31 when Officer Baker
     and Mr. Truly, the building manager, encountered him while rushing
     up the stairs from the first floor.  At the sight of Baker's gun
     drawn and seeing the commotion outside, he no doubt realized what
     had happened.[3]  He immediately left the building via the freight
     platform entrance on the northeast side and travelled to his
     rooming house via bus and taxi.  He picked up his pistol there and
     went directly to the Texas Theater where he met two of the
     assassination team and was sitting with them in the theatre when
     the police arrived.  One of these men may have been William
     Seymour.
        The Dallas police members of the team planned to shoot Oswald in
     the theatre while arresting him.  When he was arrested he did not
     realize at first that he had been framed.  When this began to
     become clear to him on Saturday, November 23, he remained confident
     that the FBI would get him out of the situation.  After all, he
     worked for them!


                                 Jack Ruby

        Jack Ruby, in addition to his Mafia involvements and other
     criminal activities, was also running guns to Cuba and carrying
     payoff money to other anti-Castro groups on behalf of various CIA-
     backed projects.  His involvement in the assassination of JFK
     appears to have been minor, even though he knew about it in
     advance.  In his night club Ruby met on several occasions with Clay
     Shaw, David Ferrie, and William Seymour.
        The group decided to assassinate Oswald in jail after the police
     failed to kill him in the Texas Theatre.  Alexander made
     arrangements to have Batchelor escort Ruby into the jail when it
     was known Oswald was being moved.  They arranged an audible signal
     (an auto horn) to let Batchelor and Ruby know when Oswald was
     coming down an elevator into the garage.  They came down an
     elevator opposite the one carrying Oswald.
        Clay Shaw gave Ruby his instructions to shoot Oswald through
     Breck Wall.  Shaw telephoned Wall from San Francisco and Wall
     called Ruby.  He was told it was an official CIA-sponsored act, in
     the best interests of the United States, and that he would be out
     of jail in a few days after his capture.


                             Planted Evidence

        The planting of the evidence against Oswald first began with
     William Seymour, who used Oswald's identity during September and
     October, 1963.  Next, the faked photographs of Oswald were created.
     Two of the team members used a camera of their own to take the two
     pictures of General Walker's house and the two shots of one of the
     men supposedly in Oswald's back yard.  They planted the pictures in
     Oswald's garage.  Next, they stole Oswald's rifle from the garage
     prior to November 22, fired several shots from it, and preserved
     three shells, one bullet, and several bullet fragments.
        They planted the rifle, the three shells, the bullet (399) and
     the bullet fragments in the TSBD, the hospital and the JFK
     limousine on November 22.  They also took Oswald's pistol at some
     time prior to November 22, fired several shots from it and saved
     the shells.  William Seymour, after shooting policeman Tippit, ran
     away in such a manner as to attract attention, throwing the shells
     from Oswald's gun into the air as he ran so that witnesses would
     see them.  (The shells matched Oswald's pistol.  None of the
     bullets matched.)
        All of the work with Oswald's rifle, pistol, and the fake photos
     was probably done at the same time.  The rifle, pistol and
     Communist newspapers had to be available together for the backyard
     photos.  The faking of the photographs, the firing of rifle and
     pistol, the retrieval of the shells from rifle and pistol and of
     bullet 399 and the bullet fragments from the rifle all required
     enough time that the event occurred well in advance of the
     assassination .


                               Escape Plans

        As mentioned before, plans were made for the team to escape by
     car, train, and airplane.  Evidence shows:


         1.  A white car was parked straddling a log barrier behind
             the western cupola on the grassy knoll.  It left that
             spot one minute after the shots were fired and drove
             eastward on the Elm Street extension in front of the
             TSBD.

         2.  A white station wagon driving west on Elm Street
             stopped at the foot of the grassy knoll at 12:40 p.m.,
             ten minutes after the shots were fired.  It picked up a
             man who looked like Oswald and drove under the triple
             overpass.

         3.  A railroad train carrying three "tramps" began to leave
             the freight train area west and north of the TSBD at
             around one o'clock, thirty minutes after the shots.
             The train was under the tower control of Lee Bowers and
             was stopped by him.  The tramps were arrested.

         4.  A police car stopped in front of Oswald's rooming house
             and honked twice around 1:10 p.m.

         5.  Policeman Tippit's patrol car was far out of position
             in the Oak Cliff area near Ruby and Oswald's rooming
             houses.  Tippit was shot by two men, one of whom was
             Billy Seymour.

         6.  A small airplane was sitting at the Redbird Airport, a
             location in the same direction as Oak Cliff, a little
             further out from Dealey Plaza.  Its engines were
             running.  It was ready for takeoff at 1 p.m.

         7.  David Ferrie went to Houston, Texas on the afternoon of
             November 22, driving at high speed through bad
             thunderstorms to get there.  He was positioned at a pay
             telephone at an ice skating rink near the Houston
             airport, until receiving a phone call there.  After
             that he returned to New Orleans.


                               Escape Routes

        These escape plans were modified after the assassination.  It
     became unnecessary for any of the Dealey Plaza participants to
     escape by airplane.  The framing of Oswald and the failure of the
     Secret Service or FBI to detect any of the escaping gunmen or their
     assistants permitted these changes.  One of the men in the Dealey
     Plaza--probably pretending to be a Secret Service agent--reported
     an "all clear" situation to Shaw in San Francisco.  Shaw notified
     Ferrie that they didn't need an airplane to escape with while
     Ferrie was waiting in Houston.  Ferrie changed his plans and drove
     back to New Orleans.
        The gunmen who did escape followed these routes:  Jack Lawrence
     got into his car parked behind the cupola and either drove or was
     driven back to his cover job location at the automobile agency.  He
     left almost immediately afterward and travelled to North Carolina.
     Frenchy ran back to the freight car area and climbed into one of
     the box cars sitting on a siding northwest of the TSBD.  He was
     arrested at 1 p.m. by Officers Harkness, Bass and Wise, but was
     released by Sheriff Elkins later in the afternoon.  Santana walked
     out the back entrance of the Dal Tex building and may have joined
     Seymour in a white station wagon on Elm Street at 12:40 p.m.
     Seymour left the roof of the TSBD via a back stairway, exited from
     the freight entrance in the rear of the building, and walked on
     Houston Street past the Elm Street extension.  He walked down the
     grassy knoll to Elm Street where he was picked up at 12:40 p.m. by
     the white station wagon.
        The other Dealey Plaza participants, Crisman, a tall tramp,
     Braden and Hicks escaped by various means.  Braden was arrested and
     released.  Hicks drove home.  Crisman and the tall tramp followed
     Frenchy's route into the box cars.


                             Tippit Shooting

        David Belin of the Warren and Rockefeller Commission is fond of
     saying, "Lee Harvey Oswald killed policeman Tippit.  Since the
     case against Oswald for the Tippit slaying is so strong, it
     follows that Oswald also shot the President."  The case against
     Oswald in the Tippit murder is as weak as the case against him in
     the JFK assassination.  The most important evidence showing that
     Seymour and another one of the assassination team shot Tippit is
     the fact that six witnesses, ignored by the Warren Commission, saw
     two men shoot Tippit.  One of them resembled Oswald.  They ran
     away from the scene in opposite directions.  Seymour ran toward the
     Texas Theater, throwing the planted shells up in the air so that
     witnesses would see and recover them.  (This act would convince
     most people that Oswald did not shoot Tippit.)  The other assassin
     ran in the opposite direction.  There is some indication that
     Seymour entered the theater in a manner to draw attention and then
     left before the Oswald arrest.  While the shells recovered were
     found to match Oswald's pistol, none of the bullets recovered from
     Tippit's body matched.


                 Comments and Congressional Actions Needed

        The above scenario comes much closer to explaining what happened
     to John Kennedy than either the Warren Commission Report or the
     Rockefeller Commission report.  It matches the known evidence from
     the two prime sources, the Warren Commission files in the National
     Archives, and the evidence produced by the Garrison investigation
     (most of which was turned over the the Committee to Investigate
     Assassinations, Washington, D.C.).
        However, without subpoena power, and with extremely limited
     resources, no group of citizens such as the Committee or Mark
     Lane's Citizens Commission can determine the ultimate truth about
     the assassination.
        Only a properly constituted Congressional committee or group
     with resources and subpoena power, and with the power and courage
     to combat the Power Control Group involved in the assassination and
     its cover-up, whoever they may be, can reach the truth.
        This chapter has been prepared as a guideline for such a
     committee, rather than as the ultimate solution.
        It should be utilized in conjunction with two other documents
     already submitted to the four Congressional groups interested in
     the case.  The groups are:


        (1)  The Senate;

        (2)  The House Special Committee on Intelligence;

        (3)  Thomas Downing, Representative from Virginia, who
             introduced House Resolution 498 to reopen the JFK
             assassination investigation;

        (4)  Henry Gonzalez, Representative from Texas, who
             introduced House Resolution 204 to reopen the
             assassination inquiries on John and Robert Kennedy,
             Martin Luther King, and George Wallace.


                             The Two Documents

     1. "Recommendations for the Senate and House Committee's
        Investigations of Illegal and Subversive Domestic Activities of
        the CIA and FBI," memorandum by Richard E. Sprague (submitted
        to them).
     2. "The Assassination of President John F. Kennedy:  the
        Involvement of the Central Intelligence Agency in the Plans and
        the Cover-Up," by Richard E. Sprague, in "People and the
        Pursuit of Truth," May, 1975.


                             Dramatis Personae

     Bill Alexander - Assistant to District Attorney Wade, Dallas
         County.
     Ronald Augustinovich - CIA agent.  Participated in Mexico City
         meetings.
     Officer Marion Baker- Dallas motorcycle police officer entering
         Texas School Book Depository after shots.
     Guy Banister - Head of clandestine CIA station in New Orleans -
         ran Banister Detective Agency.  Front for anti-Castro Cuban
         groups.  Former FBI agent and member of New Orleans police.
         Died of "heart attack" June 1964.  David Ferrie worked for
         him.  Oswald used his office and address.
     Officer Billy Bass - Dallas police officer;  arrested "tramps" in
         Dealey Plaza.
     Lt. Batchelor - Dallas police lieutenant.
     David Belin - Warren Commission lawyer.
     Major L. M. Bloomfield - Resident of Montreal, Canada.  Member of
         board of Centro Mondiale Commerciale, CIA front-organization
         in Rome.  Visited by Ferrie and Shaw in fall 1963.
     John Howard Bowen - CIA agent.  Alias Albert Osborne.  Long
         clandestine record.  On bus to Mexico with Oswald.
         Participated in Mexico City meetings.
     Lee Bowers - Railroad tower control operator, Dealey Plaza.  Died
         in curious accident.
     Jim Braden - Alias Eugene Hale Brading.  Mafia hoodlum and CIA
         contract agent.  Acted as radio man in Dealey Plaza.
     CIA - Central Intelligence Agency.
     Fred Lee Crisman - OSS and CIA domestic agent from Tacoma,
         Washington.  Participated with Frenchy and others as radio
         man in Dealey Plaza.
     Harry Dean - CIA operative in Mexico City.
     Jean DeMenil - Louisiana and Texas industrialist.
     Johnny Mitchell Deveraux - CIA agent, Mexico City.  May have
         impersonated Oswald in Mexico.
     Sheriff Harold Elkins - Dallas County Deputy Chief.
     FBI - Federal Bureau of Investigation, then headed by J. Edgar
         Hoover.
     David Ferrie - Resident of New Orleans French Quarter.  Pilot for
         Eastern Airlines.  Bay of Pigs, CIA contractor for pilot
         training and clandestine flights.  Associate of Clay Shaw,
         Lee Harvey Oswald, Jack Ruby;  murdered Feb. 1967;  death
         termed "suicide" by officials.
     "Frenchy" - Real name(s) not yet determined.  French Canadian
         adventurer.  CIA contract agent.  Training for second
         invasion of Cuba in Florida Keys.  Knew Howard, Hall,
         Seymour, Hemming, and Santana.  Fired shots.  Also involved
         in King assassination.
     Guy Gabaldin - Former OSS operative and CIA agent in Mexico City.
         Movie made about his World War II exploits, Jeffrey Hunter
         played Gabaldin role.  Assassination planning done in his
         Mexico City apartment.
     Loran Hall - Anti-Castro adventurer from southern California.  One
         of three men who visited Sylvia Odio and said JFK would be
         assassinated.  Close friend of Lawrence Howard, William
         Seymour and other no-name key adventurers.  Raising funds for
         them in 1963.
     Sgt. Harkness - Dallas police sergeant.
     Richard Helms - Deputy Director - Plans, CIA, in 1963.
     Jerry Patrick Hemming - CIA agent and trainer of mercenaries at
         no-name key.
     Jim Hicks - Radio specialist from Dallas.  Was radio communications
         coordinator in Dealey Plaza.  Placed in mental hospital run by
         the military.
     Jerry Hill - Police sergeant, Dallas.
     Mary Hope - Friend of Augustinovich.  Participated in Mexico City
         meetings on the assassination.
     Lawrence Howard - Anti-Castro adventurer.  No-name key group.
         Friend of Loran Hall and William Seymour.  Visited Sylvia Odio.
         Kept no-name key photo album.  Provided Garrison with pictures.
     E. Howard Hunt - CIA agent.  Acting station chief CIA clandestine
         station in Mexico City in 1963.
     Lt. Johnson - Dallas police lieutenant.
     Jack Lawrence - Resident of West Virginia and southern California.
         Minuteman and adventurer.  Fired shots.
     James Martin - Marina Oswald's business manager.
     Sgt. McDonald - Police sergeant, Dallas.
     Lt. Montgomery - Dallas police lieutenant;  helped frame Oswald .
     Clint Murchison - Texas oil millionaire.
     Richard Case Nagell - CIA operative in Mexico City;  testified
         before Congressional Committees.
     OSS - Office of Strategic Services.
     Lee Harvey Oswald - Dallas and New Orleans resident.  CIA and FBI
         agent and informer.  Patsy in assassination.
     Marina Oswald - Wife of Lee Harvey Oswald.  Helped to frame her
         husband.
     Sid Richardson - Texas oil millionaire.
     Jack Ruby - Mafia connections.  Anti-Castro CIA contracts.  Owner
         of Dallas night club.  Recruited to shoot Oswald.
     Emilio Santana - Cuban adventurer.  Anti-Castro, in no-name key
         group.  Was in Dealey Plaza firing shots.
     William Seymour - Mexican-American adventurer and hired killer.  On
         no-name key training for second invasion of Cuba in 1963.
         Impersonated Lee Harvey Oswald and resembled Oswald.  Fired
         shots in Dealey Plaza.  Killed Officer Tippit.
     Clay Shaw - New Orleans French Quarter resident.  Manager
         International Trade Mart, CIA contract agent, member board of
         directors of CIA organization, Centro Mondiale Commericale.
         Murdered in 1974.  Living double life as Clay Bertrand, friend
         of David Ferrie.
     Sergio Arcacha Smith - Anti-Castro Cuban.  Devoted to overthrowing
         Castro.  CIA contract agent.  Close to Guy Banister, Ferrie,
         and New Orleans CIA operations.  Fled to Texas, escaped
         Garrison subpoena.  Protected by Governor John Connally from
         extradition.
     Carlos Prio Socarras - Former premier of Cuba.  Violent Anti-Castro
         millionaire.  Backed Cuban invasion plans and CIA efforts.
         Lived in Miami area.  Murdered in 1977.
     James Tague - Spectator in Dealey Plaza, hit by piece of curbing
         thrown up by bullet striking near him.
     J. D. Tippit - Dallas policeman, shot on November 22, 1963.  Co-
         conspirator in assassination, Mafia and CIA functionary.
     Tammie True - Owner of CIA safe house in Dallas.
     Roy Truly - Manager of Texas School Book Depository.
     TSBD - Texas School Book Depository Building in Dealey Plaza,
         Dallas, from which Oswald was supposed to have fired shots at
         President John F. Kennedy.
     General Walker - Right-wing former Army General.  Resident of
         Dallas.  Supposedly shot at by Oswald.
     Breck Wall - Friend of Clay Shaw and Jack Ruby.
     Marvin Wise - Dallas police officer, arrested "tramps" in Dealey
         Plaza.



____________________

[1] For a complete listing of articles on political assassinations in the
   United States, published in "Computers and People" (formerly
   "Computers and Automation"), see the issues of "People and the Pursuit
   of Truth," May 1975, p. 6, and June, 1975, p. 5, published by Berkeley
   Enterprises, Inc., 815 Washington St., Newtonville, Mass. 02160.

[2] "1978 Los Angeles Free Press" - Special Report No 1, page 16, copy of
   receipt given to Commander James J. Humes MC, USN "for Missile removed
   on this date (Nov. 22, 1963)," signed by Francis X. O'Neill, Jr.,
   James W. Sibert, FBI Agents.

   Also "Postmortem," by Harold Weisberg, page 266, the missile receipt.

[3] As mentioned earlier, it is also possible that one of the team called
   him from a telephone inside the TSBD.







                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *
--
                                            daveus rattus

                                  yer friendly neighborhood ratman

                              KOYAANISQATSI

  ko.yaa.nis.qatsi (from the Hopi Language)  n.  1. crazy life.  2. life
      in turmoil.  3. life out of balance.  4. life disintegrating.
        5. a state of life that calls for another way of living.
Path: ns-mx!uunet!olivea!sgigate!odin!ratmandu.esd.sgi.com!dave
From: [email protected] (dave "who can do? ratmandu!" ratcliffe)
Newsgroups: alt.activism,alt.conspiracy,alt.conspiracy.jfk
Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (3/11)
Summary: we were robbed of our capability of electing a president we wanted
Keywords: part 3 of 11:  chapter 6 thru chapter 8
Message-ID: <[email protected]>
Date: 9 Jun 92 16:15:56 GMT
Sender: [email protected] (Net News)
Organization: Silicon Graphics, Inc.
Lines: 632
Xref: ns-mx alt.activism:27381 alt.conspiracy:15473 alt.conspiracy.jfk:1570
Nntp-Posting-Host: ratmandu.esd.sgi.com


                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *




                                 Chapter 6
                 The Assassinations of Robert Kennedy and
                        Dr. Martin Luther King and
                  Lyndon B. Johnson's Withdrawal in 1968

        The Power Control Group faced several dangers in 1968.  While
     President Johnson had cooperated fully with their desires in Viet
     Nam and in other parts of the world, he had not met their
     requirements in other areas.  He had gone too far in appeasing the
     blacks and had shown some signs of giving in to the young people in
     America in early 1968.  Through threats to expose his role in
     covering up the truth about the JFK assassination or personal
     threats to the safety of his family, the Group forced his
     withdrawal from the 1968 election race.  Their plan now was to
     install Richard Nixon as president at all costs.
        Robert Kennedy and Dr. King posed real threats to this plan.
     Dr. King was beginning a movement in the direction of a coalition
     with Malcom X followers and other black militant groups.  He was
     speaking out against the Viet Nam war.  His influence might help
     defeat Nixon at the polls.  So the Power Control Group created an
     environment in which he could be assassinated by his arch enemies.
        The FBI and J. Edgar Hoover had become a vital part of the Power
     Control Group by 1968.  Hoover had no love for King and was
     harrassing him in several ways.  The Power Control Group
     undoubtedly let Hoover know that it wouldn't be a bad idea to have
     King out of the way before the election campaigns really warmed up.
     They also passed the word along to some of the groups who were out
     to murder King that the crime would probably not be stopped.
     Fletcher Prouty has described this approach in some detail.[1]  The
     net result of these actions was the assassination of Dr. King by a
     group of wealthy white bigots who employed two of the intelligence
     community's own expert assassins.  One of these men, Frenchy, had
     fired shots at JFK.  The other, Jack Youngblood, was a soldier of
     fortune and CIA contract killer.  They recruited James Earl Ray and
     set him up as a patsy.
        The FBI removed King's protection in Memphis and after the
     assassination they took the case out of the hands of the local
     police to control and suppress the evidence of conspiracy.  Hoover
     did not know exactly who was going to assassinate King or where.
     He did not know in advance who the patsy was supposed to be.  The
     best evidence in support of this is that from April to June 1968
     the identity of the patsy was a mystery, first unidentified, then
     identified as Eric Starvo Galt, then as Raymond Sneyd, and finally
     as James Earl Ray.  If Hoover had been in on the plan, Ray's
     identity would probably have been revealed immediately.  In fact,
     the scenario might have been similar to the JFK case, with Ray
     being killed in a shoot-out.
        After Ray was identified and arrested in London, Hoover and the
     Justice Department had to manufacture some evidence to get Ray back
     to the U.S.  They had no qualms about bribing one witness, Charlie
     Stevens, to do this.  They forced him to say he had seen Ray.  Then
     a new problem arose.  Ray began telling the truth to his lawyer and
     a writer, William Bradford Huie.  He almost revealed Frenchy's true
     identity.  The Power Control Group, led by J. Edgar Hoover, solved
     this problem by getting rid of Ray's lawyer, Arthur Hanes, and they
     hired Percy Foreman to keep Ray quiet.  They also were forced to
     pay off or frighten off author Huie who had by then become
     convinced Ray was telling him the truth.  Huie had found several
     witnesses who had seen Ray and Frenchy together.
        The group got Foreman to talk Ray into pleading guilty and Huie
     to retract his conspiracy talk and publish an article and a book
     claiming Ray was the lone assassin.  Ever since Ray was put away
     for 99 years, the FBI and the Power Control Group have been hard at
     work covering up the truth, bribing or influencing judges who have
     heard Ray's appeals for a trial, publishing disinformation like
     Gerold Franck's book, "An American Assassin," suppressing evidence,
     and placing key witnesses in psychiatric wards.  It is still going
     on.  They have killed at least one reporter--Louis Lomax--who was
     getting too close to the truth.  The local D.A., Phil Canale, was
     brought into the conspiracy along with Percy Foreman, Judge Battle,
     Fred Vinson (who extradited Ray, using Stevens' false affidavit),
     and local authorities who committed Grace Walden Stevens to a
     mental institution because she knew Charlie had been dead drunk and
     saw nothing.
        The mechanics of the assassination are as follows:  Youngblood
     and Frenchy recruited Ray in Montreal for smuggling drugs into the
     U.S. from Mexico and Canada.  They recruited him in the
     assassination plan in such a way as to make him believe they were
     smuggling guns to Cuba.
        Frenchy (Ray knew him as Raoul) set up Ray as a patsy by
     planting evidence with Ray's prints on it near the fake firing
     point.  He persuaded Ray to rent a room opposite Dr. King's motel,
     to buy a rifle with telescopic sight, and a white Mustang, and park
     the Mustang outside the rooming house to wait for Frenchy to come
     out.  Youngblood stationed himself on a grassy knoll beneath the
     rooming house where Frenchy was located.  When King came out on his
     balcony, Youngblood killed him with one shot fired at an upward
     angle.  Frenchy ran from his perch overlooking King's balcony.  He
     made plenty of noise to attract attention, and dropped a bag full
     of items with Ray's prints on them in front of an amusement parlor
     next door to the rooming house.
        Frenchy must have had some anxious moments then because Ray had
     driven the Mustang to a gas station a few blocks away to have a low
     tire pumped up.  Three witnesses remember his being there.  When
     Ray returned, not yet knowing what had happened, Frenchy told him
     to drive away toward the edge of town where Frenchy got out of the
     back seat.  Ray drove on to Atlanta with the intention of meeting
     Frenchy there.
        Meanwhile, Youngblood mingled with the crowd under King's
     balcony and then faded away.  A false trail was created by another
     member of the team who drove away in a second white Mustang and
     then created a fake auto chase on the police band radio.
     Youngblood was tracked down by various reporters in early 1976 and
     began negotiating to tell his story for a very high price.
     Meanwhile, judge after judge and court after court keep turning
     down Bernard Fensterwald and James Cesar, Ray's new lawyers, who
     appealed for a new trial.
        All of the information above has been reported with factual
     evidence backing it up in several articles, one book, and at Ray's
     legal hearing for a new trial in Memphis in 1975.[2]
        After Dr. King was eliminated, the Power Control Group faced a
     much greater threat.  Robert Kennedy began his quest for the
     presidency.  There was little doubt in the minds of anyone in the
     Group that Kennedy would be nominated as Democratic candidate at
     the convention, and would have a very good chance of defeating
     Richard Nixon.  This would be a near certainty if Eugene McCarthy
     decided to drop out and support Senator Kennedy.  Robert Kennedy
     represented a double threat to the Group in that he would
     undoubtedly expose them after becoming president and seize control.
        The plan they adopted was again to create an environment in
     which it would be easy for an enemy like the Minutemen or the Mafia
     or certain local hate groups in California to assassinate RFK and
     get away with it by setting up another patsy.  Available at the
     time was a CIA agent planted inside the Los Angeles police
     department.  Strong influence was brought to bear on chief of
     police, Ed Davis, to remove all official protection for Senator
     Kennedy in the Ambassador Hotel.  Arrangements were made for the
     Ace Guard Service to supply three extreme right wing, militant
     guards at the hotel to guard the Senator after his victory speech.
     One of these was Thane Eugene Cesar, a known Kennedy hater and
     friend of a group of Southern California Minutemen.  He was also
     almost certainly a CIA contract agent or "blind" assassin.  At the
     same time another group was recruited to hypnotize Sirhan Sirhan
     and to program him for firing some shots in Robert Kennedy's
     direction.  Two hypnotists and at least three other people were
     involved in the framing of Sirhan.
        Cesar killed Robert Kennedy from behind while Sirhan was firing
     under hypnosis from in front of the Senator.  His programmed signal
     was given by a girl in a polka dot dress and another young Arabic
     man with them in the pantry.
        After the crime, the FBI, the CIA agent (Manny Pena), the
     District Attorney's office (Evelle Younger and Joseph Busch) and
     the Los Angeles Police Department (Ed Davis, Robert Houghton and
     others), knowing the truth, all teamed up to suppress all other
     evidence except that which was aimed at framing Sirhan.  The Power
     Control Group has since wielded its influence to keep the RFK case
     under wraps.  They pushed legislation through the California
     legislature to lock up the evidence.  They put Thomas Noguchi, the
     L.A. County Coroner who wouldn't keep quiet about the autopsy
     evidence which proved conspiracy, in an insane asylum.  They
     arranged for the FBI report on the assassination to be classified
     and locked up.  They killed at least one person who knew what had
     happened. They controlled the media on the subject, especially the
     "Los Angeles Times" through its owner, Norman Chandler, and his
     friend Evelle Younger, who became California State Attorney
     General.
        After Al Lowenstein, Jerry Brown, Paul Schrade, Vincent
     Bugliosi, Robert Vaughn, Tom Bradley and others began to try to
     expose the truth, the Group fought back by setting up their own
     expert ballistics panel and buying or frightening them into
     distorting the evidence proving there were two guns fired.  The
     Group is certainly not through yet.  More planted disinformation
     can be expected and more bribing of judges and expert witnesses.
     There may be more killings.  Cesar's life and the lives of the two
     hypnotists won't be worth much if they ever start talking.[3]



____________________


[1] "The Fourth Force" -- L. Fletcher Prouty -- "Gallery Magazine" --
   December, 1975

[2] "Frame Up:  The Martin Luther King/James Earl Ray Case" -- Harold
   Weisberg -- E.P. Dutton -- 1971

   "The Assassination of Reverend Martin Luther King, Jr." -- R.E.
   Sprague -- "Computers & Automation," December 1970

   "The Assassination of Reverend Martin Luther King, Jr. --  Parts I to
   II" -- Wayne Chastain -- "Computers & Automation," December 1974.

[3] Most of the above information has been published in a series of
   articles and in two books and one movie.

   "The Assassination of Senator Robert F. Kennedy" -- R.E. Sprague --
   "Computers & Automation" -- September 1972 and October 1970

   "RFK Must Die" -- Robert Blair Kaiser -- 1970

   "The Assassination of Robert F. Kennedy, A Searching Look at the
   Conspiracy and Cover-Up 1968-1978" -- William Turner and John
   Christian -- 1978

   "The Second Gun" --  Documentary Movie -- Ted Charach -- American
   Films -- Beverly Hills







                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *




                                 Chapter 7
          The Control of the Kennedys - Threats & Chappaquiddick

        Through the years the most common question of all has been:  "If
     there was a conspiracy in the JFK assassination, why didn't Robert
     Kennedy find out about it and take some action?  And if there was a
     conspiracy in the RFK assassination why haven't Ted Kennedy and
     Ethel Kennedy done something about it?"  No one except the Kennedys
     know the answers to these questions for sure.  However, there are
     plenty of clues and some other Power Control Group actions to
     provide the answers to us.
        First of all, thanks to Jackie Kennedy Onassis' butler in
     Athens, Greece, Christain Cafarakis, we know why Jackie did nothing
     after her husband's death.  In a book published in 1972, Cafarakis
     tells about an investigation Jackie had conducted by a famous New
     York City detective agency into the assassination of JFK in 1964
     and 1965.[1]  It was financed by Aristotle Onassis and resulted in
     a report in the spring of 1965 telling who the four gunmen were and
     who was behind them.  Jackie planned to give the report to LBJ but
     was stopped by a threat from the Power Control Group to kill her
     and her children.  Ted, Bobby and other family members knew about
     the report and the threat.
        The second clue is Chappaquiddick.  A careful examination of the
     real evidence in this event shows that Ted Kennedy was framed in
     the killing of Mary Joe Kopechne and then his life and his
     children's lives threatened if he ever told the truth about what
     happened.  The facts in the case and the conclusions that can be
     drawn from them are contained in a book by Boston researcher Robert
     Cutler.[2]
        The third clue is Ted's withdrawal from the presidential race in
     November 1975.  It is a fact that all of his and Robert's children
     were being protected by the Secret Service for five days in
     November 1975.  A threat had been made against the children's lives
     unless he officially announced his withdrawal.  He made the
     announcement and has stuck to it ever since.  The Secret Service
     protection ended the day after he made the announcement.
        It does not seem likely that Senator Kennedy would withdraw from
     the race because of a threat from a lone nut or from some obscure
     group.  He remembers the 1965 threat and Chappaquiddick very well.
     He knows about the Power Control Group and he knows their enormous
     capability.  He knows what they did to his brothers.  He has no
     choice but to hope that somehow, sometime, the Group will be
     exposed.  But he dares not let them believe he would ever have
     anything to do with it.  Publicly he will always have to support
     the Warren Commission and continue to state that he will not run
     for president.  Privately he is forced to ask his closest friends
     and his relatives not to get involved with new investigations, and
     to help protect his children.  Some of them know the truth.  Others
     do not, and are puzzled by his behavior.  They go along with it
     under the assumption that he has good and sufficient reasons not to
     open the can of worms represented by the conspiracies in his
     brother's deaths.
        The Power Control Group faced up to the Ted Kennedy and Kennedy
     family problem very early.  They used the threat against the
     Kennedy children's lives very effectively between 1963 and 1968 to
     silence Bobby and the rest of the family and friends who knew the
     truth.  It was necessary to assassinate Bobby in 1968 because with
     the power of the presidency he could have prevented the Group from
     harming the children.  When Teddy began making moves to run for
     president in 1969 for the 1972 election, the Group decided to put
     some real action behind their threats.  Killing Teddy in 1969 would
     have been too much.  They selected a new way of eliminating him as
     a candidate.  They framed him with the death of a young girl, and
     threw sexual overtones in for good measure.
        Here is what happened according to Cutler's analysis of the
     evidence.  The Group hired several men and at least one woman to be
     at Chappaquiddick during the weekend of the yacht race and the
     planned party on the island.  They ambushed Ted and Mary Jo after
     they left the cottage and knocked Ted out with blows to his head
     and body.  They took the unconscious or semi-conscious Kennedy to
     Martha's Vineyard and deposited him in his hotel room.  Another
     group took Mary Jo to the bridge in Ted's car, force fed her with a
     knock out potion of alcoholic beverage, placed her in the back
     seat, and caused the car to accelerate off the side of the bridge
     into the water.  They broke the windows on one side of the car to
     insure the entry of water;  then they watched the car until they
     were sure Mary Jo would not escape.
        Mary Jo actually regained consciousness and pushed her way to
     the top of the car (which was actually the bottom of the car--it
     had landed on its roof) and died from asphyxiation.  The group with
     Teddy revived him early in the morning and let him know he had a
     problem.  Possibly they told him that Mary Jo had been kidnapped.
     They told him his children would be killed if he told anyone what
     had happened and that he would hear from them.  On Chappaquiddick,
     the other group made contact with Markham and Gargan, Ted's cousin
     and lawyer.  They told both men that Mary Jo was at the bottom of
     the river and that Ted would have to make up a story about it, not
     revealing the existence of the group.  One of the men resembled Ted
     and his voice sounded something like Ted's.  Markham and Gargan
     were instructed to go the the Vineyard on the morning ferry, tell
     Ted where Mary Jo was, and come back to the island to wait for a
     phone call at a pay station near the ferry on the Chappaquiddick
     side.
        The two men did as they were told and Ted found out what had
     happened to Mary Jo that morning.  The three men returned to the
     pay phone and received their instructions to concoct a story about
     the "accident" and to report it to the police.  The threat against
     Ted's children was repeated at that time.
        Ted, Markham and Gargan went right away to police chief Arena's
     office on the Vineyard where Ted reported the so-called "accident."
     Almost at the same time scuba diver John Farror was pulling Mary Jo
     out of the water, since two boys who had gone fishing earlier that
     morning had spotted the car and reported it.
        Ted called together a small coterie of friends and advisors
     including family lawyer Burke Marshall, Robert MacNamara, Ted
     Sorenson, and others.  They met on Squaw Island near the Kennedy
     compound at Hyannisport for three days.  At the end of that time
     they had manufactured the story which Ted told on TV, and later at
     the inquest.  Bob Cutler calls the story, "the shroud."  Even the
     most cursory examination of the story shows it was full of holes
     and an impossible explanation of what happened.  Ted's claim that
     he made the wrong turn down the dirt road toward the bridge by
     mistake is an obvious lie.  His claim that he swam the channel back
     to Martha's Vineyard is not believable.  His description of how he
     got out of the car under water and then dove down to try to rescue
     Mary Jo is impossible.  Markham and Gargan's claims that they kept
     diving after Mary Jo are also unbelievable.
        The evidence for the Cutler scenario is substantial.  It begins
     with the marks on the bridge and the position of the car in the
     water.  The marks show that the car was standing still on the
     bridge and then accelerated off the edge, moving at a much higher
     speed than Kennedy claimed.  The distance the car travelled in the
     air also confirms this.  The damage to the car on two sides and on
     top plus the damage to the windshield and the rear view mirror
     stanchion[3] prove that some of the damage had to have been
     inflicted before the car left the bridge.
        The blood on the back and on the sleeves of Mary Jo's blouse
     proves that a wound was inflicted before she left the bridge.[4]
     The alcohol in her bloodstream proves she was drugged, since all
     witnesses testified she never drank and did not drink that night.
     The fact that she was in the back seat when her body was recovered
     indicates that is where she was when the car hit the water.  There
     was no way she could have dived downward against the inrushing
     water and moved from the front to the back seat underneath the
     upside-down seat back.
        The wounds on the back of Ted Kennedy's skull, those just above
     his ear and the large bump on the top indicate he was knocked out.
     His actions at the hotel the next morning show he was not aware of
     Mary Jo's death until Markham and Gargan arrived.  The trip to the
     pay phone on Chappaquiddick can only be explained by his receiving
     a call there, not making one.  There were plenty of pay phones in
     or near Ted's hotel if he needed to make a private call.  The tides
     in the channel and the direction in which Ted claimed he swam do
     not match.  In addition it would have been a superhuman feat to
     have made it across the channel (as proven by several professionals
     who subsequently tried it).
        Deputy Sheriff Christopher Look's testimony, coupled with the
     testimony of Ray LaRosa and two Lyons girls, proves that there were
     two people in Ted's car with Mary Jo at 12:45 PM.  The three party
     members walking along the road south toward the cottage confirmed
     the time that Mr. Look drove by.  He stopped to ask if they needed
     a ride.  Look says that just prior to that he encountered Ted's car
     parked facing north at the juncture of the main road and the dirt
     road.  It was on a short extension of the north-south section of
     the road junction to the north of the "T".  He says he saw a man
     driving, a woman in the seat beside him, and what he thought was
     another woman lying on the back seat.  He remembered a portion of
     the license plate which matched Ted's car, as did the description
     of the car.  Markham, Gargan and Ted's driver's testimony show that
     someone they talked to in the pitch black night sounded like Ted
     and was about his height and build.
        None of the above evidence was ever explained by Ted or by
     anyone else at the inquest or at the hearing on the case demanded
     by district attorney Edward Dinis.  No autopsy was ever allowed on
     Mary Jo's body (her family objected), and Ted made it possible to
     fly her body home for burial rather quickly.  Kennedy haters have
     seized upon Chappaquiddick to enlarge the sexual image now being
     promoted of both Ted and Jack Kennedy.  Books like "Teddy Bare"
     take full advantage of the situation.
        Just which operatives in the Power Control Group at the high
     levels or the lower levels were on Chappaquiddick Island?  No
     definite evidence has surfaced as yet, except for an indication
     that there was at least one woman and at least three men, one of
     whom resembled Ted Kennedy and who sounded like him in the
     darkness.  However, two pieces of testimony in the Watergate
     hearings provide significant clues as to which of the known JFK
     case conspirators may have been there.
        E. Howard Hunt told of a strange trip to Hyannisport to see a
     local citizen there about the Chappaquiddick incident.  Hunt's
     cover story on this trip was that he was digging up dirt on Ted
     Kennedy for use in the 1972 campaign.  The story does not make much
     sense if one questions why Hunt would have to wear a disguise,
     including his famous red wig, and to use a voice-alteration device
     to make himself sound like someone else.  If, on the other hand,
     Hunt's purpose was to return to the scene of his crime just to make
     sure that no one who might have seen his group at the bridge or
     elsewhere would talk, then the disguise and the voice box make
     sense.
        The other important testimony came from Tony Ulasewicz who said
     he was ordered by the Plumbers to fly immediately to Chappaquiddick
     and dig up dirt on Ted.  The only problem Tony has is that,
     according to his testimony, he arrived early on the morning of the
     "accident", before the whole incident had been made public.
     Ulasewicz is the right height and weight to resemble Kennedy and
     with a CIA voice-alteration device he presumably could be made to
     sound like him.  There is a distinct possibility that Hunt and Tony
     were there when it happened.
        The threats by the Power Control Group, the frame-up at
     Chappaquiddick, and the murders of Jack and Bobby Kennedy cannot
     have failed to take their toll on all of the Kennedys.  Rose, Ted,
     Jackie, Ethel and the other close family members must be very tired
     of it all by now.  They can certainly not be blamed for hoping it
     will all go away.  Investigations like those proposed by Henry
     Gonzalez and Thomas Downing only raised the spectre of the powerful
     Control Group taking revenge by kidnapping some of the seventeen
     children.
        It was no wonder that a close Kennedy friend and ally in
     California, Representative Burton, said that he would oppose the
     Downing and Gonzalez resolutions unless Ted Kennedy put his stamp
     of approval on them.  While the sympathies of every decent American
     go out to them, the future of our country and the freedom of the
     people to control their own destiny through the election process
     mean more than the lives of all the Kennedys put together.  If John
     Kennedy were alive today he would probably make the same statement.
        John Dean summed it up when he said to Richard Nixon as recorded
     on the White House tapes in 1973:  "If Teddy knew the bear trap he
     was walking into at Chappaquiddick. . . ."[5]



____________________

[1] "The fabulous Jackie" -- Christian Cafarakis -- Productions de Paris
   -- 1972

[2] "You the Jury" -- Robert Cutler -- Self Published -- 1974

[3] A rope attached to the stick which held the Oldsmobile throttle wide
   open caught the drivers rear view mirror and tore it loose so that
   it was hanging by the rear bolt.  There was no other mark on the
   left side of the car.

[4] A sliver of glass from two broken windows no doubt caused this
   bleeding since Mary Jo was already face down and unconscious in the
   rear seat.  Since there was no autopsy this clean cut went
   unnoticed by the embalmers.

[5] On page 121, "White House Tapes," Paperback Edition, published by New
   York Times







                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *




                                 Chapter 8
                    1972 - Muskie, Wallace and McGovern

        In 1972 the Power Control Group was faced with another set of
     problems.  Again the objective was to insure Nixon's election at
     all costs and to continue the cover-ups.  Nixon might have made it
     on his own.  We'll never know because the Group guaranteed his
     election by eliminating two strong candidates and completely
     swamping another with tainted leftist images and a psychiatric case
     for the vice presidential nominee.  The impression that Nixon had
     in early 1972 was that he stood a good chance of losing.  He
     imagined enemies everywhere and a press he was sure was out to get
     him.
        The Power Control Group realized this too.  They began laying
     out a strategy that would encourage the real nuts in the Nixon
     administration like E. Howard Hunt, G. Gordon Liddy and Donald
     Segretti to eliminate any serious opposition.  The dirty tricks
     campaign worked perfectly against the strongest early Democratic
     candidate, Edmund Muskie.  He withdrew in tears, later to discover
     he had been sabotaged by Nixon, Liddy and company.
        George Wallace was another matter.  At the time he was shot, he
     was drawing 18% of the vote according to the polls, and most of
     that was in Nixon territory.  The conservative states such as
     Indiana were going for Wallace.  He was eating into Nixon's
     southern strength.  In April the polls showed McGovern pulling a
     41%, Nixon 41% and Wallace 18%.  It was going to be too close for
     comfort, and it might be thrown into the House - in which case
     Nixon would surely lose.  There was the option available of
     eliminating George McGovern, but then the Democrats might come up
     with Hubert Humphrey or someone else even more dangerous than
     McGovern.  Nixon's best chance was a head-on contest with McGovern.
     Wallace had to go.  Once the group made that decision, the Liddy
     team seemed to be the obvious group to carry it out.  But how could
     it be done this time and still fool the people?  Another patsy this
     time?  O.K., but how about having him actually kill the Governor?
     The answer to that was an even deeper programming job than that
     done on Sirhan.  This time they selected a man with a lower I.Q.
     level who could be hypnotized to really shoot someone, realize it
     later, and not know that he had been programmed.  He would have to
     be a little wacky, unlike Oswald, Ruby or Ray.
        Arthur Bremer was selected.  The first contacts were made by
     people who knew both Bremer and Segretti in Milwaukee.  They were
     members of a leftist organization planted there as provocateurs by
     the intelligence forces within the Power Control Group.  One of
     them was a man named Dennis Cossini.
        Bremer was programmed over a period of months.  He was first set
     to track Nixon and then Wallace.  When his hand held the gun in
     Laurel, Maryland, it might just as well have been in the hand of
     Donald Segretti, E. Howard Hunt, G. Gordon Liddy, Richard Helms, or
     Richard Nixon.
        With Wallace's elimination from the race and McGovern's
     increasing popularity in the primaries, the only question remaining
     for the Power Control Group was whether McGovern had any real
     chance of winning.  The polls all showed Wallace's vote going to
     Nixon and a resultant landslide victory.  That, of course, is
     exactly what happened.  It was never close enough to worry the
     Group very much.  McGovern, on the other hand, was worried.  By the
     time of the California primary he and his staff had learned enough
     about the conspiracies in the assassinations of John and Robert
     Kennedy and Martin Luther King that they asked for increased Secret
     Service protection in Los Angeles.
        If the Power Control Group had decided to kill Mr. McGovern the
     Secret Service would not have been able to stop it.  However, they
     did not, because the election was a sure thing.  They did try one
     more dirty trick.  They revealed Thomas Eagleton's psychiatric
     problems, which reduced McGovern's odds considerably.
        What evidence is there that Bremer's attempt on Wallace was a
     directed attempt by a conspiratorial group?
        Bremer himself has told his brother that others were involved
     and that he was paid by them.  Researcher William Turner has turned
     up evidence in Milwaukee and surrounding towns in Wisconsin that
     Bremer received money from a group associated with Dennis Cossini,
     Donald Segretti and J. Timothy Gratz.  Several other young
     "leftists" were seen with Bremer on several occasions in Milwaukee
     and on the ferry crossing at Lake Michigan.
        The evidence shows that Bremer had a hidden source of income.
     He spent several times more than he earned or saved in the year
     before he shot at Wallace.  Bremer's appearance on TV, in court and
     before witnesses resembled those of a man under hypnosis.[1]
        There is some evidence that more than one gun may have been
     fired with the second gun being located in the direction opposite
     to Bremer.  Eleven wounds in the four victims that day exceeds the
     number that could have been caused by the five bullets Bremer
     fired.  There is a problem in identifying all of the bullets found
     as having been fired from Bremer's gun.  The trajectories of the
     wounds seem to be from two opposite directions.  All of this--the
     hypnotic-like trance, the possibility of two guns being fired from
     in front and from behind, and the immediate conclusion that Bremer
     acted alone--sounds very much like the arrangement made for the
     Robert Kennedy assassination.
        Another part of the evidence sounds like the King case.  A lone
     blue Cadillac was seen speeding away from the scene of the shooting
     immediately afterward.  It was reported on the police band radio
     and the police unsuccessfully chased it.  The car had two men in
     it.  The police and the FBI immediately shut off all accounts of
     that incident.
        E. Howard Hunt testified before the Ervin Committee that Charles
     Colson had asked him to go to Bremer's apartment in Milwaukee as
     soon as the news about Bremer was available at the White House.
     Hunt never did say why he was supposed to go.  Colson then said
     that he didn't tell Hunt to go, but that Hunt told him he was
     going.  Colson's theory is that Hunt was part of a CIA conspiracy
     to get rid of Nixon and to do other dirty tricks.
        Could Hunt and the Power Control Group have had in mind placing
     something in Bremer's apartment rather than taking something out?
     The "something" could have been Bremer's diary, which was later
     found in his car parked near the Laurel, Maryland parking lot.
     Hunt did not go to Milwaukee, because the FBI already had agents at
     the apartment.  Perhaps Hunt or someone else went instead to
     Maryland and planted the diary in Bremer's car.  One thing seems
     certain after a careful analysis of Bremer's diary in comparison to
     his grammar, spelling, etc., in his high school performances in
     English.  Bremer didn't write the diary.  Someone forged it, trying
     to make it sound like they thought Bremer would sound given his low
     I.Q.
        One last item would clinch the conspiracy case if it were true.
     A rumor spread among researchers and the media that CBS-TV had
     discovered Bremer and G. Gordon Liddy together on two separate
     occasions in TV footage of Wallace rallies.  In one TV sequence
     they were said to be walking together toward a camera in the
     background.  CBS completely closed the lid on the subject.
        The best source is obviously Bremer himself.  However, no
     private citizen can get anywhere near him.  Even if they could he
     might not talk if he had been programmed.  Unless an expert
     deprogrammed him, his secret could be locked away in his brain,
     just like Sirhan's secret is locked within his mind.



____________________

[1] "Report of an Investigation" by William Turner for the Committee
   on Government Intelligence.

   References:

   "Bremer Wallace and Hunt", The New York Review of Books -- Gore
   Vidal -- December 13, 1973.

   "The Wallace Shooting" -- Alan Stang -- "American Opinion" --
   October, 1972.

   "Why Was Wallace Shot?" -- R.F. Salant -- Self Published --
   Monsey, N.Y.

   "Interview With Charles Colson" -- Dick Russell -- "Argosy" --
   March, 1976.







                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *

--
                                            daveus rattus

                                  yer friendly neighborhood ratman

                              KOYAANISQATSI

  ko.yaa.nis.qatsi (from the Hopi Language)  n.  1. crazy life.  2. life
      in turmoil.  3. life out of balance.  4. life disintegrating.
        5. a state of life that calls for another way of living.
From [email protected] Wed Jun 10 10:08:58 1992
Received: from pl122c.eecs.lehigh.edu by ns-mx.uiowa.edu (5.64.jnf/920408)
         on Wed, 10 Jun 92 10:08:44 -0500 id AA10332 with SMTP
Received: from SGI.COM by PL122c.EECS.Lehigh.EDU (5.61/1.34)
       id AA15979; Wed, 10 Jun 92 10:53:16 -0400
Received: from [192.102.132.11] by sgi.sgi.com via SMTP (911016.SGI/910110.SGI)
       for [email protected] id AA02901; Wed, 10 Jun 92 07:55:47 -0700
Received: by ratmandu.esd.sgi.com (920110.SGI/920502.SGI.AUTO)
       for @sgi.sgi.com:[email protected] id AA02416; Wed, 10 Jun 92 07:55:45 -0700
Date: Wed, 10 Jun 92 07:55:45 -0700
From: [email protected] (dave "who can do? ratmandu!" ratcliffe)
Message-Id: <[email protected]>
To: [email protected]
Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (4/11)
Status: RO


Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (4/11)
Summary: we were robbed of our capability of electing a president we wanted
Keywords:  part 4 of 11:  first half of chapter 9
Lines: 995


  chapter 9 stands out as one of the most detailed explorations i've ever
  read *anywhere* concerning the media's culpability in the cover-up of
  the assassination of the president.  the major media's collusion in
  covering-up the truth of the assassination is one of the most tragic
  *and* revealing indicators about just how far this nation has moved away
  from *some* kind of representative democracy to, what, totalitarian
  "democracy"?  until we the people confront such crimes as the cover-up,
  perpetrated and perpetuated by "the official reality consortium," we will
  continue to experience an evermore expanding strangulating oligarchy and
  ever decreasing accountability.
                                                       --ratitor




                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *




                                 Chapter 9
                           Control of the Media

        As mentioned in Chapter 1, one of the two clever strategies used
     by the Power Control Group in the taking of America has been the
     control of the news media.
        For those American citizens who steadfastly refuse to believe
     that all of the American establishment news media could be
     controlled by the CIA and its friends in the White House, the
     continuing support of the Warren Commission's lone assassin
     conclusion by virtually all of the major news media organizations
     in November, 1975, twelve years after the event, must have been
     very puzzling indeed.  Since 78% of the public believe that there
     was a conspiracy in the case, there must be a series of questions
     in the minds of the most intelligent of the 78% about the media's
     position on the subject.[1]
        This Chapter is intended to enlighten readers and to remind them
     of the control exercised by the intelligence community and the
     White House over the 15 organizations from whom the public gets the
     vast majority of its news and opinions.
        Let's begin with 1968-1969.  By 1973 the American public had
     begun to develop a skepticism toward information they received on
     television or radio.  Various news stories appearing in our
     national news media through those years had brought about this
     attitude.  Some examples are:  the Songmy-Mylai incident, the
     Pueblo story, the murder of Black Panther Fred Hampton, the
     Pentagon Papers, the Clifford Irving hoax, the Bangladesh tragedy
     and the India-Pakistan war, Hoover & FBI antics, the Jack Anderson
     papers, and IT&T and the Republican National Convention.
        The general reaction was bound to be, "Don't believe everything
     you read, see or hear, especially the first time around, and more
     especially if the story comes from Washington."  In the case of the
     Pentagon Papers, things we all had taken as gospel for nearly two
     decades suddenly seemed to crumble.
        To what extent can the national news media be held responsible
     for this situation?  What has happened to the inquiring reporter
     and the crusading editor who are both searching for and printing
     the truth?  If a government or a president lies or keeps secrets,
     can the American news media really find out about it?  And if they
     do, what moral, ethical, political or other criteria should they
     use in uncovering the lies and presenting them to the public?
        Vice President Agnew would have said, "The press is already
     going too far."  Members of the press would have said, "We must
     remain independent and maintain the freedom of speech."  Just how
     independent is the news media?  Is it controlled to some extent by
     Washington?
        The answer to some of these questions can be found by taking an
     inside look at the major national news media organizations during
     1968 and 1969 and how they treated the most controversial news
     subject since World War II.  The assassination of John F. Kennedy
     and its aftermath is an all-pervading, endless topic.  It has yet
     to reach the Pentagon Papers, Anderston papers, or Mylai stage of
     revelation.  Precisely because it is still such a controversial
     subject, verboten for discussion among all major news media (unless
     the discussant supports the Warren Commission), it serves as an
     excellent case study.
        A categorical statement can be made that management and
     editorial policy, measured by what is printed and broadcast in all
     major American news media organizations, supports the findings of
     the Warren Commission.  This has been true since 1969, but it was
     not true between 1964 and 1969.
        Of significance in this analysis and what it implies about the
     American public's knowledge about the assassination and its
     aftermath is a definition of "major American national news media."
     It can be demonstrated that an overwhelming mass of news
     information reaching the eyes and ears of Americans comes from
     about fifteen organizations.  They are, in general order of
     significance:  NBC-TV & Radio CBS-TV & Radio, ABC-TV & Radio,
     Associated Press, United Press, "Time-Life-Fortune-Sports
     Illustrated," McGraw Hill "Business Week," "Newsweek," "U.S.  News
     & World Report," "New York Times" News Service, "Washington Post"
     News Service, Metromedia News Network, Westinghouse Radio News
     Network, Capital City Broadcasting Radio Network, the North
     American Newspaper Alliance, and the "Saturday Evening Post" (the
     "Post" is, of course, now defunct.)
        There are some subtle reasons for this, not generally
     appreciated by the average citizen.  Television has, of course,
     become the primary source of information.  For any nationally
     circulated news story, local stations rely heavily on film,
     videotape and written script material prepared and edited by the
     three networks.  Once in a while Metromedia may also send out TV
     material.  In effect, this means that editorial content for a vast
     majority of the television information seen by American citizens
     everywhere originates not only with three or four organizations but
     also with a very small number of producers, editors and
     commentators in those networks.
        A large majority of any national news items printed by local
     newspapers originates in a small number of press-wire services.  AP
     and UP dominate this area, with selected chains of papers
     subscribing to a lesser extent to new services of the "New York
     Times," "Washington Post," North American Newspaper Alliance, and a
     very small percentage receiving information from papers in Los
     Angeles, Chicago and St. Louis.
        In a national news story of major significance such as the
     assassination of John Kennedy, the smaller local papers rely almost
     exclusively on their affiliated news services.  Economic reasons
     dictate this situation.  The small paper can't afford to have
     reporters everywhere.  The major newspapers might send a man to
     Dallas for a few days to cover the assassination, or they might
     send a man to New Orleans to cover the Clay Shaw trial.  But even
     the major papers can't afford to cover every part of a continuing
     story anywhere around the world.  So they too rely on UP and AP for
     much of their material.  They also rely on AP, UP and Black Star[2]
     for most of their photographic material.
        In the case of news magazines, the holding corporations become
     important in forming editorial policy in a situation as
     controversial as the assassination of JFK.  Time Inc. and "Life,"
     "Newsweek" and the "Washington Post," "U.S. News," and McGraw Hill
     managements all became involved.
        Fifteen organizations is a surprisingly small number, and one is
     led to conjecture about how easy or difficult it might be to
     control or dictate editorial policy for all of them or some
     appreciable majority of them.  An article in "Computers and
     Automation"[3] reprinted a statement by John R. Rarick, Louisiana
     Congressman and an entry made in the "Congressional Record" bearing
     on this subject.  In the reprint, the "Government Employees
     Exchange" publication is quoted as stating that the CIA New Team
     used secret cooperating and liaison groups after the Bay of Pigs in
     the large foundations, banks and newspapers to change U.S. domestic
     and foreign relations through the infiltration of these
     organizations.  The coordinating role at "The New York Times" was
     in the custody of Harding Bancroft, Executive Vice President.
        A useful analysis consists of examining what happened
     organizationally and editorially inside each of the fifteen
     companies following the assassination of President Kennedy.  My
     personal knowledge, plus information available from a few sources
     connected with the major news media, permits such an analysis to be
     made for eleven of the fifteen.  They are:  NBC, CBS, ABC, Time-
     Life, "The New York Times," "Newsweek," Associated Press, United
     Press, "Saturday Evening Post," Capital City Broadcasting, and
     North American Newspaper Alliance.  In addition, the performance of
     nine local newspapers and TV stations directly involved in the
     events in Dallas and New Orleans will be analyzed.  These include:
     "Dallas Times Herald," "Dallas Morning News," Fort Worth "Star
     Telegram," Dallas CBS-Affiliate WBAP, "New Orleans Times Picayune,"
     "New Orleans Times Herald," and New Orleans NBC-Affiliate WDSU-TV.
        Most of these organizations had reporters and photographers in
     Dallas at the time of the assassination or within a few hours
     thereafter.  Most of them had direct coverage available when Jim
     Garrison's investigation broke into the news in 1967 and during the
     trial of Clay Shaw in New Orleans in 1969.  For many of them the
     Shaw trial became the running point in the changing of editorial
     policy toward the assassination.  For a few, the Garrison
     investigation and the Shaw trial took on the aspect of waving a
     red flag in front of a bull.  They became directly involved in a
     negative way and thus not only reported the news, but also biased
     it.
        Immediately following the assassination the media reported
     nearly everything that had obviously happened.  All was confused
     for the first few days.  The killing of Oswald by Ruby on live
     television produced even greater confusion.
        For one year the major media reported everything, from probable
     Communist conspiracies to the lone assassin theory.  The media
     waited for the Warren Report, and when it was issued in October of
     1964 many of the major media fell into line and editorially backed
     the Commission's findings.  Some questioned the findings and
     continued to question them until 1968 or 1969.  "The New York
     Times" and "Life" magazine fell into this category.  But by the
     time the Shaw trial ended in March 1969, every one of the fifteen
     major news media organizations was backing the Warren Commission
     and they have continued to maintain this editorial position since.
        The situation would perhaps not be so surprising had not the
     internal assassination research teams in several of these
     organizations discovered the truth about the Kennedy killing
     between 1964 and 1968.  These teams examined the evidence and
     thoroughly analyzed it.  No one who has ever taken the trouble to
     objectively do just that has reached any conclusion other than
     conspiracy.
        In each and every case the internal findings were overruled,
     suppressed, locked up, edited and otherwise altered to back up the
     Warren Commission.  Management at the highest editorial and
     corporate level took the action in every instance.  Before drawing
     any further generalization about the performance of the media in
     the JFK case, it will be revealing to examine what happened and
     specifically who took what actions in the case of the eleven
     national organizations and the nine local ones listed earlier.


                                 Time-Life

        The Time Inc. organization let "Life Magazine" establish its
     editorial policy while "Time" published more or less standard
     "Time-Life" stories.  "Life" became directly involved in the
     assassination action and evidence suppression from the very
     beginning, on November 22, 1963.
        "Life" purchased the famous Zapruder movie from Abraham Zapruder
     on the afternoon of the assassination for about $500,000.  The
     first negative action took place when "Life" and Zapruder began
     telling the lie that the price was $25,000 (which Zapruder donated
     to the fund raised for the widow of Dallas policeman, J. D.
     Tippit, who had also been murdered that day).  Apparently, both
     "Life" and Zapruder were ashamed that he profited by the event.  He
     lived in fear that the true price would be revealed until the day
     he died.
        As many readers know, the Zapruder film (viewed in slow motion)
     proves there was a conspiracy because of the backward motion of the
     President's head immediately following the fatal shot.  It proves
     the shot came from the grassy knoll to the right and in front of
     the president while Oswald's purported position was very nearly
     directly behind him.  The film also helps establish that five, and
     not three shots, were fired, and that one of them could not have
     been fired from Oswald's supposed sniper's nest because of the
     large oak tree blocking his view.
        "Life" magazine never permitted the Zapruder film to be seen
     publicly and locked it up in November 1968 so that no one inside or
     outside "Life" could have access to it, automatically becoming an
     "accessory after the fact".  "Life" helped protect the real
     assassins and committed a worse crime than the Warren Commission.
        In answer to those defenders of "Life" who will say, "But `Life'
     turned over a copy of the Zapruder film to the Warren Commission,
     and it is available in the National Archives," let's look at the
     facts.  "Life" did not supply the copy of the film now resting in
     the Archives.  That copy came from Zapruder's original to the
     Secret Service to the Warren Commission to the Archives.  It is
     available for viewing by the few people fortunate enough to visit
     the Archives.  It can not be duplicated by anyone, and copies can
     not be taken out of the Archives or viewed publicly in any way.
     The Archive management responsible for the Kennedy assassination
     records state that the "Life" magazine ownership of the Zapruder
     film is what prevents copies from being made available outside the
     Archives.
        The Warren Commission did not see the film in slow motion.  Nor
     does the average Archives' visitor get to see it in slow motion or
     stop-action.  Yet the most casual analysis of the film in slow
     motion convinces anyone to conclude there was a conspiracy.
        Thus "Life" magazine is an important part of the efforts to
     suppress evidence of conspiracy.
        "Life" was involved in several other ways as an accessory after
     the fact.  The organization began its efforts to discover the truth
     about the assassination in 1964 when it assigned Ed Kern, an
     associate editor, to investigate.  By the fall of 1966, Kern had
     become convinced that the basic evidence pointed to conspiracy.
     "Life" management was also apparently convinced;  they published
     articles in November 1965 and November 1966 questioning the Warren
     Commission's conclusions.
        In the fall of 1966 "Life" transferred Richard Billings from
     their Miami office to headquarters in New York.  His assignment was
     to take over the investigation of the Kennedy assassination, and to
     head a team of several people working full time on it.  One of Dick
     Billings' objectives was to search for and acquire as much of the
     missing photographic evidence as possible.
        This author initiated a similar search, independent from "Life"
     magazine, in September 1966.  As often happens, people with common
     objectives decided to work together.  Billings and the author
     arrived at a tacit understanding that any JFK assassination
     photographs, including TV films or private movies, found by either
     would be brought to the other's attention.  In exchange for access
     to "Life"'s photographic collection (including the Zapruder film
     and slides), the author agreed to give "Life" the results of any
     analyses of the photographic evidence.  In cases where the author
     could not afford to acquire some new piece of evidence, "Life"
     would offer to purchase the materials from the owners and supply
     copies to the author.
        In this manner the author discovered and helped "Life" magazine
     acquire the largest collection of photographic evidence of the JFK
     assassination, outside of the author's personal collection and the
     collection now located at the headquarters of the Committee to
     Investigate Assassinations in Washington, D.C.  Among the photos
     discovered were:

        The Dorman movie                  Private
        The Wilma Bond photos             Private
        The Robert Hughes movie           Private
        The David Weigman TV footage      NBC
        The Malcolm Couch TV footage      ABC
        The Jack Beers photos             "Dallas Morning News"
        The William Allen photos          "Dallas Times Herald"
        The George Smith photos           Ft. Worth "Star Telegram"
        The John Martin movie             Private
        Hugh Betzen's photo               Private

     (See "Computers and Automation," May 1970)

        Many of these were important in proving conspiracy and some
     showed pictures of the real assassins.
        The "Life" team headed by Billings was in the process of
     discovering a great deal about the conspiracy during the 1966-1968
     period.  While editorially not taking a strong position favoring
     conspiracy, "Life" did take a position that favored a new
     investigation by the government.  This was editorially summed up in
     a lead cover story on the fourth anniversary of Kennedy's death in
     November 1967 with the title,  "A Matter of Reasonable Doubt".  In
     that issue, John Connally and his wife were shown examining the
     Zapruder film's frames and concluding that he had been hit much
     later in the film than the Warren Commission claimed.  This meant
     that two bullets struck the two men and, by the Commission's own
     admission, pointed automatically to the conspiracy.
        The government naturally did not respond to "Life"'s suggestion
     for a new investigation, so nothing ever came of that editorial
     policy.  Billings, however, continued his team's efforts and in
     October 1968 was preparing a comprehensive article for the November
     anniversary issue.  The author continued to work with him and
     continued being given access to the photos right up to October
     1968.
        It was at that point in time that a drastic change in management
     policy occurred at "Life" magazine.  Dick Billings was told to stop
     all work on the assassination;  his entire team was stopped.  All
     of the research files, including the Zapruder film and slides and
     thousands of other film frames and photographs, were locked up.  No
     one at the magazine was permitted access to these materials and no
     one (including the author) was ever allowed to see them again.
        Simultaneously, editorial and management policy toward the
     assassination changed to complete silence.  Billings and crew were
     not allowed to discuss the subject at "Life," let alone work on it.
     In November 1968 the article Billings had been working on was
     turned into a non-entity.  A few of the hundreds of photographs
     collected by the author and purchased by "Life" were published in
     the article, along with an innocuous commentary.  Credit for
     discovering the photos was given to a number of people at "Life"
     magazine in New York and Dallas, not to the individuals who
     actually found them.
        That article, published nearly nine years ago, was the last word
     "Life" has ever uttered about their extensive research probe and
     their feelings about a conspiracy.  Dick Billings moved to
     Washington, D.C. to become editor of the Congressional Quarterly
     and is a member on the board of directors of the Committee to
     Investigate Assassinations (CTIA).
        Who made the policy change decision at "Life" and why?  Various
     high-level conspiracy enthusiasts claim that the cabal behind the
     assassination of the President brought extreme pressure to bear
     upon the owners and management of Time Inc. to silence all
     opposition to the Warren Commission findings.  Others conclude it
     had something to do with the CIA's control of "Life"'s editorial
     policy from inside.  This author takes no position on why.  Dick
     Billings knows only that the decision was made at high levels and
     passed downward and that it was irrevocable.
        Repeated attempts by the CTIA and several independent
     assassination researchers to break loose the basic evidence in
     "Life"'s possession, such as the Zapruder film, the Hughes film,
     and the Mark Bell Film, met with total opposition and a stone wall.
     Attempts to break loose the Archives' copy of the Zapruder film or
     slides met the same stiff opposition.  In 1971 "Life"
     representatives indicated they might be interested in selling
     rights to the Zapruder film for a sum in the neighborhood of a
     million dollars.


                                    CBS

        The American public is aware of the editorial policy adopted by
     the Columbia Broadcasting System toward the Kennedy assassination
     because of a special four-part series with Walter Cronkite which
     was broadcast on network TV in prime time in the summer of 1967.[4]
     That series, while taking issue with some of the work of the Warren
     Commission *and criticizing the Dallas police*, the FBI and the
     Secret Service, nevertheless backed all of the basic Warren
     Commission conclusions.
        Anyone watching the Cronkite series might have wondered why the
     basic evidence presented by CBS in an itemized format for each of
     several areas in the case, did not always seem to point to the
     conclusion reached at the end of each section.  The conclusion
     always agreed with the Warren Commission's comparable conclusion.
     Some viewers may even have noticed Cronkite's double-take after
     reading through the basic evidence and then reading the phrase,
     "and the conclusion is!"  It seemed as though he didn't believe the
     conclusion and hadn't seen it until he came to it in the script.
        Actually, that is exactly what happened.  CBS management caused
     the entire script to be changed from one concluding conspiracy to a
     script supporting the Warren Commission in the last week before the
     first part of the series went on the air.  Cronkite had not seen
     the entire script until the program went on.  Time had not
     permitted changing all of the points of evidence, so in most cases
     they were unchanged and only the conclusion was changed.
        How did this come about?  Who decided to change the script at
     the last moment and why?  Again there are control theories extant,
     but the author's personal relationships to CBS people might help to
     shed a little light on the subject.
        The discussion with all of the CBS people always centered on
     evidence of conspiracy and the CBS-TV film footage taken at the
     assassination site.  Bob Richter was the most knowledgeable of all
     the aforementioned people on the basic evidence and he was firmly
     convinced there was a conspiracy.  Bernie Birnbaum was convinced
     that a new investigation was desirable and his wife was convinced
     there had been a conspiracy.  Dan Rather believed there was a
     conspiracy and so did Wes Wise.
        CBS photographers Sandy Sanderson, Tom Craven, and Jim Underwood
     had taken movie-TV footages showing evidence of conspiracy.
     Craven's footage, for example, showed the assassin's get-away car
     driving away from the parking lot area behind the grassy knoll
     about one minute after the shots were fired.  Sanderson filmed one
     of the assassins being arrested in front of the Depository building
     about 30 minutes after the shots.  Most of this footage was either
     lost or locked up in the CBS archives vaults in New Jersey.
        Wes Wise so strongly maintained his opinion about conspiracy
     that he broadcast appeals for new photographic evidence over the
     KRLD local TV shows.  This was done against the orders of Eddie
     Barker.  Wes became Mayor of Dallas, elected in 1971 and defeated
     the Dallas-established oligarchy.  He actually received a new piece
     of photographic evidence based on his TV appeal from a Dallas
     citizen named Bothun, who had taken a picture of the grassy knoll a
     few moments after the shots.
        The script for the Cronkite series was being edited and was
     going through its final preparation stages in May and early June.
     The author was in constant touch with Wise, Birnbaum and Richter
     during this period and was informed about the basic thrust of the
     script toward conspiracy and recommendations for a new
     investigation.
        On May 8 a dinner meeting took place at the author's New York
     club with Mr. and Mrs. Birnbaum.  There, Mrs. Birnbaum and the
     author tried to convince Bernie that he should take a stronger
     position on a new investigation.
        On May 18, Bob Richter and one of Jim Garrison's investigators
     met in the National Archives with the author and reviewed the
     evidence of conspiracy.  On June 2, 3 and 4 in Dallas, the author
     showed Bernie Birnbaum and Wes Wise a film taken by Johnny Martin
     that showed three of the assassins and their cohorts on the grassy
     knoll running toward the parking lot a few seconds after firing two
     shots.  Wise and Birnbaum tried to interest Barker and others in
     taking a look at the film.
        On June 14 Bob Richter invited the author to meet Midgely,
     Lister and Wallace at CBS in New York where an interview was being
     taped with Jim Garrison for use in the series.  At that time
     Garrison, Richter and the author spent some time with the producer
     and his assistant discussing the evidence of conspiracy.
        Finally, on June 20, just five days before the program was to go
     on the air, the author met with Richter and Dan Rather in the
     Washington, D.C. CBS studios.  The script was reviewed by Richter
     and Rather in the author's presence.  The gist of the conversation
     was that Rather and Richter agreed that the conclusions stating
     conspiracy had to be made even stronger than they were at that
     time.
        The day before the program was aired, Bob Richter assured the
     author that the theme would point to conspiracy and demand a new
     investigation.  The author telephoned Richter immediately after the
     first broadcast and asked what had happened.  Richter was
     devastated.  He could not understand what had happened.  From that
     time forward his course paralleled that of Dick Billings.  He
     resigned from CBS in disgust and formed his own company, Richter-
     McBride, in New York.  It was his original intent to make a film
     about the JFK assassination based on his own research and the films
     he could obtain.  However, the massive suppression of the
     assassination, especially the suppression of the Zapruder film by
     Time-Life films, cancelled Richter's plans for a film.
        Correspondence with Cronkite and others determined that the
     decision to change the script, distort and hide CBS's own findings
     and back up the Warren Commission to the hilt came from Midgely and
     Lister.  How much higher did the decision go?  Richard Salant was
     head of the CBS News Division then and, of course, William C. Paley
     was (and still is) chairman of the board.
        By an odd coincidence, in a sequel to the above CBS story, the
     author had an opportunity to learn a little more about Mr. Paley's
     knowledge.  Jeff Paley, William Paley's son, returned to the United
     States from Paris in the winter of 1967-1968, where he had been
     writing news stories and a news column for "L'Express" and for the
     North American Newspaper Alliance, a group serving small papers in
     the United States.  Jeff had become convinced there was a
     conspiracy in the JFK case and came to interview Garrison and
     others and to do a story for French papers.  (European papers and
     magazines always believed and still do believe in the JFK
     assassination conspiracy.)  He met at length with Richter and the
     author and became quite disturbed at what CBS had done.  He
     approached his father with the idea that CBS had been wrong in the
     Cronkite series and that something should be done to rectify the
     situation.
        Bill Paley told his son that he knew nothing about the details
     of the programs or the work lying behind the conclusions.  He said
     Midgely had been responsible for the entire production.  He told
     Jeff that if he could show proof that the CBS conclusions were
     wrong and there had been a conspiracy, that he would fire Midgely
     and all the rest of the team and do the whole thing all over again
     under new management.
        Needless to say, this did not happen and the mystery about where
     the decision to suppress the truth came from within CBS is as deep
     as it ever was.
        Since June 1967, CBS has remained editorially silent on the
     subject of the JFK assassination.  The photographic evidence of
     conspiracy in their possession remains locked up and suppressed.
     The Craven sequence--film footage by the CBS photographer (who had
     been in the parade's camera car # 1) of a car driving out of the
     Elm Street extension (left-to right in front of the Texas School
     Book Depository) within 20 seconds of the assassination--was seen
     by the author and Jones Harris in New York, but was cut out of the
     film where it appeared prior to the time the author and Richter
     began searching for it.  There is little question that CBS is an
     accessory after the fact.
        CBS edited out one other important piece of TV film.  In
     November 1969, Walter Cronkite conducted a three-part interview
     with Lyndon B. Johnson at his ranch in Texas.  The series was
     broadcast in the spring of 1970 and on the first program an
     announcement was made that portions of the taped interview had been
     deleted at Lyndon Johnson's request, "for reasons of national
     security."
        What actually happened and what Johnson had said six months
     earlier was made public due to a leak at CBS.  The story appeared
     in newspapers all over the U.S. several days before the broadcast.
        Johnson told Cronkite that there had been a conspiracy in the
     assassination of President Kennedy, that Oswald was not a lone
     madman assassin, and that he, Johnson, had known it all along.
     Johnson reviewed the tapes a week or so before the program was to
     go on the air and then called up the CBS management, asking that
     his remarks be deleted.
        Someone at CBS who was very disturbed by this called a member of
     the Committee to Investigate Assassinations and told him what had
     been deleted.  This led to the story being printed in the
     newspapers.


                           "The New York Times"

        The record of the "Times" through the 1969-1971 period follows
     the same pattern as CBS and "Life" magazine editorial policies.
        The early editorials following the Warren Report supported the
     Commission.  The "Times" cooperated by publishing much of the
     report in advance.  In 1965, however, editorials began to appear
     that questioned the Commission's findings and suggested a new
     investigation.  In 1964 the "Times" formed a research team headed
     by Harrison Salisbury to investigate the assassination.  The team
     of six included Peter Khiss and Gene Roberts.  Their conclusions
     were never made public by the "Times" but indications point to
     their finding evidence of conspiracy.
        Khiss, in particular, through the 1966-1968 period in several
     meetings and discussions with the author, expressed doubts about
     the Warren Report and questioned the lone madman assassin theme.
     When the Garrison investigation made the news, the "Times" began a
     regular campaign to undermine Garrison's case, to support the
     Warren Commission, and finally (during the Clay Shaw trial) to
     completely distort the news and the testimony presented.  Martin
     Waldron was the reporter sending in the stories from the Shaw
     trial, but someone in New York edited them to completely change
     their content.  The author saw the story written by Waldron on the
     first day of the trial and the final version appearing in the
     "Times."  The two were completely different, with Waldon's original
     following the actual trial proceedings very closely.
        The author, writing under the pen name of Samuel B. Thurston,
     postulated the possibility that "The New York Times," on selected
     subjects, including the JFK assassination, was controlled by the
     CIA through their representative among top management, Mr. Harding
     Bancroft.[5]
        In the summer of 1968, the author discovered a remarkable
     similarity between the sketch of the assassin of Dr. Martin Luther
     King and one of the three tramps arrested in Dealey Plaza following
     the assassination of President Kennedy.  Peter Khiss wrote a story
     about this and it was published by the "Times" in June, 1968.
     Apparently that was the final straw for the "Times" management as
     far as Khiss was concerned.  He was not allowed to do any more
     research on assassinations or to discuss the subject at the
     "Times."  As he told the author in 1969, he doesn't attend any
     press conferences about assassinations because he doesn't like it
     when people in "Times" management say, "Here comes crazy old Pete
     Khiss again with his conspiracy talk."
        The apex of "The New York Times" actions and editorial positions
     on the JFK assassination came in November and December 1971.  They
     published three items supporting the Warren Commission eight years
     after the assassination, at a time when it seemed on the surface to
     be a dead issue.
        The first was a story about Dallas eight years later by an
     author from Texas who wrote his entire story as though it were an
     established fact that Oswald was the lone madman assassin firing
     three shots from the sixth floor window of the Depository building
     and later killing police officer Tippit.
        The second was an Op-Ed page guest editorial by none other than
     David Belin, a Warren Commission lawyer.  He defended the
     Commission and attacked the researchers.  The third was a story by
     Fred Graham about the findings of Dr. Lattimer, who was allowed to
     see the autopsy photographs and x-rays of John Kennedy.  Graham
     actually wrote most of his story, which solidly backed up the
     Warren Commission due to Lattimer's claims that the autopsy
     materials proved no conspiracy, before Lattimer ever entered the
     Archives.
        In other words, it appears that Graham knew what Lattimer was
     going to find and say in advance.  Either that or someone in
     Washington, D.C. gave someone at the "Times" orders in advance to
     prepare the story for the first page, upper left-hand corner, of
     the paper.  It really didn't make any difference whether Dr.
     Lattimer ever saw the x-rays and photographs.
        The concerted campaign on the part of the "Times" management
     could have been timed to prevent a discovery of new evidence of
     conspiracy in the autopsy materials.  The reason for this
     possibility developing in the November 1971 period is that the
     five-year restriction placed on the autopsy evidence by Burke
     Marshall, a Kennedy family lawyer, expired in November of 1971.
     Four well-known and highly reputable forensic pathologists, Dr.
     Cyril Wecht of Pittsburgh, Dr. John Nichols of the University of
     Kansas, Dr. Milton Helpern of New York City and Dr. John Chapman of
     Detroit had already asked permission to examine the x-rays and
     photos upon the expiration of the five-year period.  All four were
     known to question the Warren Commission's findings.  What better
     way to freeze them out of the Archives than to select a doctor who
     could be trusted to back up the Commission (Lattimer had published
     several articles doing just that), commission him to go into the
     Archives, and then persuade "The New York Times" to publish a front
     page story in its Sunday issue demonstrating that no one else need
     look at the materials because they supported the Warren
     Commission's findings.
        All attempts by researchers to convince "Times" management that
     the other side of the story should be told have been completely
     ignored.  Lattimer's findings, if correct, actually prove
     conspiracy.  The "Times" has been informed of this but they have
     shut off all discussion of the subject.  The complete story of the
     complicity of the "New York Times" in the crimes to which they have
     become an accessory would take up an entire volume.[6]


                                    NBC

        The National Broadcasting Company became an active participant
     in the government's efforts to protect Clay Shaw and to ruin Jim
     Garrison.
        Two of NBC's high-level management people, Richard Townley of
     NBC's affiliate in New Orleans, WDSU, and Walter Sheridan,
     executive producer, became personally and directly involved in the
     Shaw trial.  They were indicted by a grand jury in New Orleans for
     bribing witnesses, suppressing evidence and interfering with trial
     proceedings.  NBC top-level management backed Sheridan and Townley.
        NBC produced a highly biased, provably dishonest program
     personally attacking Garrison and defending Shaw prior to the
     trial.  Frank McGee, who acted as moderator, later had to publicly
     apologize for lies told on the program by two "witnesses" whom NBC
     paid to give statements against Garrison.  The FCC ruled that NBC
     had to give Garrison equal time because the program was not a news
     program but a vendetta by NBC against Garrison.  NBC did give
     Garrison 30 minutes (compared to their one-hour attack) to respond
     at a later date.  Sheridan was the producer of the one-hour show.
        With Sheridan and Townley so deeply involved, and with such an
     extremely strong editorial position favoring the Justice
     Department, the Warren Commission, and the lone assassin stance,
     suspicions were raised about NBC's and RCA's independence.[7]  At
     one point in 1967 the president of NBC, according to Walter
     Sheridan, helped in the bribery efforts by calling Mr. Gherlock,
     head of Equitable Life Insurance Company's New York office, and
     asked for assurance that Perry Russo, who worked for Equitable,
     would cooperate with NBC.
        NBC is also the owner of several important pieces of
     photographic evidence.  A TV film taken by NBC photographer David
     Weigman was suppressed by NBC and not made available to
     researchers.  It shows the grassy knoll in the background just a
     fraction of a minute after the shots.  Some of the assassination
     participants can be seen on the knoll.
        Fortunately for researchers, NBC sold the Weigman film to the
     other networks and to the news film agencies before realizing its
     importance.  The author was able to purchase a copy from Hearst
     Metrotone News.
        NBC's affiliate, WBAP in Fort Worth, has several important film
     sequences.  James Darnell took several sequences on the grassy
     knoll and in the parking lot which should contain important
     evidence.  Dan Owens took TV movies in and around the Depository
     building which should show how the snipers' nest was faked on the
     sixth floor, and one of the assassins in front of the building.


                                   ABC

        Of the three major television networks, ABC has remained more
     objective and appears to be less under the thumb of the government
     than the other two.  For example, when NBC was busy defending the
     Warren Commission and Clay Shaw and attacking Jim Garrison, ABC was
     giving Garrison a free chance to express his views without
     interruption on their Sunday program, "Issues and Answers."  They
     have never taken an editorial position one way or another on
     conspiracy.  However, in the Robert Kennedy assassination case, the
     investigation was suppressed at ABC.  The man heading the brief
     investigation was stopped and sent to Vietnam.  The man at ABC who
     called the shots in stopping the investigation and in suppressing
     evidence in ABC's possession was a lawyer named Lewis Powell.
        The evidence owned by ABC is a video tape of the crowd in the
     Ambassador Hotel ballroom before, during and after the shots were
     fired in the kitchen.  The ballroom microphones, including ABC's,
     picked up the sound of only three shots above the crowd noise.
     Since Sirhan fired eight shots, or certainly more than three, and
     since Los Angeles police tests proved that Sirhan's gun could not
     be heard in the position of the microphones in the ballroom, the
     ABC film and soundtrack is important evidence of three other shots.
        The sequence was originally included in the TV film of Robert
     Kennedy's 1968 campaign and assassination entitled, "The Last
     Journey."  Following a meeting at ABC when the management learned
     what the film showed, the next TV broadcast of "The Last Journey"
     (scheduled for the following week) was cancelled without any
     logical explanation.  The next time the film appeared on ABC (late
     1971), the three-shot ballroom sequence had been cut.


                        United Press International

        Of all the fifteen major news organizations included herein, UPI
     has come closest to really pursuing the truth about the JFK
     assassination.  Yet they, too, have suppressed evidence, have not
     had the courage of their convictions in analyzing conspiratorial
     evidence, and by default have become accessories after the fact.
        Two different departments at UPI became involved in the
     photographic evidence of the JFK assassination.  The regular photo
     news service department, which receives wire photos and negatives
     from many sources all over the world, accumulated a large
     collection of basic evidence both from UPI photographers and by
     purchasing wire service photos from newspapers, Black Star, AP and
     other sources.  This department has made all of its photographs
     available to anyone at reasonable prices ($1.50 to $3.00 per
     print).
        UPI photographer Frank Cancellare was in the motorcade and
     snapped several important photographs.  In addition, five other
     photographs at UPI, taken by three unknown photographers, are
     significant.  All of these were purchased by the author from UPI.
        The other department has not been as cooperative.  Within the
     news department at UPI, Burt Reinhardt and Rees Schonfeld have
     varied in their attitude and performance.  UPI news purchased the
     commercial rights to two very important films shortly after the
     assassination.  These were color movies taken by Orville Nix and
     Marie Muchmore (private citizens).  Both show the fatal shot
     striking the President, and both show evidence of conspiracy.  In
     the Nix film, certain frames (when enlarged) show one of the
     assassins on the grassy knoll with a rifle.  Both movies show a
     puff of smoke generated by another one of the men involved in the
     assassination.
        UPI, under the direction of Burt Reinhardt, did several things
     with the Nix and Muchmore films.  They produced a book, "Four
     Days," including several color frames from the movies.  They made a
     composite movie in 35mm from the original 8mm movies.  The
     composite used the technique of repeating a frame several times to
     give the appearance of slow motion or stop action during key
     sections of the films.  Reinhardt, Schonfeld and Mr. Fox, a UPI
     writer, made the composite movie available to researchers at their
     projection studio in New York in 1964 and 1965.
        Fox and Schonfeld wrote an article for "Esquire" in 1965 which
     portrayed the Nix film as proving the conspiracy theories about
     assassins on the grassy knoll to be false.  This was deemed
     necessary by UPI management because a New York researcher and a
     photographic expert, after seeing the Nix film at UPI, claimed it
     showed an assassin with a rifle standing on the hood of a car
     parked behind the knoll.
        The research team had used a few frames from the film in color
     transparencies and enlarged them in black and white to show the
     gunman.
        In 1964, UPI gave the Warren Commission copies of both the Nix
     and Muchmore films for analysis.  The films were later turned over
     to the National Archives under a special agreement between UPI and
     the Archives.  This agreement reminds one of the agreements between
     the Archives and the Kennedy family on the autopsy materials, and
     the obscure one between "Life" magazine, the Commission, the Secret
     Service and the Archives on the Zapruder film.
        The UPI agreement prevents anyone from obtaining copies of the
     Nix and Muchmore films or slides of individual frames for any
     purpose.  The agreement is just as illegal as the other two, yet it
     has been just as effective in suppressing the basic evidence of
     conspiracy.
        In 1967, UPI, apparently still not sure they would not be
     attacked by researchers on what the Nix film revealed, employed
     Itek Corporation to analyze the film.  (At least it would appear on
     the surface that UPI did the hiring.)  Itek Corporation, a major
     defense contractor, did an excellent job of obscuring the truth.
     In an apparently highly scientific analysis using computer-based
     image enhancement, they "proved" that not only was there no gunman
     on the grassy knoll, but there was no person on the knoll at all
     during the shooting.
        The final Itek report was made public and highly publicized by
     UPI.  It looked as though the UPI earlier claim of no gunman had
     been scientifically substantiated.  As a by-product, Itek got some
     great publicity for their commercially available photo-computer
     image enhancement system.
        What the public did not know was that UPI gave Itek only 35mm
     enlarged black and white copies of selected frames from the Nix
     film.  The great amount of detail is lost in going from 8mm color
     to 35mm black and white.  And UPI gave Itek carefully chosen frames
     from the Nix film that did not show the gunman on the knoll.
        UPI and Itek defined "the grassy knoll" in a very limited and
     carefully chosen way so as to exclude five people (in addition to
     the fatal-shot gunman) on the knoll who appear in the Nix film as
     well as in every other photograph and movie taken of the knoll at
     the time the shots were fired.[8]  In addition, man No. 2, who had
     ducked down behind the stone wall during the Nix film, could not be
     detected by Itek because they only had the Nix film.
        Three men standing on the steps of the knoll, and two men behind
     the picket fence, were completely ignored or overlooked.
        The author began to contact Schonfeld and Reinhardt in early
     1967, viewed the two films both at UPI and in the Archives, and
     requested copies of the original 8mm color films or color copies of
     individual frames.  The response to the requests were negative for
     more than four years.  During this time, however, the author, a New
     York researcher, and a photographic specialist, enlarged in color
     the correct frames from the Nix film.  The enlargements clearly
     show the gunman, not on top of a car but in front of a car, with
     his rifle poised.  He is standing on a pedestal protruding from the
     eight-sided cupola behind the stone wall on the knoll.  The car is
     parked behind the cupola and can be seen in several other
     photographs and movies.
        Unfortunately, UPI's agreement with the researcher prevents
     making public the color enlargements.  UPI has consistently
     suppressed this evidence.  In 1971, they offered to make the film
     available for a very large sum of money, but they have never agreed
     that it shows anyone on the knoll and they will not make copies
     available for research.
        The UPI editorial position (in articles, the book "Four Days,"
     letters and news releases) has supported the Warren Commission
     through the years.  The major difference between UPI and "Life" or
     CBS is that no drastic reversal of management policy took place at
     UPI.


                                    AP

        Associated Press became an accessory after the fact by taking an
     action unprecedented for a news wire service.  It published a
     three-part report by three AP writers in 1967, completely
     supporting the Warren Commission.  The report was transmitted by
     wire to all AP subscribers over a three-day period and it occupied
     a total of nine to ten full pages of the average newspaper.  It was
     not news, but editorial policy and took a position supporting the
     Warren Commission and the official government propaganda about the
     assassination of John Kennedy.
        Most small newspapers rely on UP and AP for their news stories.
     The three-part AP report ran in hundreds of papers across the
     United States without opposition commentary.  For many this was the
     gospel at the time.  What more could the conspirators and their
     government protectors have asked?
        AP photographers were on the scene in Dallas during the
     assassination.  James Altgens, one of AP's men assigned to Dallas,
     took seven important photographs in Dealey Plaza.  Henry Burrows,
     an AP photographer from Washington, D.C., was in the motorcade and
     snapped two pictures.  Four other AP photographers took ten
     important photographs.  AP's photo department and Wide World Photos
     in New York purchased many other photographs taken in Dealey Plaza.
        Meyer Goldberg, manager of Wide World Photos, set a policy early
     in the 1966-1967 period which placed AP in the position of
     partially suppressing basic photographic evidence.  The policy
     contained several parts.  First, Goldberg made it extremely
     difficult for anyone to obtain access to the photographic evidence,
     particularly the negatives.  Second, he set a high enough price on
     copies of photographs ($17.50 for one 8x10 black and white print)
     to freeze out all but commercially-financed interests.  Third, when
     an original negative was discovered, the print order, when cleared
     by Wide World, was always cropped.  (Full negative prints showing
     important details in the Altgens photographs were nearly impossible
     to purchase.)  Whenever any suggestion was made to Wide World that
     their photographs contained basic evidence of conspiracy, Goldberg
     and AP management turned blue with anger and literally refused to
     discuss the subject or permit research in their files.
        Various researchers, including Josiah Thompson, Raymond Marcus
     and the author met this type of stiff opposition, but after many
     visits discovered ways around it.  The staff at Wide World in
     charge of the photographic files was more cooperative, and at least
     one staff member was completely convinced there was a conspiracy in
     the JFK assassination.
        Nevertheless, the broadly announced editorial policy and stance
     of Associated Press between 1964 and 1972 fully supported the
     Warren Commission and the lone assassin fable.


                                "Newsweek"

        "Newsweek"'s editorial policy and coverage of the assassination
     and its aftermath was largely the doing of one man, Hugh
     Aynesworth.  Aynesworth was the Dallas-Houston correspondent for
     "Newsweek" following the assassination.  He was in Dealey Plaza
     when Kennedy was killed, and he turned in several stories during
     the days and weeks following November 22, 1963.  His point of view
     was always closely allied with that of the Dallas police, the
     district attorney and the FBI.  He wholeheartedly supported the
     Warren Report.
        However, in May of 1967, after Garrison's investigation hit the
     news, Aynesworth wrote a violent attack on Garrison's
     investigation, and it was published in "Newsweek."  Aynesworth
     accused Lynn Loisel, a Garrison staff member, of bribing Al
     Beaubolf to testify about a meeting to plot the assassination.
     Beaubolf later denied this accusation in a sworn affidavit and
     proved Aynesworth and "Newsweek" to be fabricators of information.


                          "Saturday Evening Post"

        The position of the "Saturday Evening Post" solidified after the
     Garrison probe became public.  It was based in large part on the
     reporting of one man, James Phelan.  Phelan wrote a blistering
     article for the "Post" published on May 6, 1967.  He attacked
     Garrison and Russo, and claimed that Russo's original statement to
     Assistant D.A. Andrew Sciambra differed from his later testimony.
     In view of the earlier editorial position of the "Post" when Lyron
     Land and his wife questioned the Warren Commission findings, the
     Phelan article came as somewhat of a surprise.  In fact, the "Post"
     had taken a strong conspiracy stand when in 1967 it published a
     long article excerpted from Josiah Thompson's book, "Six Seconds in
     Dallas," and featured it on the magazine's cover.
        The Garrison investigation, however, turned the "Post" around.
     Phelan became directly involved in the case, and in a sense was
     more of an accessory than Walter Sheridan or Richard Townley.  He
     travelled to Louisiana from Texas, spent many hours with Perry
     Russo and other witnesses, and generally obfuscated the Shaw trial
     picture.
        Phelan joined the efforts to persuade Russo to desert Garrison
     and to help destroy Garrison and his case.  According to a sworn
     Russo statement, Phelan visited his house four times within a few
     weeks.  Phelan told Russo he was working hand-in-hand with Townley
     and Sheridan, that they were in constant contact, and that they
     were going to destroy Garrison and the probe.  Phelan warned Russo
     that he should abandon his position and that Russo would be the
     only one hurt as a result of the trial.  Phelan claimed Garrison
     would leave Russo alone, standing in the cold.
        Phelan offered to hire a $200,000-a-year lawyer from New York
     for Russo if he would cooperate against Garrison.  He asked Russo
     how he would feel about sending an innocent man (Clay Shaw) to the
     penitentiary.  Phelan left New Orleans and Baton Rouge and returned
     to New York, only to telephone Russo several times and offer to pay
     Russo's plane fare to New York to meet with him and discuss going
     over to Clay Shaw's side.
        Phelan was subpoenaed by Shaw's lawyers during a hearing in 1967
     because his article attacked Garrison.  Sciambra welcomed the
     opportunity to cross-examine Phelan on the stand.  He described the
     article as being incomplete, distorted and tantamount to lying.
     Sciambra said, "I guarantee that he (Phelan) will be exposed for
     having twisted the facts in order to build up a scoop for himself
     and the `Saturday Evening Post.'"
        Sciambra went on to say that Phelan had neglected the most
     important fact of all in his article.  It was that Phelan had been
     told by Russo in Baton Rouge that Russo and Sciambra had discussed
     the plot dialogue (to assassinate JFK) at their initial meeting.


                         Capital City Broadcasting

        This organization owns several radio stations in the capitol
     cities of various states and in Washington, D.C.  Their interests
     in the JFK assassination increased in 1967 and 1968 when the
     Garrison-Shaw case made headlines.  A producer at Capital City,
     Erik Lindquist, decided to do a series of programs designed to
     ferret out the truth.  The author furnished various evidence for
     scripts to be used in the programs.  After several months of work
     the project was cancelled, presumably by top management, and the
     broadcasts never took place.


                     North American Newspaper Alliance

        This newspaper chain, with papers affiliated in small
     communities through the northern and eastern U.S., supported the
     Warren Commission findings as did all the other major newspaper
     services and chains.
        The Alliance also became involved in the Martin Luther King case
     and it circulated the syndicated column by the black writer and
     reporter, Louis Lomax, who had taken an interest in finding out
     what really happened in the King assassination.
        Lomax located a man named Stein who had taken a trip with James
     Earl Ray from Los Angeles to New Orleans.  The two retraced the
     automobile trip of Ray and Stein, beginning in Los Angeles and
     heading through Arizona, New Mexico and Texas.  They were trying to
     find the telephone booth from which Ray had called a friend named
     Raoul in New Orleans somewhere along the route.  Raoul, according
     to Ray, was the man who actually fired the shot that killed King.
     Stein remembered that Ray told him he was going to meet Raoul in
     New Orleans and that Ray phoned Raoul at someone's office.  Stein
     couldn't remember exactly where the phone booth was because he and
     Ray had been driving non-stop day and night.
        Lomax wrote a series of articles depicting Raoul as the killer
     and Ray as the patsy.  He sent them to the Alliance, a column each
     day, from the places along the retraced trip he and Stein took.
     Finally, Lomax's column announced they had found the phone booth at
     a gas station in Texas and that he was going to obtain the phone
     number Ray had called in New Orleans.  He presumably was planning
     to visit the local telephone company office the next morning and
     obtain the number.
        That was the last Lomax column ever to appear in the North
     American Alliance papers.  He seemed to disappear completely.  The
     readers were left hanging, not knowing whether he obtained the
     phone number or whether he discovered who it belonged to.  The
     Committee to Investigate Assassinations located Lomax several
     months later and asked him what had happened.
        He said he had been told by the FBI to stop his investigation
     and not to publish or write any more stories about it.  He said he
     found the phone number and where it was located in New Orleans.  He
     gave the number to the Committee to Investigate Assassinations.  He
     said he was afraid he would be killed and decided to stop work on
     the case.
        Whether North American Newspaper Alliance management knew about
     any of this remains unknown.  What is known, however, is that Louis
     Lomax died in a very mysterious manner in 1970.  He was traveling
     at a very high speed and was found dead in a car crash, according
     to the State police report.  Lomax's wife says he was a very
     careful driver and never drove at high speeds.

From [email protected] Thu Jun 11 08:37:11 1992
Received: from pl122c.eecs.lehigh.edu by ns-mx.uiowa.edu (5.64.jnf/920408)
         on Thu, 11 Jun 92 08:37:01 -0500 id AA02015 with SMTP
Received: from SGI.COM by PL122c.EECS.Lehigh.EDU (5.61/1.34)
       id AA17732; Thu, 11 Jun 92 09:22:19 -0400
Received: from [192.102.132.11] by sgi.sgi.com via SMTP (911016.SGI/910110.SGI)
       for [email protected] id AA19154; Thu, 11 Jun 92 06:24:54 -0700
Received: by ratmandu.esd.sgi.com (920110.SGI/920502.SGI.AUTO)
       for @sgi.sgi.com:[email protected] id AA04892; Thu, 11 Jun 92 06:24:51 -0700
Date: Thu, 11 Jun 92 06:24:51 -0700
From: [email protected] (dave "who can do? ratmandu!" ratcliffe)
Message-Id: <[email protected]>
To: [email protected]
Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (5/11)
Status: RO


Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (5/11)
Summary: we were robbed of our capability of electing a president we wanted
Keywords:  part 5 of 11:  second/last half of chapter 9
Lines: 908


                             Dallas Newspapers

        The two newspapers in Dallas, "The Times Herald" and "The
     Morning News," became accessories after the fact.  They suppressed
     evidence of conspiracy and evidence concerning the Dallas police
     role in framing Lee Harvey Oswald.  It was not immediately
     established that the management policy of both papers supported the
     official positions taken by the Dallas police and district
     attorney, the FBI and the Warren Commission.  During the first few
     days immediately following the assassination, both newspapers
     printed anything that came along.  The editions on November 22
     through 25 make very interesting reading for the researcher because
     the stories were printed before anyone had any idea what to
     suppress.  (For example, there are stories about other people being
     arrested, about other rifles being found near Dealey Plaza, and
     about Oswald's rifle being a Mauser and a British 303 model.)
        Editorial and management policy took over within a couple of
     weeks and the lone assassin story received all the attention from
     then on.  The two papers have not since made any independent
     inquiries, have not been interested in any conspiratorial
     discussions, and have remained completely faithful to the official
     governmental position.
        There were some inquiring reporters around (like Ronnie Dugger,
     for example, or Lonnie Hudkins), but they were eventually silenced
     by management or the FBI and Dallas police.  Photographers at the
     two papers left town or were frightened out of talking about the
     case or their photographs.  Some of these photographs showed
     evidence of conspiracy, including pictures of three conspirators
     under arrest in Dealey Plaza.  Other photographs proved that
     members of the Dallas police planted evidence in the Depository
     building to frame Oswald.
        Between the assassination and 1967, the management and owners of
     the "Herald" and "News" were not completely aware of the
     significance of some of the evidence in their files.  Nor were they
     attempting to control their reporters and news staff.  For example,
     Hudkins found that Oswald had been a paid informer for the FBI.  He
     even found what his pay number had been (S172).  He took the
     information to Waggoner Carr, Texas Attorney General, in January of
     1964.  Carr brought it to the attention of the Warren Commission.
     Hoover denied it, and the matter died in secret executive sessions
     of the Warren Commission.
        Several photographs taken by "Dallas Morning News" photographer
     Jack Beers proved that the police created the so-called "sniper's
     nest" from which Oswald allegedly fired the shots.  The pictures
     show the positions of cartons in the sixth floor window before the
     police moved them.  Beers's photographs also indicate that the
     police made the large paper bag found inside the Depository
     building.
        Beers was permitted to use his photographs commercially in a
     book that he published jointly with R. B. Denson, called "Destiny
     in Dallas."  If it were not for that event, researchers would
     probably never have seen Beers's photographs.  Once the "Morning
     News" editor, Mr. Krueger, discovered that the photographs
     demonstrated both conspiracy and the complicity of some of the
     Dallas police force, he locked them up.  The pictures remain
     suppressed to this date.
        The "Times Herald"'s record is not much better.  Through 1967
     John Masiotta, the man in charge of the assassination photographs
     taken by William Allen, made copies available on a very limited
     basis.  The basis in the author's case was that a total of twelve
     pictures out of seventy-three taken by Allen could be purchased.
     The author was allowed to examine 35mm contact prints (about 3/4 X
     1/2 inches) of the rest, and the selection decision was extremely
     difficult.  Three of Allen's photographs showed the "tramps" under
     arrest who were part of the conspiracy.
        In 1968 the "Times Herald" management realized the implications
     of some of Allen's pictures in pointing out the real assassins, and
     locked their files.  To date they have not permitted anyone to see
     the photos again or to purchase copies.
        One photograph taken by "Dallas Times Herald" photographer Bob
     Jackson was so obviously in opposition to the official police
     position that it was suppressed by late 1966.  Jackson was riding
     in one of the news photographer's cars in the motorcade with
     "Dallas Morning News" photographer, Tom Dillard.  As Jackson's car
     approached the Depository building and travelled north on Houston
     Street, between Main Street and Elm Street, Jackson snapped a
     picture (see map in May 1970 "Computers & Automation" article).  At
     the time, the Kennedy car was already on Elm Street and was
     probably close to the position where the first shot was fired.
     Jackson's car was eight cars behind Kennedy's (about twenty car
     lengths).
        Jackson can be seen taking this picture in the Robert Hughes
     film and in some of the TV footage taken by other photographers.
     He also testified that he took the picture.  When the author asked
     Masiotta about the Jackson photo in early 1967, he became very
     flustered and claimed to know nothing about it.  Jackson himself
     was finally located and, when asked about it, became very angry and
     denied taking a picture.  That photograph has never been seen by
     anyone outside of the "Times Herald" staff.  It's not difficult to
     speculate about what it probably showed, since the Hughes film, the
     Weaver photo, the Dillard photo and the Tom Alyea TV sequence all
     show the same thing.  Jackson's photo, without doubt, showed
     "Oswald's window" in the Depository building empty when Oswald
     should have been in it--an embarrassing counterpoint to Jackson's
     testimony that he saw someone in that window with a rifle.  If
     Jackson's photo (or anyone else's for that matter) showed Oswald in
     the sixth floor window, the whole world would have heard about it
     on November 22, 1963.


                        Fort Worth "Star Telegram"

        The Fort Worth "Star Telegram" shines like a light in the Texas
     darkness.  It made photographic evidence from five of their
     photographers, Joe McAulay, Harry Cabluck, Jerrold Cabluck, George
     Smith and William Davis available to everyone.  Even though the
     "Telegram"'s editorial stance was eventually pro-Warren Commission,
     the photographers, editors and the woman who ran the photo files
     were all cooperative.
        George Smith's photos showed the three members of the
     assassination team under arrest.  Jerrold Cabluck's aerial photos
     were instrumental in establishing Dealey Plaza landmarks and
     topography.  Joe McAulay's photos of a man arrested in Ft. Worth in
     connection with the shooting might yet become valuable.


                              TV Station WFAA

        The second shining light in Texas was TV station WFAA, an ABC
     affiliate.  WFAA was very cooperative (albeit expensive) in
     providing copies of all their photographic evidence.  TV sequences
     by Tom Alyea, Malcolm Couch, A. J. L'Hoste and Ron Reiland were
     made easily viewable and the copies made available.  Much of this
     evidence demonstrating conspiracy was also sold to TV networks and
     newsreel companies.


                             WBAP -- Ft. Worth

        The NBC affiliate in Ft. Worth, WBAP, was less cooperative.
     Even though public statements were made that viewing of Dan Owens
     and Jim Darnell's footage was possible, many roadblocks were thrown
     into the path of researchers.  As mentioned in the section on NBC,
     Darnell's footage of the knoll and parking lot is very important.
     It has remained unavailable at WBAP.


                              KTTV -- Dallas

        Independent TV station KTTV in Dallas also suppressed, or lost,
     valuable evidence of conspiracy.  Don Cook's TV footage contained
     twelve important sequences.  One is a sequence of a man being
     arrested in front of the Depository building at about 1:00 p.m.
     From other evidence it is possible to determine that the man may be
     William Sharp, participant in the assassination.  Cook can be seen
     in a picture taken by Phil Willis pointing his 16mm TV film camera
     directly at the man from about ten feet away.
        Willis' photo does not show the man's face.  For this reason,
     Cook's close-up footage is very important.  In 1967 the author
     interviewed Cook in Dallas and found that his film had been turned
     over to the editor at KTTV.  A phone call to the station resulted
     in a statement being made to the author that Cook's footage had
     been lost "on the cutting room floor" and was not available for
     viewing.  No further efforts have even been made to open up KTTV's
     evidence in the assassination.


                          New Orleans Newspapers

        The only two publications in the United States that printed the
     truth about the Clay Shaw trial were the New Orleans "Times
     Picayune" and the New Orleans "Times Herald."
        Between 1963 and 1967 both New Orleans newspapers used AP and UP
     stories on most of their coverage of the Kennedy assassination.
     Suddenly, the papers found themselves deeply involved in the middle
     of the sensational Garrison investigation, and in 1969 they
     reported on the Shaw trial.
        The papers took no editorial position on Jim Garrison, the
     trial, the investigation, the assassination, or the guilt or
     innocence of Shaw until after the final verdict was delivered by
     the jury.  Then both papers savagely attacked Garrison on the
     editorial page.  Off the record, the reporters and others at both
     papers supported Garrison.  This was reflected in a book published
     by the two "Herald" reporters, Rosemary James and Jack Wardlaw,
     called "Plot or Politics."
        The management and editors of the newspapers evidently paid more
     attention to forces from Washington and New York than they did to
     New Orleans citizens or the testimony at the trial.
        But the verbatim proceedings at the Shaw trial, as well as all
     of the detailed events for the two years that the Federal
     Government successfully delayed the trial, were faithfully printed
     in both the "Herald" and the "Picayune."  While you and I, dear
     reader, were treated to a highly biased account for three years
     concerning events in New Orleans by "Time" magazine, "Newsweek,"
     "U.S. News," "The New York Times," NBC, CBS, ABC, UP, AP, etc., the
     average New Orleans citizen was well aware that the Justice
     Department, under both Ramsey Clark and John Mitchell, was
     responsible for continually delaying the trail.  (You and I were
     fed the impression that Garrison delayed the trial.)
        Mr. New Orleans citizen, let's call him Joe, knew that Shaw's
     lawyers were paid by the CIA.  You and I were told that Shaw paid
     his lawyers a lot of money and suffered financially because of it.
        Joe knew that the FBI was looking for Shaw under his alias, Clay
     Bertrand, before lawyer Dean Andrews ever mentioned the name
     associated with Lee Harvey Oswald just before he was killed by Jack
     Ruby.  You and I were told that Andrews fabricated the name Clay
     Bertrand out of whole cloth, and no mention was made to us of the
     FBI's search.
        Joe knew that twelve people saw Clay Shaw together with Oswald
     and David Ferrie on many occasions, exchanging money on two
     occasions.  You and I were led to believe by "Time" and "The New
     York Times" that only three people saw them together and that the
     three were not credible witnesses.
        Joe knows how Garrison was hounded and framed by the Justice
     Department in a fake pinball rap.  More importantly, he knows the
     government did not want Regis Kennedy, FBI agent, and Pierre Finck,
     Army doctor at the JFK autopsy, to testify at the trial.
        Finck's testimony, however, was printed in the "Times Picayune"
     but not in "Time" magazine.  He said that an Army general gave
     orders during the autopsy at Bethesda Naval Hospital.  The
     unidentified general told Finck and the other doctors not to probe
     the President's neck wound.  We did not read about this or hear
     about it.
        The "Times Picayune" record of the Shaw trial was especially
     accurate.  The "Herald"'s record was reasonably accurate, but
     because the paper was printed by 3:00 p.m., the paper missed some
     of the longer sessions.[9]


                          WDSU-TV -- New Orleans

        As mentioned in the section on NBC, WDSU became directly
     involved in the JFK assassination aftermath because of Rick Townley
     and Walter Sheridan.  Both were under indictment by Garrison for
     bribing witnesses and tampering with evidence.  Townley, on the
     staff of WDSU, was close to the action with Garrison, Shaw,
     Andrews, Ferrie, Perry Russo, Layton Martens, Gordon Novel, Sergio
     Arcacha Smith, David Lewis, David Llewelyn, Guy Banister, and many
     other participants in the drama.
        According to accounts in the New Orleans papers and repeated in
     Paris Flammonde's book "The Kennedy Conspiracy," Townley tried to
     get Perry Russo, Garrison's prime witness at the Shaw trial, to
     change his testimony at the upcoming trial to make it seem that
     Garrison had hypnotized him and then asked leading questions to get
     Russo to testify against Shaw.
        Townley went to Russo's house twice, threatened to discredit him
     and perhaps have him fired from his job, and offered him a chance
     to work closely with NBC in their efforts to "destroy Garrison and
     his case".  Townley told Russo he could get Shaw's lawyer, F.
     Irving Dymond, to go easy on him if he would alter his testimony.
     He assured Russo that his employer, Equitable Life, had promised
     the president of NBC that no retaliation would be taken against
     Russo if he cooperated with WDSU and NBC.
        Walter Sheridan told Russo that NBC and WDSU could set him up in
     California (where Russo always wanted to live) if he helped break
     the Garrison probe's back.  NBC would pay his expenses there,
     protect his job, obtain a lawyer for Russo and guarantee that
     Garrison would never extradite him to Louisiana.  Sheridan told
     Russo that NBC had flown Gordon Novel out of Louisiana to McLean,
     Virginia (home of the CIA) and had given Novel (an important
     witness for Garrison's case) a lie detector test.  Sheridan said
     NBC would make sure Novel would never be extradited to Louisiana to
     testify.  (Novel never was extradited.)
        Townley also tried to influence Marlene Mancuso, former wife of
     Gordon Novel, and an important Shaw trial witness.  He told her
     that she should cooperate with WDSU and NBC because Garrison was
     going to be destroyed and that NBC was not merely willing to
     discredit the probe:  he said Garrison would go to jail.
        On July 10, 1967, Richard Townley was arrested and charged with
     attempted bribery and two counts of intimidating two witnesses.  He
     was also accused of serving as an intermediary to influence cross-
     examining trial attorneys that the character and reputation of
     Perry Russo not be damaged.
        Sheridan was arrested on July 7 on the counts of intimidating
     witnesses and attempted bribery.  Both posted bond.  Townley's
     statements, however, did come true.  The Federal Government, aided
     and abetted by WDSU and NBC, did crucify Garrison.
        The author's belief is that this kind of behavior in the face of
     all the evidence gathered by the staffs of their own organizations,
     on the part of 15 to 24 major news media management groups is
     highly suspect.  It might be that each major news organization shut
     up about the Kennedy assassination because each was afraid of
     losing face or influence, FCC licenses, business or advertisers, or
     Government favors of one kind or another.
        This theory is perhaps best exemplified by a story told by
     Dorothy Kilgallen, before she died, to a close friend.  Kilgallen
     was writing several articles about the JFK assassination for the
     newspapers who published her column.  She strongly believed there
     had been a conspiracy that included Jack Ruby.  She interviewed
     Ruby alone in his jail cell in Dallas (the only person outside of
     the police who had this opportunity).  She told her friend shortly
     afterward that she was planning to "blow the case wide open" in her
     column.  She said the owner of the New York newspaper where her
     column appeared refused to let her print stories in opposition to
     the Warren Commission.  When the friend asked her why, Dorothy
     said, "He's afraid he won't be invited to White House parties any
     more".
        Of the three possible motives for suppression in the news media,
     the influence from the top and from high government places seems
     the most probable.  When will we, as Americans, learn the truth
     about influence in the case of the Kennedy assassination?


                                Conclusions

        The pattern of internal knowledge of conspiracy followed by the
     complete suppression of such information is too strong to ignore.
     Two conclusions suggest themselves as one reviews the evidence
     regarding suppression and secrecy.
        The first is that our national news media are controlled on the
     subject of the assassination by some very high level group in
     Washington.  The orders to cease, desist, and suppress came from
     the top in each case.  To influence the very top level of all
     fifteen major news media organizations would have taken a great
     deal more than money, power, or threats.  In fact, the only kind of
     appeal which seems likely to have had a chance of shutting everyone
     up is a "highly patriotic, national security," kind of appeal.  It
     was probably just such an argument that worked with the Warren
     Commission.  Judging by the fact that Lyndon B. Johnson told Walter
     Cronkite there was a conspiracy and then successfully persuaded CBS
     to edit this out of his remarks "on grounds of national security,"
     this kind of an appeal obviously does work.
        The second possibility, rather remote from a probability
     standpoint, should nevertheless be considered.  It is that all 15
     to 24 news organizations reached a point of exasperation and
     disbelief in 1968-1969.  It's possible the top managers of these 24
     organizations reached this exasperation point independent of one
     another.  Within a two to three-year period, culminating in the
     Shaw trial and discrediting of Jim Garrison, every one of these
     managers might finally have said, "Stop, cease, desist, lock the
     files, you're fired, shut up, I don't want to hear another word
     about it."


                                   1976

        How, one may ask, could all of this have happened in the world's
     greatest democracy?  What has become of the principles of the
     Founding Fathers, Horace Greeley, Will Rogers and others, in which
     the "free" press is supposedly our best protection from the misuse
     of governmental power.  Didn't things change with Watergate?  What
     about the "New York Times" and the "Pentagon Papers," the
     "Washington Post," Bernstein and Woodward, Watergate, NBC's white
     paper on Vietnam, Sy Hersh and the CIA stories in the "New York
     Times"?
        The actions taking place in November-December, 1975 and on into
     1976, proved the media were still influenced and controlled by the
     same forces that controlled the media in 1968 and 1969.  Some of
     the names of the players were different:  Ford for Nixon, Colby for
     Helms, Kelley for J. Edgar Hoover.  But the forces were the same.
     The chairmen of the boards and presidents of NBC, CBS, ABC, Time,
     Inc., "Newsweek"-"Washington Post," "Los Angeles Times," "Chicago
     Tribune," UPI, AP, and the rest, were still very much controlled
     and influenced by the White House and the Secret Team.  Some of the
     influence was by infiltration, as Fletcher Prouty so aptly
     demonstrated.[10]
        The Secret Team members were to be found everywhere at or near
     the top.  Other influence came from the Ford administration through
     direct or indirect pressure.  The FCC, the IRS, the Department of
     Commerce, the military and other government agencies had some
     control over the media or the personal lives of the top managers.
     (It must be remembered that Gerald Ford was and is one of the
     cover-up conspirators in the JFK case.)


                           What is the Evidence?

        What is the evidence for this?  One measures the influence by
     results.  In an era when all who have really examined the basic
     evidence know there were conspiracies in the JFK and RFK
     assassinations, we still find the 15 organizations concluding there
     were lone, demented gunmen in the two cases.
        For example, CBS broadcast a two-part special on November 25 and
     26, 1975, once again reinforcing their stand that Oswald acted
     alone.  Except for the substitution of Dan Rather as chief narrator
     in place of Walter Cronkite, the cast was the same as in the 1967
     four-part series.  Leslie Midgely was the producer, Bernie
     Birnbaum, the associate producer, and Jane Bartels, Birnbaum's
     girl-Friday.  Eric Sevareid and Eddie Barker were missing.  So was
     Bob Richter, another 1967 associate producer who had discovered the
     truth about the conspiracy and the way CBS handled it.  (He now
     manages his own film-making company, Richter-McBride, in New York.)
     Richter's opinion about the 1967 CBS four-part special, as
     expressed in an interview with Jerry Policoff published in "New
     Times" magazine in October 1975,[11] barred him from becoming a
     consultant to Midgely on the November 25 and 26 programs.


                       Hard Evidence Never Mentioned

        Time, Inc., in their November 17, 1975 issue supported the lone
     assassin myth as they have since 1964.[12]  Since "Life" was no
     longer in existence, Time management used "Time" and "People"
     magazines to further the causes of the White House and the CIA in
     the cover-up of the cover-ups.  The November 3, 1975 issue[13] of
     "People" magazine hand-picked a group of "researchers" and
     portrayed them as obvious maniacs who believed in and furthered the
     conspiracy theories being bandied about.  One of the favorite
     tricks of the media throughout the years has been to couple the
     words "conspiracy" and "theory" together;  never once did the major
     media mention any of the hard evidence pointing to conspiracy in
     any of the four major cases.  The "Time" policy and article,
     according to Jerry Policoff, was commanded from the very top, above
     Hedley Donovan's level.[14]
        The fine hand of David Belin can be traced in the "Time"
     article.  All of the 1964 arguments against conspiracy were aired
     once again, as though they were brand new.


                The Forces of Good vs. the Forces of Evil:

                         A Life and Death Struggle

        David Belin:  Belin shows up in several places.  He constructed
     a new CIA-White House base on behalf of his superiors by personally
     writing most of Chapter 19 of the Rockefeller Report on the CIA and
     the FBI.  That material was used by Belin and others to try and
     shore up the Warren Commission defenses.
        The reader may ask, "Why did Belin appear on `Face the Nation'
     on November 23, 1975 and get himself on the front page of the `New
     York Times' on the same day by proposing the reopening of the JFK
     case?"[15]  The answer lies in Belin's own explanation.  He wants
     America to see that a new investigation will confirm the findings
     of the Warren Commission, thereby strengthening the country's faith
     in its government.  Just how did Belin manage to get on "Face the
     Nation" and on the first page of the "New York Times?"  To answer
     that you must analyze the life and death struggle that is going on
     between the forces of evil who want to continue the cover-ups, and
     the forces of good who want to expose the truth.  Senators Richard
     Schweiker and Gary Hart and the Church Committee's subcommittee
     looking into the JFK assassination were not the push-overs that
     Mark Lane, Harold Weisberg and others once were.  There were also
     Henry B. Gonzalez and Thomas Downing and their new resolutions in
     the House, not to mention Don Edwards' subcommittee and Bella
     Abzug's subcommittee.
        The evil forces needed to muster the strongest counterattack
     possible at this stage.  For them it was a matter of life and
     death.  So they rounded up David Belin, Joseph Ball, Wesley
     Liebeler, John J. McCloy, Dr. John Lattimer, the old Ramsey Clark
     panel of doctors who secretly went into the Archives in 1968, and
     some of the coterie of writers who were in their camp in the
     1960's.


                        "I've Seen No New Evidence"

        Any doubts about Belin's recruitment by Ford and the White House
     disappeared with Gerald Ford's press conference on Wednesday,
     November 26, 1975.  A reporter asked Ford whether he would support
     reopening the JFK investigation.[16]  He said, "I, of course,
     served on the Warren Commission.  And I know a good deal about the
     hearings and the committee report, obviously.  There are some new
     developments--not evidence--but new developments that, according to
     one of our best staff members (David Belin), who's kept up to date
     on it more than I, that he thinks just to lay those charges (of
     conspiracy) aside that a new investigation ought to be undertaken.
     He, at the same time, said that no new evidence has come up.  If
     those particular developments could be fully investigated without
     reopening the whole matter that took us 10 months to conclude, I
     think some responsible group or organization ought to do so.  But
     not to reopen all of the other aspects because I think they were
     thoroughly covered by the Warren Commission."
        Thus Ford, in one of his own inimitable paragraphs, tried to
     give the impression that he was following the lead of David Belin-
     -rather than the other way around--in the continued cover-up
     efforts.  Earl Warren was always saying, "I've seen no new
     evidence."  Ford, Belin and the rest were forced to echo this
     refrain, as though all of the things that have been learned since
     1964 about the real assassins of John Kennedy and their planners
     and backers, were false rumors or stories and theories created out
     of whole cloth by the researchers and later by Congress.[17]


                             Pure Coincidence?

        One CIA-White House lackey is James Phelan, formerly a freelance
     writer for the old "Saturday Evening Post."  Phelan was brought out
     of mothballs to do a pro-Warren Commission piece in the "New York
     Times" Sunday magazine section.[18]  By pure coincidence, it
     happened to appear on the same day that Belin's arranged interview
     was found on page one.  The "Times" is one of the worst, if not the
     worst, news media organization on the evil side of the battle.
        An article in the July 1971 issue of "Computers and
     Automation"[19] shows that the CIA control of the "Times" had for
     years been directed through Harding Bancroft, the Secret Team
     member there.  He controlled all stories and editorial positions on
     domestic assassinations.  He undoubtedly arranged for both stories
     to appear on the same day.[20]


                    CBS.  Cover-Up Broadcasting System

        The Belin appearance on the CBS show, "Face the Nation", was no
     doubt timed to coincide with the first two parts of the new CBS
     whitewash series.  (The new name for CBS is "Cover-Up Broadcasting
     System".)  The men at the top made the decisions in 1967 and 1975
     to support the Warren Commission, and Leslie Midgeley carried them
     out.  In 1967 the entire program format was changed by top
     management from pro-conspiracy to pro-Warren Commission in the last
     ten days before the first show went on the air.[21]  By 1975 there
     wasn't any doubt about the conclusions.  Midgeley and Co. started
     out with the lone assassin thesis and, as the Warren Commission
     did, merely sought witnesses, experts and explanations that would
     back it up, while they totally ignored everything else.
        The CIA's man at CBS who controlled this policy is not known.
     Personal experiences and contacts within the organization by the
     author have led to the conclusion that it is someone below the
     level of William C. Paley and above the level of Midgeley.  That
     leaves Richard Salant and one or two other possibilities.  Salant
     is known to have had intelligence connections through the decades
     since World War II.


                            Too Perfect Timing

        CBS and the "New York Times" are sometimes simultaneously
     orchestrated by the evil forces.  One example was the CBS show
     preview by the "Times" on November 24 (the show was scheduled to
     appear on November 25 and 26).[22]  The article, written by John J.
     O'Connor, was a reverse-psychology strategy by the top managements
     of both organizations and was used to reinforce their pro-Warren
     Commission policies.  To quote O'Connor, "In bringing some facts to
     bear on the feverish speculation, CBS News is less sensational but
     more telling."  This was in reference to David Susskind and Geraldo
     Rivera on Channel 5 in New York, and ABC, who the "Times" believed
     provided no facts in disputing the lone assassin conclusion.
        How did O'Connor and the "New York Times" take a look at the CBS
     shows *two days in advance* while other publications and reviewers
     had to wait and watch it with the rest of us?  There goes the
     orchestration again.


                      "Newsweek" Editorial Position:
               Schweiker, Hart and Gonzalez Misled by Kooks

        The "Washington Post"-"Newsweek" situation is a little more
     mystifying.  It is difficult to believe that Katherine Graham,
     owner of both publications, is a Secret Team member.  The
     "Newsweek" story on the JFK assassination, published in the issue
     of April 28, 1975[23] was not as blatantly pro-Warren Commission as
     the "Time" article.  Yet it left the impression with the readers of
     "Newsweek" that editorial position regarded the researchers as
     kooks who misled or talked Senator Schweiker and Representatives
     Gonzalez and Downing into the wrong attitudes.  "Oswald did fire
     the shots" is the "Newsweek" message.  Individuals at "Newsweek"
     like Evert Clark did not really believe this.  So where did the
     pressure come from?  Mrs. Graham herself, or Benjamin Bradlee at
     the "Post," or someone else near the top of "Newsweek?"  With
     reporters like Bernstein and Woodward, and Haynes Johnson who later
     moved into management, it is strange that the "Post" supported the
     Warren Commission.  Yet that has been the "Post"'s editorial stance
     since 1964.  It remains adamant in its continuing contention that
     lone madmen assassinated our three leaders and attempted to
     assassinate Wallace.


                         Eliminate Areas of Doubt

        Researcher Jim Blickenstaff, disturbed by a "Newsweek" article
     in April of 1975, wrote to the editors.  Madeline Edmundson replied
     for them.  "It was certainly not our aim to discredit those who
     doubt the conclusions of the Warren Commission or to express
     opposition to a reopening of the investigation of John F. Kennedy's
     assassination."
        Yet, "Newsweek" did exactly that and, in effect, took the same
     editorial position it had taken in May, 1967, when CIA lackey Hugh
     Aynesworth was doing their dirty work.  (Aynesworth later did the
     CIA's dirty work and supported the Warren Commission for the
     "Dallas Times Herald.")  The new position in favor of reopening the
     investigation was the one taken by Belin.  It was expressed best by
     Harrison Salisbury, the man at the "New York Times" who knew
     better.  Salisbury was quoted in "Newsweek" saying, "A new
     investigation is needed to answer questions of major importance.
     We will go over all the areas of doubt and hope to eliminate them."


       UPI:  Accessory After the Fact in the JFK Conspiracy Cover-Up

        AP and UPI have not repeated their 1967-1968 performances
     recently in which they sent out the longest stories ever broadcast
     over their news service wires.  They were so long that they were
     divided into installments.  The stories backed up the Warren
     Commission and attacked the researchers, especially Jim Garrison.
     UPI, of course, became an accessory after the fact in the JFK
     conspiracy cover-up by suppressing the original 8mm color films by
     Marie Muchmore and Orville Nix.  It went even further by employing
     Itek Corporation to prove there was no one on the grassy knoll.
        In July of 1975 a UPI alumnus, Maurice Schonfeld, published an
     article in "Columbia Journalism Review"[24] that subtly contended
     one of the riflemen on the knoll as seen in the original Nix film
     was either an illusion or a man without a rifle.


                             "Expert" Opinions

        Itek:  Itek is still at work helping out their friendly
     employers, the U.S. government and the CIA.  Itek analyzed the
     Zapruder film and the Hughes film on the CBS program aired in
     November of 1975, giving its "expert" opinion that all shots fired
     in Dealey Plaza came from the sixth floor window of the TSBD
     Building.
        Maurice Schonfeld, perhaps unwittingly, did a favor for
     researchers in his "Columbia Journalism Review" article that
     revealed that two officials of Itek, Howard Sprague and Franklin T.
     Lindsay, were CIA Secret Team members.  So when Ford, Belin and
     Salant or whoever at CBS needed help, all they had to do was call
     upon good old Itek and Howard Sprague.  (Frank Lindsay has since
     departed.)


                 AP:  Faithful to the White House and CIA

        Associated Press has been editorially silent since 1969.  They
     have faithfully broadcast all of the White House-CIA cover or
     planted stories without comment.


                            Keeping the Lid On

        "Los Angeles Times:"  "The Los Angeles Times," controlled by
     Norman Chandler who was strongly influenced by the Ford
     administration, the CIA and Evelle Younger (the Attorney General of
     California), produced a complete cover-up effort in the Robert
     Kennedy assassination conspiracy.  Younger, of course, was D.A. in
     Los Angeles County when RFK was killed.  He and Ed Davis, L.A.
     Police Chief, teamed up with Joseph Busch, assistant D.A., to cover
     up the conspiracy evidence.  The "Times" for a short, unguarded
     period allowed reporter Dave Smith to publish the truth about the
     assassination.  This stopped in 1974, after Al Lowenstein stirred
     Vincent Bugliosi, Baxter Ward, Thomas Bradley, and finally Governor
     Pat Brown, Jr. to take a new interest in the case.
        Younger influenced Chandler to shut off the flow of information
     through the "Los Angeles Times."  Chandler, who contributed to the
     Nixon campaign, undoubtedly was strong-armed by both Nixon and Ford
     (or the CIA) to support the position of the Los Angeles police and
     the D.A.'s office.  Ronald Reagan and his immediate deputy at the
     time also helped sway Chandler and others in California to keep the
     lid on.


                 Zapruder Film Broadcast on Two Occasions

        The American Broadcasting Corporation was the first of the
     television networks to seemingly break away from CIA-White House
     control.  In the spring of 1975, after Robert Groden, Dick Gregory,
     Ralph Schoenman and Jerry Policoff decided to release and publicize
     a clear, enlarged, stop-action color copy of the Zapruder film, the
     ABC show hosted by Geraldo Rivera, "Good Night, America," showed
     the film on two occasions.  Rivera might have made this move
     against the wishes of top ABC management.  Rumor had it during the
     summer months that he was in hot water with high level people.  All
     doubts about ABC's position disappeared when they broadcast an
     assassination special during the week of November 17, 1975 that
     supported the lone assassin theory.


                            "Conspiracy Fever"

        "Commentary:"  One surprising newcomer to the cover-up
     conspiracy group is "Commentary."  The liberal, open-minded, non-
     government magazine "Commentary" broke their pattern in the October
     1975 issue[25] when it published an article by Dr. Jacob Cohen from
     Brandeis University which attacked the researchers as paranoid
     conspiratorialists.  Cohen has been writing these defenses for the
     Warren Commission for over ten years.  This article was republished
     in several other places in November, 1975, as part of the
     orchestrated campaign by the CIA-White House.


                           A Straight News Story

        "U.S. News and World Report:"  "U.S. News" may be one of the few
     media publications to change positions.  On September 15, 1975 they
     ran a story entitled, "Behind the Move to Reopen the JFK Case".  It
     was a straight news story about Senator Schweiker's efforts and
     list of uncovered evidence raising new questions.  The article
     closed with:  "Numerous Americans who long have doubted the Warren
     Commission conclusions will be watching what the Senate does with
     his (Schweiker's) idea."  That is as close as any of the fifteen
     organizations came to saying they believe the Warren Commission was
     wrong.


                           A Breath of Fresh Air

        "Saturday Evening Post:"  Like a breath of fresh air from the
     heartland of America in Indianapolis, Indiana, the revived
     "Saturday Evening Post" (Bobbs Merrill subsidiary) took an
     editorial stance.  The "Post" not only published several strong
     articles on the assassinations but also called for reopening all of
     the cases, supported the Gonzalez-Downing resolutions, and offered
     a sizable reward for information leading to conviction of the
     murderers of John F. Kennedy.[26]  Thus the "Post" joined the ranks
     of the "National Enquirer," "National Tattler," "National Insider,"
     "Argosy," "Penthouse," "Gallery," "Genesis" and other publications
     of this type, plus nearly all the "underground newspapers" in
     calling for new investigations.


                 CIA Operatives Are Serving as Journalists
                       For News Organizations Abroad

        "Variety:"  On November 12, 1975, "Variety" published an article
     on the House and Senate Intelligence Committees' suspicions about
     relationships between the CIA and broadcasting organizations.[27]
     "Variety" said the committees were probing the CIA's influence on
     the media organizations, particularly management connections, and
     commented, "A central issue in the investigations is reports of
     financial dealings with the CIA and media firms with extensive
     overseas staffs."
        William Colby admitted that CIA operatives were currently
     serving as journalists for news organizations abroad, and that
     "detailmen" were assigned abroad to news organizations, often
     without the knowledge of management.  Ronald Dellums, California
     representative asked Colby in an open session of a House hearing if
     the CIA had ever asked a network to kill a news story.  Colby would
     not answer specifics in open session, so the panel went immediately
     behind closed doors to grill him for several hours.


                                Conclusions

        It is to be hoped that all committees in the House and Senate
     will investigate the Secret Team members in the 15 media
     organizations and their influence and control over editorial
     policies on domestic assassination conspiracies.  It is also to be
     hoped that the committees will investigate the role of then-
     president Gerald Ford and his working relationship to various CIA
     people in the original cover-up of the John F. Kennedy
     assassination conspiracy.  Certainly, David Belin's relationship to
     the CIA and to Ford in the media cover-up campaign needs be
     investigated.
        Fletcher Prouty claimed in his November, 1975 article in
     "Gallery Magazine," "The Fourth Force,"[28] that Belin is a CIA
     operative.  Prouty says, "The Rockefeller Commission did not look
     into this (the Fourth Force-CIA) because it had been penetrated on
     behalf of the CIA by David Belin, its chief counsel and former
     counsel of the Warren Commission.  In fact, Belin still reports to
     the CIA."  If this is indeed true, it explains every move Belin has
     made since 1964 and it also explains the mysterious way he appeared
     and reappeared on the front pages and editorial pages of various
     major newspapers, on choice television shows, and on the
     Rockefeller Commission.
        If the Congress leaves the media-government-CIA link untouched-
     -more serious than any of the other problems raised by the
     assassination conspiracies and their cover-ups--the United States
     might, in fact, be headed for the real 1984.


                                Postscript

        On April 27, 1976 "The New York Times" published a story on the
     Senate Intelligence Committee revelation that the CIA would be
     keeping twenty-five journalist agents within the news media.[29]
     The Committee disclosed that George Bush planned to keep these
     people in the media positions that they had occupied for a long
     time.
        The significant point about the story was a statement by a
     Committee staff member that many of the individuals were in
     executive positions at American news organizations.  Bush had
     directed that the CIA stop hiring correspondents "accredited" by
     American publications and other news organizations.  The "Times"
     recognized that the pivotal word in Bush's directive was
     "accredited."  "Executives who do not work as correspondents are
     apparently not covered by Mr. Bush's directive, nor are freelance
     writers who are not affiliated with a specific employer."  The
     article also said that in most cases the media organization was not
     aware of the individual's CIA connection.
        This was yet the best confirmation that the CIA had its Secret
     Team members planted at the top of the media.  Only one executive
     is required at the top of a media organization to control it when
     needed.  Since the CIA had twenty-five executives planted, that
     figure is more than enough to control the fifteen media
     organizations mentioned in this chapter.
        Who are they?  The answer can be supplied by watching where the
     decisions come from to halt or change the news about domestic
     political assassinations.
        The indications from the analysis in this chapter are that the
     following media executives are among the twenty-five retained by
     the CIA:  Harding Bancroft, Jr.  ("New York Times"); Richard Salant
     (CBS);  George Love (Time, Inc./"Life");  Walter Sheridan (NBC);
     Lewis Powell, lawyer (ABC);  and Benjamin Bradlee ("Washington
     Post").



____________________

[1] "Accessories After the Fact" is the title of a book by Sylvia
    Meagher, published by Bobbs Merrill in 1967, accusing the Warren
    Commission and the various government agencies of covering up the
    crime of the century.  This book accuses the national news media
    of the same crimes.

[2] Black Star is a New York based organization made up of free-
    lance photographers, called stringers, in every major city.  They
    do contract work for news media with Black Star acting as
    contracting agent.

[3] Samuel Thurston, "The Central Intelligence Agency and `The New
    York Times,'" "Computers and Automation," July, 1971.

[4] CBS-TV Special on the Assassination of John Kennedy -- June 25,
    26, 27 and 28, 1972.

[5] "Computers and Automation," July, 1971

[6] For a more detailed analysis of the "Times"' culpability and
    selective bias in reporting the facts of the assassination, see
    Jerry Policoff's October 1972 article in "The Realist:"  "How All
    the News About Political Assassinations In the United States Has
    Not Been Fit to Print in `The New York Times.'"

[7] A detailed review of NBC's performance and Walter Sheridan's and
    Richard Townley's involvement is given in "The Kennedy Conspiracy"
    by Paris Flammonde.

[8] Those interested in more detail are referred to the map in the
    May 1970 issue of "Computers and Automation" on the JFK
    assassination.  The UPI definition of "the grassy knoll" was the
    area bounded by the picket fence, the stone wall, the top of the
    steps on the south, and the cupola.

[9] For a comparison of New Orleans newspapers and all other media
    coverage of the Shaw trial, see the author's unpublished book
    "The Trial of Clay Shaw -- The Truth and the Fiction."

[10] Prouty, L. Fletcher, "The Secret Team," Prentice Hall, 1973.

[11] Policoff, Jerry, "The Media and the Murder of John Kennedy", "New
    Times," October, 1975.

[12] "Who Killed JFK?  Just One Assassin," "Time" magazine, November
    24, 1975.

[13] "Up Front -- Did One Man With One Gun Kill John F, Kennedy?
    Eight Skeptics Who Say No," "People," November 3, 1975.

[14] Author's discussion with Jerry Policoff, November 29, 1975.

[15] "Warren Panel Aide Calls for 2nd Inquiry Into Kennedy Killing",
    "New York Times," November 23, 1975, p. 1.

[16] Transcript of Gerald Ford Press Conference "New York Times,"
    November 27, 1975.

[17] For a summary of the evidence and scenario about what it shows
    the reader is referred to two articles in "People and the
    Pursuit of Truth:"  "The Assassination of President John F.
    Kennedy the Involvement of the Central Intelligence Agency in the
    Plans and the Cover-Up," May 1975, and "Who Killed JFK?,"
    October, 1975.  Both by the author.

[18] Phelan, James R., "The Assassination," "New York Times Magazine
    Section," November 23, 1975.

[19] Thurston, Samuel F. (psuedonym for Richard E. Sprague), "The
    Central Intelligence Agency and `The New York Times'" "Computers
    and Automation," July, 1971.

[20] Bancroft retired in early 1976.  A successor has undoubtedly been
    groomed by the CIA.  However, Bancroft still has a strong
    influence at the "Times" on the subject of assassinations.

[21] Based on a discussion among the author, Dan Rather, and Robert
    Richter at CBS in Washington, D.C., approximately ten days before
    the first Cronkite-CBS section of the 1967 four-part series on
    the JFK assassination.

[22] O'Conner, John J., "TV:  CBS News is Presenting Two Hour-Long
    Programs on the Assassination of President Kennedy", "New York
    Times," November 24, 1975.

[23] "Dallas:  New Questions and Answers," "Newsweek," April 28, 1975.

[24] Schonfeld, Maurice W., "The Shadow of a Gunman," "Columbia
    Journalism Review," July-August, 1975.

[25] Cohen, John, "Conspiracy Fever," "Commentary," October, 1975.

[26] "Saturday Evening Post," September, October, November and
    December, 1975 issues.

[27] "D.C. Digs Deep Into TV News Ties With CIA," "Variety," November
    12, 1975.

[28] Prouty, L. Fletcher, "The Fourth Force," "Gallery," November,
    1975.

[29] "CIA Will Keep More Than 25 Journalist-Agents," "New York Times,"
    April 27, 1976, p. 26.







                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *


--
                                            daveus rattus

                                  yer friendly neighborhood ratman

                              KOYAANISQATSI

  ko.yaa.nis.qatsi (from the Hopi Language)  n.  1. crazy life.  2. life
      in turmoil.  3. life out of balance.  4. life disintegrating.
        5. a state of life that calls for another way of living.



From [email protected] Fri Jun 12 09:16:33 1992
Received: from pl122c.eecs.lehigh.edu by ns-mx.uiowa.edu (5.64.jnf/920408)
         on Fri, 12 Jun 92 09:16:18 -0500 id AA05588 with SMTP
Received: from SGI.COM by PL122c.EECS.Lehigh.EDU (5.61/1.34)
       id AA19548; Fri, 12 Jun 92 09:59:36 -0400
Received: from [192.102.132.11] by sgi.sgi.com via SMTP (911016.SGI/910110.SGI)
       for [email protected] id AA20770; Fri, 12 Jun 92 07:02:12 -0700
Received: by ratmandu.esd.sgi.com (920110.SGI/920502.SGI.AUTO)
       for @sgi.sgi.com:[email protected] id AA14133; Fri, 12 Jun 92 07:02:10 -0700
Date: Fri, 12 Jun 92 07:02:10 -0700
From: [email protected] (dave "who can do? ratmandu!" ratcliffe)
Message-Id: <[email protected]>
To: [email protected]
Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (6/11)
Status: RO


Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (6/11)
Summary: we were robbed of our capability of electing a president we wanted
Keywords:  part 6 of 11:  chapter 10 thru chapter 12
Lines: 1057


                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *




                                Chapter 10
      Techniques and Weapons and 100 Dead Conspirators and Witnesses

        As Chapter 1 made clear, one of the two fiendish stratagems used
     by the Power Control Group to cover-up the truth and to fool the
     people was the use of various intelligence techniques and weapons.
     The use of such techniques in assassination and murder completely
     conceals the real killer's presence or the real cause of death.
     From the moment the crime occurs the public is led to believe that
     there is either one lone madman assassin or that the death was
     accidental, due to natural causes, or committed by natural enemies
     of the victim.  Some of the techniques are so unique that they are
     nearly impossible for the average American to believe.
        The intelligence forces of the United States as well as those of
     other countries have out-Bonded James Bond.  The development of
     sophisticated murder methods and the control of humans for warfare
     and spying in other countries came home to the United States,
     effectively used by the Power Control Group.  Penn Jones, Jr.
     published a list of "mysterious deaths" in his series of four
     volumes, "Forgive My Grief."[1]  Sylvia Meagher published facts
     about the first eighteen witnesses at Dealey Plaza murdered through
     the use of these techniques in the book, "Accessories After the
     Fact."[2]  Very few people other than researchers pay any
     attention.  Two movies with somewhat wider circulation, "Executive
     Action" and "The Parallax View," covered the techniques fairly
     well, but they were considered to be fiction by most viewers.  So
     the PCG goes on murdering where and when it is necessary, and it
     covers up the murders where necessary.
        In 1974 and 1976, two murders became necessary.  Rolando
     Masferrer, mentioned as a JFK conspirator, became dangerous to the
     PCG, and he was eliminated in early 1976 with a non-sophisticated
     weapon.  A bomb was planted in his car in Miami.  The cover-up in
     this case merely involved planting an informer who claimed
     Masferrer was killed by a rival anti-Castro Cuban faction in
     Florida.[3]
        Clay Shaw became quite nervous in 1974 after Victor Marchetti's
     statements to the press earlier that year made it known that Shaw
     was a CIA contract employee and that the CIA gave him assistance
     and protection before his trial in New Orleans and after Jim
     Garrison arrested him.  Shaw was murdered in New Orleans by the PCG
     and the murder covered-up by simply controlling his embalming and
     burial and blocking any local investigation.[4]  The reason for his
     murder was to keep him from talking and from returning to the
     public eye.
        The techniques and weapons fall into several classes.  First,
     there are sophisticated weapons developed by the CIA.  An example
     of this is the umbrella poison dart gun used in Dealey Plaza to
     shoot JFK in the throat.  Such a weapon was postulated by Robert
     Cutler and the author in mid-1975 as the one that fired the first
     shot from near the Stemmons Freeway sign.[5]  This seemed
     incredulous to most observers and so wild an idea that the author
     and Cutler did not discuss it with many researchers.  Then Mr.
     Charles Senseney, a CIA weapon developer at Fort Detrick, Maryland,
     testified before the Senate Intelligence Committee in September
     1975 and described an umbrella poison dart gun he had made.[6]  He
     said it was always used in crowds with the umbrella open, firing
     through the webing so it would not attract attention.  Since it was
     silent, no one in the crowd could hear it and the assassin merely
     would fold up the umbrella and saunter away with the crowd.  (That
     is almost exactly what happened in Dealey Plaza.  The first shot
     had always seemed to have had a paralytic effect on Kennedy.  His
     fists were clenched and his head, shoulders and arms seemed to
     stiffen.  There was a small entrance wound in his neck but no
     evidence of a bullet path through his neck and no bullet was ever
     recovered that matched that small size.)
        Senseney testified that his Special Operations Division at Fort
     Detrick had received assignments from the CIA to develop exotic
     weaponry.  One of the weapons was a hand-held dart gun that could
     shoot a poison dart into a guard dog to put it out of action for
     several hours.  The dart and the poison left no trace so that
     examination would not reveal that the dogs had been put out of
     action.  The CIA ordered about 50 of these weapons and used them
     operationally.  Senseney said that the darts could have been used
     to kill human beings and he could not rule out the possibility that
     this had been done by the CIA.  He said he had developed a dart-
     launching device that looked like an umbrella.
        A special type of poison developed induces a heart attack and
     leaves no trace of any external influence unless an autopsy is
     conducted to check for this particular poison.  The CIA revealed
     this poison in various accounts in the early 1970s.
        Among the witnesses, important people and conspirators who might
     have been eliminated this way are:  Clay Shaw, J. Edgar Hoover,
     Earlene Roberts (Oswald's land-lady) and Adlai Stevenson.
        A second category, already discussed in the Robert Kennedy and
     George Wallace shootings, is the use of a "programmed" assassin.
     The Manchurian Candidate always seemed to be a science fiction
     story.  It is now well known that the CIA has used hypnosis and
     "programming" to achieve a number of objectives, including murder.
     Certainly there is little doubt that Sirhan Sirhan was under
     hypnosis when he wrote in his diary and when he fired the shots in
     the general direction of Robert Kennedy.[7]  There is also
     evidence that Arthur Bremer was "programmed" to shoot at George
     Wallace.  It is conceivable that one of the assassins in Dealey
     Plaza could have been "programmed".  A man surfaced after 1975
     who--under deprogramming--remembered a firing situation resembling
     Dealey Plaza.  However, it is much less likely that the PCG had to
     use hypnosis in the JFK murder.
        It is completely untrue that Oswald was programmed, as the book
     "Were We Controlled?" by Lincoln Lawrence (an alias for radio
     commentator Art Ford) postulates.  The evidence shows Oswald
     didn't fire a shot, that he was on the second floor of the TSBD
     Building at the time of the shots, and that he was very calm until
     Patrolman Baker pointed a gun at him.  Strangely enough, Ford's
     thesis is true.  We were controlled by the PCG, although he had the
     details wrong.
        A third popular technique is, of course, the patsy.  The PCG has
     developed this to the level of a real science.  The assassination
     is allowed to be obvious, but the assassin is presented as a single
     madman or criminal who acts alone.  Lee Harvey Oswald, Jack Ruby,
     James Earl Ray, Sirhan Sirhan and Arthur Bremer have all been
     patsies.  They are not all exactly alike, nor is the way in which
     they were used the same in each case.  For example, Oswald and Ray
     did not fire any shots, while Sirhan, Ruby and Bremer did.  Sirhan
     and Bremer were "programmed", whereas Ruby was talked into killing
     Oswald by his friends in the PCG.  Four of the five men were
     framed;  a lot of evidence was manufactured and planted to
     implicate them, including fake diaries, fake photographs, planted
     guns, bullets and shells, and men using their identities.  The one
     who did not fit this category was Ruby.  It was not needed in his
     case because he killed Oswald before live television and believed
     until the day he died of cancer that his friends were going to get
     him out of jail in exchange for his "patriotic" act.
        The use of "seconds", men who looked like the patsy and who used
     his name (true of Oswald, Ray and Sirhan) is a common intelligence
     technique.  The planting of fake photos in the case of Oswald
     required some relatively special photographic facilities, but the
     job was not done well enough to avoid detection.
        A fourth technique is the "accidental" death.  Many witnesses
     and conspirators have been murdered in this way.  Lee Bowers, the
     railroad yard control tower man who saw the real assassins behind
     the picket fence in Dealey Plaza, was killed when his car rammed
     into a concrete abutment in Dallas (it was traveling at high
     speed).  The doctor who examined Bowers prior to his removal from
     the car, stated that he probably received an injection of some
     kind prior to the crash.  Louis Lomax, the black author who was
     getting close to the truth in the Martin Luther King case, was
     killed in Arizona when his car was forced off the road after he
     was made to drive at high speed.  Hale Boggs disappeared in an
     airplane crash that left no trace of the plane.  And of course the
     classic "accident" occurred at Chappaquiddick.
        A fifth technique is an induced death that produces another
     finding of the cause either by disguising the true cause or by
     controlling the coroner or those in charge of burial.  Examples
     are:  David Ferrie's murder by means of a karate chop to the back
     of his head, disguised as an embolism of the brain, Clay Shaw's
     murder by means unknown because there was no autopsy and complete
     control of his removal and burial;  Jack Ruby's supposed death by
     cancer in jail (real cause unknown because he was never out of the
     PCG's hands until he was under ground).
        Then there is a favorite sixth technique:  mock suicide.
     Examples of PCG murders that somehow became suicides are:  Hank
     Killam, a husband of one of Ruby's dancers, who committed suicide
     by throwing himself through a plate glass window off the street in
     Miami;  Betty Mooney, one of Ruby's girls who hung herself in her
     jail cell by using her leopard-skin tights;  Roger Craig, who shot
     himself;  Jesus Crispin, who knew Sirhan, supposedly killed himself
     in his jail cell;  Grant Stockdale, who threw himself off the top
     of a tall building in Miami.
        There are some on the list who were admittedly murdered, but
     supposedly not by the PCG.  These include Robert Perrin, Nancy
     Perrin's husband;  Buddy Walters, deputy sheriff under Sheriff
     Decker, shot by a man he was trying to arrest;  Eladio Del Valle, a
     cohort of Ferrie, killed in Miami by an axe on the same day Ferrie
     was murdered;  Rolando Masferrer, blown up in his car;  Eddy
     Benevides, shot by an unknown assailant (he recovered).  The
     cover-ups in each of these cases were put into effect by
     controlling the investigation or simply by not having one.
        The complete list of deaths, including the eight major ones
     (JFK, RFK, MLK, Mary Jo Kopechne, Lee Harvey Oswald, David Ferrie,
     Ruby and Clay Shaw) numbers over a hundred.  Here is a partial
     list:

                      1. John Kennedy
                      2. Robert Kennedy
                      3. Martin Luther King
                      4. Mary Jo Kopechne
                      5. Lee Harvey Oswald
                      6. David Ferrie
                      7. Jack Ruby
                      8. Clay Shaw
                      9. Buddy Walthers
                     10. Roger Craig
                     11. Eladio Del Valle
                     12. Rolando Masferrer
                     13. Hank Killam
                     14. Rose Cherami
                     15. Hale Boggs
                     16. J. Edgar Hoover
                     17. Louis Lomax
                     18. Lee Bowers, Jr.
                     19. Jesus Crispin
                     20. Jim Koethe
                     21. Bill Hunter
                     22. Tom Howard
                     23. Earlene Roberts
                     24. Betty McDonald
                     25. Eddy Benevides
                     26. Robert Perrin
                     27. Gary Underhill
                     28. Bill Chesher
                     29. Dorothy Kilgallen
                     30. David Goldstein
                     31. Levens (first name unknown)
                     32. Teresa Norton
                     33. Warren Reynolds
                     34. Harold Russell
                     35. Marilyn Moore Walle
                     36. William Whaley
                     37. James Worrell, Jr.
                     38. Captain Frank Martin
                     39. Mrs. Earl T. Smith
                     40. Karyn Kupcinet
                     41. Albert Guy Bogard
                     42. Hiram Ingram
                     43. Nicholas Chetta
                     44. Mary Bledsoe
                     45. Jude Preston Battle
                     46. John M. Crawford
                     47. Richard Carr
                     48. Kathy Fullmer
                     49. Clyde Johnson
                     50. Reverend A. D. W. King
                     51. Carole Tyler
                     52. Dr. Mary Sherman
                     53. Grant Stockdale
                     54. J. A. Milteer
                     55. Hugh Ward
                     56. Perry Russo
                     57. Maurice Gatlin, Sr.
                     58. W. Guy Banister
                     59. Charles P. Cabell
                     60. Dorothy Hunt
                     61. Michelle Clark
                     62. John Roselli
                     63. Sam Giancana
                     64. Fred Lee Crisman
                     65. Carlos Prio Socarras
                     66. Charles Nicoletti
                     67. Jimmy Hoffa
                     68. George De Mohrenschildt
                     69. General Donald Donaldson
                     70. Lou Staples
                     71. William C. Sullivan
                     72. James Chaney

        The large majority of these murders eliminated witnesses to,
     participants in, or investigators of one of the assassinations.
     People involved with the participants in one of the assassinations
     or cover-ups were also listed above.  The participants were:  Jack
     Ruby, David Ferrie, Clay Shaw, Rolando Masferrer, J. Edgar Hoover
     (in the cover-up), and Robert Perrin.  There were four
     investigators:  Jim Koethe, Louis Lomax, Dorothy Kilgallen and Hale
     Boggs.  The rest were witnesses or associates.
        Two articles[8] written in 1976 analyzed some of these deaths
     and concluded that they were not accidents unconnected with the
     assassinations of our leaders.  Another analysis by the authors
     demonstrated that fifty of the first seventy murders met three
     criteria for proving death by foul means.  All involved people
     directly or indirectly linked to the major assassinations.  All met
     death under violent or very strange circumstances.  No autopsies
     were performed in any of these murders.
        The Charles Senseney dart weapon might have been used in some of
     the murders.  The injection given Lee Bowers produced such a
     paralytic and terrorized expression on Bowers' face that the doctor
     examining his body exclaimed he had never seen such before.  Grant
     Stockdale was found to have died of a heart attack on his way to
     the street from the top of a building (a dart might have killed
     him).



____________________

[1] "Forgive My Grief" Volumes I, II, III, IV, Penn Jones, Jr., Self
    Published, Midlothian, Texas.

[2] "Accessories After the Fact," Sylvia Meagher, Scarecrow Press,
    N.Y., 1976

[3] "Miami Herald," March, 1976.

[4] "The Mysterious Death of Clay Shaw," Richard Russell, "True
    Magazine."

[5] "The Umbrella Man," R.B. Cutler, & R.E. Sprague, "Gallery
    Magazine," June, 1978.

[6] "New York Times," September 19, 1975.

[7] "RFK Must Die!," Robert Kaiser, E.P. Dutton & Co. Inc., N.Y.C.,
    1970.

[8] (a) Self published article by Gary Schoener --  Minneapolis,
        Minn. Researcher.

    (b) Assassination Information Bureau (AIB), Cambridge, Mass,
         Research project and article.







                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *




                                Chapter 11
                Nixon and Ford -- The Pardon and the Tapes

        As the Power Control Group grew larger and the number of murders
     increased through the years, it became more and more difficult to
     keep the veil of secrecy surrounding the takeover intact.  As
     Nixon's instability increased, the danger of revealing the secret
     superstructure to the American people increased.
        Watergate and Nixon's resignation from office nearly ruined
     everything for the Power Control Group.  A splinter faction in the
     CIA began showing strength and all of the dirt might have been
     leaked to the press and to the people.  Nixon himself had pulled
     the most dangerous boner in the history of the PCG.  He installed a
     secret tape recording system that recorded a number of
     conversations about the PCG's murders, assassinations and dirty
     tricks.  Even worse, Nixon did not destroy the tapes before the
     Congress found out about them and went after them.  As soon as it
     became obvious that Nixon would be forced to resign, the PCG had to
     use a desperation strategy.
        Gerald R. Ford pardoned Richard M. Nixon on September 8, 1974:
     such was the PCG's strategy.  Many skeptical U.S. citizens nodded
     their heads knowingly and assumed Nixon had made his "deal" with
     Ford when he nominated him for the vice presidency.  Evans and
     Novak[1] assumed that Julie Nixon Eisenhower talked Ford into the
     pardon on grounds that Nixon's health was poor.  The Ford's fears
     for Nixon's health didn't seem to convince very many news media
     people who saw a rosy-cheeked, apparently robust ex-president in
     San Clemente.[2]
        The pardon seemed to most Americans and news editors a gross
     error in judgment and a miscarriage of justice.  But once again the
     United States was fooled.  This time, the PCG, Nixon and Ford
     managed to pull the wool over the eyes of the public and to
     narrowly escape revealing what can be called "the entire rotten
     crust at the top of American power."  Any reasonable hypothesis
     about what actually happened, based on the evidence at hand, had
     not been even remotely suggested by either Congress or the media by
     1976.
        Any explanation of the situation leading to the pardon begins
     with the relationship between Gerald Ford and Richard Nixon.  It
     goes back to 1960, the year Mr. Nixon planned the overthrow of
     Castro's Cuba.  As earlier chapters have made clear, the U2
     incident and the Bay of Pigs was the beginning.
        In 1960, Nixon and the White House action officer worked on the
     plans for what was later called the Bay of Pigs invasion.[3]  Prior
     to that time the PCG and Nixon had accumulated plenty of reasons to
     want Castro overthrown.  The anti-Communist attitude was the
     superficial reason.  Beneath it were Nixon's connections with the
     Mafia and his friendships and financial holdings that were greatly
     damaged when Castro closed the casinos run by the mob in Havana.[4]
     When Nixon and Kennedy debated about the Cuban situation in the
     1960 campaign, Nixon purposefully lied to the American people about
     U.S. plans for an invasion.[5]  When he narrowly lost to Kennedy,
     it created a deep wound, and he and the PCG spent much of the next
     three years planning revenge.
        Nixon became a tool of a number of Cubans and Americans, both
     inside the CIA and outside, who agreed with him that casting out
     Castro was highly desirable.  One of these men was E. Howard
     Hunt.[6]  Another was Bernard Barker.[7]  A third was Carlos Prio
     Socarras.[8]  Richard Bissell, Richard Helms and Allen Dulles were
     the three higher level men in the PCG.
        These Nixon cronies and financial partners became involved with
     the PCG.  They murdered John Kennedy.[9]  Whether Nixon was
     directly involved in the PCG's planning for the assassination is
     still open to question, although one researcher believes that he
     was.[10]  There certainly is substantial evidence that Nixon was
     out to at least politically sink Kennedy and Johnson, and aimed to
     do so in Dallas immediately before Kennedy was killed. (See section
     on evidence).[11]
        Whether Nixon was directly involved in planning the
     assassination of President John F. Kennedy does not have to be
     settled here.  What is important is that Nixon was directly
     involved in covering up the truth about who did kill Kennedy.
     Evidence from the Nixon-Haldeman tapes of June 1972 indicated that
     Nixon knew the truth about the assassination when he suggested
     Gerald Ford be part of the Warren Commission.[12]
        A close personal friendship had developed between Ford and Nixon
     during their days together in the Congress, when both were strong,
     ultra-conservative, "red, white and blue", anti-Communist,
     "religious" members who thought and talked alike.
        When Nixon realized that John Kennedy had been killed almost
     under his nose in Dallas by some of his Bay of Pigs friends, the
     PCG convinced him he had to do everything in his power to cover it
     up and to bide his time until his powerful military and
     intelligence friends could place him in the White House.  It took
     one more murder by the PCG (Robert Kennedy) to get him there, and
     still another attempted murder to keep him there (George Wallace).
        Control over the investigations of these murders was essential
     for Nixon and the PCG.  In order to guide a presidential commission
     away from the truth, the closed small circle of people in the PCG
     who knew what had happened to John Kennedy had to be enlarged.
     Allen Dulles was no problem.  He knew the cause was an
     intelligence/military one from the day it happened.  Earl Warren
     was a different matter.  He had to be fooled and later talked into
     remaining silent "for the good of the country."
        A ringleader inside the Warren Commission was crucial.  It had
     to be someone the PCG and Nixon could trust, one who had an honest
     and trustworthy appearance.  Nixon called on Gerry Ford, and he
     convinced LBJ that Ford should be on the Commission.[13]
        Nixon told Ford at some point prior to January, 1964 who killed
     JFK and why.  He convinced Ford that every effort should be made to
     make sure Oswald was found to be the lone assassin.  Ford did an
     excellent job.  He not only steered the Commission away from the
     facts[14] whenever a key witness was interviewed or an embarrassing
     situation developed, but he also nailed Oswald's coffin shut
     personally by publishing his own book on Oswald.[15]  This, coming
     from the chairman of the House Armed Services Committee, served to
     firmly plant in the American mind the idea that there was no
     conspiracy, that Oswald was the lone assassin, and that the Warren
     Commission had done a good job.
        From the day Ford's book was published, Nixon and Ford became
     totally beholden to each other.  They also both became totally
     beholden to the members of the PCG who were at or near the top of
     things and who were part of the small knowledgeable circle.  Other
     members of the PCG's inner circle included J. Edgar Hoover and
     Richard Helms.
        No one could be permitted by the PCG to come into power in the
     White House, the CIA, the Justice Department or the FBI unless they
     were part of the PCG and willing to keep quiet and help suppress
     the truth about the JFK assassination.  The PCG's membership
     widened, of necessity, when Robert Kennedy was killed and Nixon
     became president.  The people involved in killing Robert Kennedy
     and Nixon's top aides had to be told the truth.  This included
     Haldeman, Ehrlichman, Kissinger, Mitchell (who had the job of
     controlling Hoover's successors in continuing the cover-ups) and
     possibly others.  Mitchell was instrumental in stopping Jim
     Garrison's investigation of Clay Shaw and other PCG members and in
     totally discrediting Garrison.[16]  He was aided by Richard Helms
     and others in the PCG through CIA support in the Clay Shaw trial
     cover-up efforts.[17]
        The White House plumber section of the PCG decided in 1972, with
     or without Nixon's knowledge and approval, to assassinate George
     Wallace, so that Nixon would be assured of the conservative vote.
     The PCG and its debts once again grew.  E. Howard Hunt and Charles
     Colson, along with Tony Ulasewicz, Donald Segretti and others, were
     in a position to make demands in exchange for their silence.  The
     Hunt million-dollar blackmail threat to reveal "seedy things" or
     "hankypanky" was never explainable in terms of Watergate or the
     Ellsberg break-ins.  But three assassinations would certainly be
     worth a cool million to keep Hunt silent.  Again, the Haldeman-
     Nixon June 23, 1972 tapes are revealing.[18]
        When the Watergate crisis occurred, Nixon was trapped by his own
     tapes, and the PCG was in grave danger.  Discussions with Haldeman,
     Mitchell and others mention the Kennedy assassination conspiracy
     and the Wallace murder attempt on tape.  The PCG was suddenly
     threatened as a group.  The tapes couldn't all be destroyed because
     too many Secret Service people knew about them.  Haldeman and Nixon
     managed to erase one revealing 18 1/2 minute section about the
     assassinations, but who could remember exactly what telephone calls
     or Oval Office conversations might have mentioned the truth about
     the three murders?
        The PCG and Nixon again sensed the need for a successor who
     would keep quiet.  They called on Gerry Ford when Agnew was forced
     out.  Ford and Nixon, bound inextricably together by their mutual
     cover-up of the assassinations, worked out a deal.  Nixon nominated
     Ford to be his Vice President.  The Senate, completely bamboozled
     by Nixon and Ford, never asked Ford any important questions about
     the assassinations nor his performance on the Warren Commission.
     When they asked Ford about his book, he committed perjury twice
     before the Senate (see item # 15 in the list ennumerated below).
        Nixon and Ford agreed that Ford would keep quiet if Nixon
     remained silent and that Ford would succeed Nixon if he were forced
     to resign or be impeached.  They agreed to a pardon afterward.  But
     the most critical part of the arrangement was that those tapes
     revealing the truth about the assassinations be kept out of
     circulation.  When the Supreme Court ruled that the tapes must be
     turned over, it was then time to implement their agreed-upon
     strategy.
        In addition, Jaworski, Colson, Mitchell, Kissinger, Haldeman,
     Ehrlichman, the Warren Commission, Hunt, Helms, Shaw and anyone
     else in the PCG had to be bought off, pardoned, protected or killed
     to insure their silences.
        Leon Jaworski resigned.  People asked why.  The real answer was
     buried in the fact that Jaworski knew what had been going on.  He
     knew because of information passed on to him by the Ervin Committee
     and Cox regarding the assassination and the cover-up.  He was also
     personally involved in 1964 in the JFK cover-up.
        Jaworski could have been a problem, even though he helped with
     the JFK cover-up from the beginning.[19]  Hunt was taken care of by
     getting him out of jail, buying him a large estate in Florida and
     paying him a lot of money.[20]  Helms could be counted on.
     Kissinger may have been a problem, but he finally agreed.  His
     wiretaps were ordered to find out who knew about the
     assassinations.  Hoover was dead.  Clay Shaw was murdered.[21]
     Warren was dead.  Richard Russell was dead.  John Sherman Cooper
     was bought off (he received an important ambassadorship).  John J.
     McCloy was too old to worry about.
        That left Colson, Mitchell, Haldeman, and Ehrlichman, plus some
     other small fry.  The PCG strategy as planned with these men
     involved pardons for all of them in exchange for their silence,
     especially Haldeman and Mitchell, who not only knew what happened
     to JFK, but who also took overt actions to cover-up.  (Haldeman
     erased the 18 1/2 minutes of tape and Mitchell nailed Jim
     Garrison.)
        Newer members of the PCG may cause some problems.  They all have
     to know the truth by now.  Rockefeller and Alex Haig must know.
     George Bush, William Colby, Edward Levi and Clarence Kelly knew
     because of their access to the records, and they must have agreed
     to cover-up continuance.  Ford and his cronies in the House had to
     continue to knock out any efforts by Henry B. Gonzalez of Texas to
     start a new House Committee investigation of the JFK assassination.
     They were very successful in their control of the House Rules
     Committee.  Haig seemed to have been bought off with the promise of
     a top NATO post in exchange for his silence.  And control over
     Frank Church and the Senate Intelligence Committee was necessary.
        Gerald Ford remained committed to the PCG and to Nixon.
        The tapes had to be controlled and edited at all costs.  Nixon
     no doubt required help in listening to the tapes after Haldeman
     left and in sorting out those in which assassinations and cover-ups
     were discussed.  General Haig was undoubtedly the man he selected
     to do the dirty work.  It was almost certain that no tapes would be
     turned over to Judge Sirica or to Jaworski with any assassination
     references left on them.  One of the tapes demanded by Jaworski had
     such references.  This is the recording made on June 23, 1972 in
     which Nixon and Haldeman are discussing Watergate just six days
     after the break-in.
        The Nixon transcript of that tape turned over to Judge Sirica
     upon orders of the Supreme Court showed many sections labelled
     "unintelligible."  It is a near certainty that the critical
     sections were edited out by Nixon and General Haig before they were
     turned over to Sirica and prior to their transcription.  Judge
     Sirica was the only person in the chain of possession of that tape
     who could have been counted on to make a scientific analysis of the
     tape to see whether it was tampered with before he received it.
     His near brush with death in 1975 must be viewed in that light and
     in the light of the PCG's use of weapon-induced heart attacks.
        The rest of Nixon's tapes that were still in Gerald Ford's
     possession and control might have contained many references to
     assassinations and cover-ups.  Rather than go through all of them
     and edit or erase the critical material, it was more likely that
     Ford would either turn them over to Nixon for total destruction or
     sit on them as long as he was president.
        The evidence for the Power Control Group's and Ford/Nixon's
     strategy is as follows:


        1.  Nixon was White House action officer on Cuban invasion
            plans in 1960.

        2.  Nixon was in contact with Hunt and others during the
            Bay of Pigs planning.

        3.  Nixon lied to the American people by his own admission
            about the Bay of Pigs during his TV debates with
            Kennedy in 1960.

        4.  Nixon was financially linked to the Mafia and to Cuban
            casino operations before Castro took over.

        5.  Nixon was acquainted with Hunt, Baker, Martinez,
            Sturgis, Carlos Prio Socarras, and other Watergate
            people and anti-Castro people in Florida, and he was
            financially linked to Baker, Martinez and Socarras.

        6.  Hunt, Baker, Sturgis and Socarras were connected with
            the assassination group in the murder of JFK.

        7.  Nixon was in Dallas for three days, including the
            morning of the JFK assassination.  He was trying to
            stir up trouble for Kennedy.

        8.  Nixon went to Dallas under false pretenses.  There was
            no board meeting of the Pepsi Cola Company as he
            announced his law firm had had to attend.

        9.  Nixon did not admit being in Dallas on the day Kennedy
            was shot and did not reveal the true reason for his
            trip.  He held two press conferences on the two days
            before the assassination, attacking both Kennedy and
            Johnson and emphasizing the Democratic political
            problems in Texas.

       10.  Research indicates that Nixon either knew in advance
            about assassination plans, or learned about them soon
            after the assassination.

       11.  Nixon proposed to Lyndon Johnson that Gerald Ford serve
            on the Warren Commission.

       12.  Ford led the Commission cover-up by controlling the
            questioning of key witnesses and by several other
            means.

       13.  Ford helped firmly plant the idea that Oswald was the
            only assassin and that there was no conspiracy by
            publishing his own book, "Lee Harvey Oswald:  Portrait
            of the Assassin."

       14.  Ford purposefully covered up the conspiracy of the PCG
            in the JFK assassination and also covered up the fact
            that Oswald was a paid informer for the FBI.  He did
            this by dismissing the subject in his book as worthless
            rumor and by keeping the executive sessions of the
            Commission (where Oswald's FBI informer status was
            discussed) classified Top Secret.

       15.  Ford continued the cover-up when he was questioned
            before being confirmed by the Senate as Vice President.
            He lied under oath twice to the Senate Committee.  He
            stated that he had written his book about Oswald with
            no access to classified documents.  He lied about this
            because his book used classified documents about
            Oswald's FBI informer status.  He lied when he said
            that the book was entitled, "Lee Harvey Oswald:
            Portrait of *an* Assassin."  This was significant in
            1973 because the public by then had become very
            skeptical about a lone assassin.  By changing one word
            in the title, Ford made the book seem a little less
            like what it actually was--an effort to make Oswald the
            assassin.

       16.  Jaworski aided in the JFK cover-up by sitting on
            evidence of conspiracy accumulated by Waggoner Carr,
            Texas Attorney General, who he represented in liaison
            with the Warren Commission.  He also stopped the
            critical testimony of Jack Ruby when he testified
            before the Warren Commission, and diverted attention
            away from Ruby's intent to reveal the conspiracy to
            kill both Kennedy and Oswald.

       17.  Nixon became president in 1968 only because Robert
            Kennedy was killed by a conspiracy.  Nixon was well
            aware of the conspiracy whether or not he approved of
            it in advance.

       18.  John Mitchell and J. Edgar Hoover joined Nixon and the
            lower level members of the PCG in covering up the RFK
            murder conspiracy.  They classified the evidence "Top
            Secret" and murdered several witnesses, controlled the
            judge in the Sirhan trial and the district attorney and
            the chief of police in Los Angeles during and after the
            trial.  They still control these people and the Los
            Angeles County Board of Supervisors.  Clarence Kelly
            also became involved.

       19.  The plumbers group ordered the assassination of George
            Wallace in 1972 to insure Nixon's election by picking
            up Wallace's vote (about 18%, according to polls).

       20.  J. Edgar Hoover and Richard Helms were aware of who
            killed John Kennedy and Robert Kennedy.  They helped
            cover-up both conspiracies.

       21.  John Mitchell controlled the trial of Clay Shaw and the
            Garrison investigation and discredited Garrison by
            framing him in a New Orleans gambling case.

       22.  Nixon and Haldeman discussed the assassination of John
            Kennedy, the conspiracy, Hunt's involvement, the
            possibility that Hunt might talk, the cover-up, the Bay
            of Pigs relationship between Nixon, Hunt and the other
            PCG members, and the briefing Nixon might have had to
            give anyone running against him in 1972, on matters of
            "national security".

       23.  Nixon and Mitchell discussed the assassinations and the
            attempt to assassinate George Wallace.  Mitchell
            executed orders to suppress the truth about these
            events.

       24.  Gerald Ford had possession of the most critical tapes
            on which assassinations and cover-ups were discussed.

       25.  Jaworski could be counted on to keep the assassination
            material under wraps even after his resignation.  He
            was aware of the conspiracy evidence and cover-up in
            all three cases (JFK, RFK, George Wallace).

       26.  Hunt was taken care of and will keep silent.  He had
            been out of jail and living on a beautiful $100,000
            estate in Florida with plenty of money, across the
            street from his Bay of Pigs friend, Manuel Artime.

       27.  Clay Shaw was murdered by the PCG, undoubtedly to keep
            him from talking once the truth about his CIA position
            was revealed by Victor Marchetti.  He was embalmed
            before the coroner could determine the cause of death.
            Evidence indicates he was killed somewhere and then
            brought back to his apartment.

       28.  Hale Boggs, a Warren, Commission member, was possibly
            killed by the PCG.  Bogg's airplane disappeared in
            Alaska.  No trace of it was ever found and no
            explanation of how the plane could have crashed has
            ever been given.  Mrs. Boggs has expressed doubts about
            it being an accident.

       29.  Four of the seven Warren Commission members are dead:
            Warren, Dulles, Russell and Boggs.  Of the remaining
            members, Ford was President, John McCloy is retired and
            living in Connecticut, and John Sherman Cooper was made
            ambassador to East Germany.

       30.  Richard Russell, Hale Boggs and Cooper believed there
            was a conspiracy in the JFK assassination.  Russell and
            Boggs both said so publicly.

       31.  Haldeman erased 18 1/2 minutes of a taped discussion
            with Nixon.  This tape undoubtedly contained "national
            security" matters.  The fact that Haldeman did the
            erasing can easily be determined by tracing the trail
            of possession of the tape from the day it was taken out
            of the vault to the day the gap was discovered.
            Haldeman had the tape with the recorder alone for
            nearly 48 hours.  No one else had the tape alone long
            enough to do the erasing.

       32.  Ford and the PCG contemplated pardons for Mitchell,
            Haldeman, Ehrlichman and possibly others who know the
            number one secret.

       33.  Ford's statements to the sub-committee of the House
            Judiciary Committee concerning his pardon of Nixon
            dodged the real issue.  Only Elizabeth Holtzman asked
            questions coming close to the number one secret.  When
            she asked about a prior agreement, Ford said, "I have
            made no deal, there was no deal, *since I became Vice
            President*."  Those last few words were not reported by
            the press, but a large number of Americans watched and
            heard him say them.  Of course he spoke truthfully
            because the "deal" was made *before* he became Vice
            President.



____________________

[1] Evans & Novak column -- September 12. 1974.

[2] "Paris Herald Tribune" -- September 12, 1974.

[3] "Compulsive Spy," Tad Szulc, Viking Press, 1974.

[4] "Nixon and the Mafia," Jeff Gerth, "Sundance," December, 1972.

[5] "My Six Crises," Richard M. Nixon.

[6] "Compulsive Spy."

[7] "Nixon and the Mafia."

[8] "Nixon, Bay of Pigs & Watergate," -- R.E. Sprague, "Computers and
    Automation," January, 1973.

[9] "Nixon, Bay of Pigs & Watergate."

[10] Trowbridge Ford, Holy Cross College, Boston, MA, Several papers and
    articles.

[11] Warren Commission Hearings & Exhibits -- Vol. 23, Pages 941-943.

[12] Nixon Transcript of June 23 1972 tape  -- "New York Times," August
    6, 1974.

[13] Trowbridge Ford -- Article on Gerald Ford & Warren Commission.

[14] Ibid.

[15] Gerald Ford "Lee Harvey Oswald:  Portrait of the Assassin."

[16] "The Framing of Jim Garrison", R.E. Sprague, "Computers and
    Automation," December, 1973.

[17] "The CIA and the Kennedy Assassination" -- Unpublished article by
    R.E. Sprague.

[18] Nixon tape, June 23, 1972.

[19] Warren Commission Exhibits -- Testimony of Jack Ruby, Vol. V,
    Pages 181-213 and Vol. XIV, pages 504-571.  Also Trowbridge Ford
    article on Jaworski.

[20] "Washington Watch" and Triss Coffin newsletter, August 10, 1974.

[21] Zodiac News Service release -- August 20, 1974.







                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *




                                Chapter 12
         The Second Line of Defense and Cover-Ups in 1975 and 1976

        The mini-war waged by assassination researchers and a few
     Congressmen from 1964 to 1976 to reopen the major assassination
     inquiries never really disturbed the Power Control Group.  But in
     1975, simultaneous with the revelations about all of the terrible
     things the CIA and the FBI did, the researchers and a few of their
     friends in the media and in Congress began to draw more attention
     than was comfortable for the PCG.
        A special renewed effort became necessary to extend the cover-
     ups.  Part of this effort was a program to bring the media back
     under control and to reinforce media support of the cover-ups.
     This has been discussed in some detail in Chapter 9.  Another part
     of this effort was the expansion of the Rockefeller Commission's
     assignment to reinforce the cover-up of the JFK assassination
     conspiracy.  Separate new efforts were necessary to control the
     courts and lawyers and other public officials in the King and
     Robert Kennedy assassination conspiracies.  These were brought
     about by appeals for new trials by James Earl Ray and Sirhan B.
     Sirhan.  The appeals were accompanied by new revelations.  New
     publicity was given to demands for an investigation into the
     Wallace shooting by prominent people, including Wallace himself.
        A minor success in the JFK case was scored by researchers with
     the assistance of Dick Gregory, Geraldo Rivera of ABC, Tom Snyder
     of NBC, Mort Sahl and others.  They managed to have the Zapruder
     film and other photographic evidence of conspiracy shown on local
     and national television.  No one of any intelligence outside the
     PCG who has even seen the Zapruder film questions the fact that
     shots came from two different directions in Dealey Plaza.  This
     breakthrough after eleven years of effort put new public and
     Congressional pressures on the PCG.  It was closely followed by a
     grass roots campaign conducted by Mark Lane's Citizens Commission
     of Inquiry to reopen the JFK case.  Pressure was brought to bear on
     Congressmen by their local constituents as a result of this
     campaign.  Henry Gonzalez from Texas and Thomas Downing from
     Virginia introduced resolutions in the House of Representatives
     calling for the reopening of all four cases and the JFK case, so
     the public and Congress had a formal base to work with and a goal
     to reach.
        New revelations were made in 1975 about the FBI's and the CIA's
     information withheld from the Warren Commission.  From Dallas came
     the admission that Oswald had been in closer contact with the FBI
     than believed and that Jack Ruby had been an FBI informer.
        Perhaps the most dangerous development for the PCG was the
     creation of a sub-committee under the Church committee to
     investigate the JFK assassination.  This two-man subcommittee
     formed by Senator Gary Hart of Colorado and Senator Schweiker of
     Pennsylvania became a real threat when it was given authority by
     the full Senate Committee on Intelligence to conduct their own
     independent investigation with a staff of nine people.  It would be
     harder to control their efforts than to control the Church
     committee, where the PCG had several strong allies, including
     Senators Goldwater and Tower.
        Gerald Ford, William Colby, Richard Helms (from his faraway post
     in Asia) and the other PCG members developed a three-prong strategy
     for the JFK case in order to cope with all of these new problems.
        First came the reinforcement of the lone-assassin Warren
     Commission scenario.  Ford selected David Belin to be chief of
     staff of the Rockefeller Commission.  Ford admitted that Belin in
     his Rockefeller Commission role--as well as in his advocacy to
     reopen the JFK case in order to prove the Warren Commission
     findings correct--was acting as "one of our best staff members."
     This was necessary so that the Rockefeller Commission could add a
     new assignment to its original charter and investigate the CIA and
     FBI.  The new assignment was to prove that all of the new questions
     about the Zapruder film and the evidence for assassins on the
     grassy knoll were answerable in support of Warren Commission
     conclusions.
        The former Warren commissioner now President, who led the
     cover-up and pardoned Nixon, nominated the Warren Commission staff
     lawyer who led the cover-up at the working level as the new
     Rockefeller Commission chief of staff.
        Belin did his job like a faithful dog.  He personally called in
     the most dangerous researchers, including Cyril Wecht and Dick
     Gregory's cohorts, Ralph Schoenman and Robert Groden, who had been
     making all of the noise on television.  With the help (and possibly
     the knowledge) of only one other staff man, Belin interviewed these
     witnesses briefly, almost casually:  then he misquoted them, edited
     their statements, or left them out of the Rockefeller Report.  He
     purposefully did not call any researchers other than Wecht who
     might have presented some embarrassing evidence of conspiracy.  He
     instead called a number of "experts" from the stable of PCG people,
     including some of the Ramsey Clark doctors panel that had examined
     the medical evidence in 1968 to back up the Warren Commission
     during the Garrison investigation and the Clay Shaw trial.  He also
     called on reliable Dr. Lattimer, the urologist, to testify again
     about the bullet wounds above the navel.
        Belin wrote the chapter of the Rockefeller Commission Report
     himself.  It formed a base for controlled media presentations of
     the lone assassin scenario.  CBS used much of the basic material in
     its series in 1975.  Others quoted liberally from the favorite
     misquotes of Cyril Wecht and the statements of the CIA doctors
     concerning the fatal shot at frame 313 of the Zapruder film.  That
     had always been a sticky point with Belin and the other Warren
     Commission defenders and technical cover-up artists in the PCG.
     Belin was nearly driven to distraction at times, trying to avoid
     any discussion of the back-to-the-left acceleration of JFK's head
     following the Z313 shot.
        He was therefore delighted to be able to produce a medical
     opinion that the back-to-the-left motion was consistent with a shot
     directly from the rear.  The fact that no ballistics experts or
     physics experts were called to testify about Newton's second law of
     motion and what happens to an object when struck by a rifle bullet
     traveling at twice to three times the speed of sound was never
     questioned by the Rockefeller panel or the media.  Belin easily
     eliminated the assassins on the grassy knoll simply by persuading
     the FBI to say the assassins weren't there at all.
        Over a period of several months in the second half of 1975, the
     PCG (through its control agents in the 15 media organizations, and
     by using Belin's creation) hammered away again at the lone assassin
     thesis.  They caused the wave of excitement and furor created by
     Gregory, Lane, Groden, Schoenman and their friends to die out.
     Lectures on university campuses, discussions on FM radio talk shows
     late at night, and conspiracy books and articles in underground
     newspapers appeared as always.  But there was no more showing of
     the Zapruder film on ABC, NBC or CBS;  nor was there any talk of
     conspiracy in any of the major fifteen national news media
     organizations.
        The second part of the strategy was to create a fall-back, or
     second line of defense in the JFK case.  If necessary the same idea
     could also be applied in the other three cases when the situation
     became too dangerous.  There was less danger in 1975 in the RFK,
     MLK and Wallace cases because the researchers and the media had not
     yet consistently begun to tie in the CIA, FBI and other PCG high
     level people.  In 1976 a danger emerged in the MLK case when it was
     revealed that J. Edgar Hoover and the FBI might be linked and that
     Hoover attempted to get King to commit suicide.  However, that
     development occurred several months after the implementation of the
     strategy began in the JFK case.  Of course there had never been any
     danger with the Chappaquiddick crime, because few researchers
     realized what the PCG had accomplished in that event.  No
     suspicions existed in Congress either, beyond some curiosity about
     Tony Ulasewicz and E. Howard Hunt's strange visits to the island
     and to Hyannisport.
        There may be several second lines of defense positions already
     prepared for the JFK case.  The one that has been implemented in
     1975 and 1976 is the "Castro did it in revenge" position.  The PCG
     realizes that while the media will behave like slaves to present
     the first line of defense (Oswald did it alone), the public isn't
     buying it any more.  In 1969, shortly after the Clay Shaw trial
     ended, the percent of people disbelieving the lone assassin theory
     fell to its all-time low of just over 50%.  By 1976 it had risen to
     80%, despite the faithful efforts of CBS, "Time," "Newsweek," et
     al.  More importantly, Richard Schweiker, Gary Hart, Henry
     Gonzalez, Thomas Downing, and a very large part of the House and
     Senate weren't buying the lone assassin story any more either.
        So, a good second line of defense story was needed.  It had to
     be one that the House and Senate and Schweiker, Church, Downing and
     hopefully Gonzalez would buy.  It had to be one which could be
     created out of existing facts and then shored up by planted
     evidence, faked records, dependable witnesses lying under oath, and
     once again, the control and use of the media.  The "Castro did it
     in revenge" story met these requirements.  The media had already
     helped to some extent by publishing information from Jack Anderson,
     Lyndon B. Johnson and others about Castro's turning around various
     CIA agents or sending agents of his own, including Oswald, to
     assassinate JFK.  Perhaps even more importantly, Senator Schweiker
     said he believed Castro might have been behind the assassination
     and that this possibility should be investigated.
        The Castro story strategy was implemented in 1975.  Gradually at
     first, a story appeared here or there in the press about the
     assassins assigned to kill Castro.  Then the media began to reprint
     the Jack Anderson story about Castro's turning around of some of
     these agents.  New authors of the story appeared.  Anderson's
     original story seemed to be forgotten.  These articles never seemed
     to have an identifiable source or any proof.  Hank Greenspun of the
     Las Vegas newspaper circuit and the man involved with Howard
     Hughes, Larry O'Brien, released a story to the "Chicago Tribune."
     He said his information came from reliable sources.
        The momentum began to build.  More and more "leaked" information
     about Castro and assassins and Oswald being a pro-Castroite hit the
     establishment media.  The stories and the sequence of events began
     to be predictable, if a researcher had understood the PCG and their
     fight for survival in 1975 and 1976.  Then the Church committee and
     the Schweiker sub-committee issued statements that they were going
     to investigate the "Castro did it" theory.  The PCG began feeding
     them information in various forms and various ways that would back
     up the idea.  The JFK sex scandal was released by Judith Exner.
     The PCG provided her with an incentive to spice up the "Castro did
     it" theory with a little sex involving JFK and one of the assassins
     assigned to Castro, John Roselli.
        The PCG realized they had the double advantage of drawing
     attention to Roselli and Castro and the turn-around assassin idea,
     while at the same time gnawing away at JFK's image.  There was
     press speculation that Exner was a Mafia plant in the White House
     to find out how much JFK knew about the Castro assassination plans.
     Since Frank Sinatra had introduced Judith to both JFK and Roselli,
     there was speculation about Sinatra's Mafia friends linked to the
     rat pack, to Peter Lawford, to JFK's sister and to JFK himself.
     All of this was meat for the PCG's grinder.  It certainly drew
     Schweiker's attention away from Helms, Hunt, Gabaldin, Shaw,
     Ferrie, Seymour and all of the other operatives involved in JFK's
     murder.  In fact, the Schweiker staff, which had the names and
     locations of several participants and witnesses that could pinpoint
     the Helms-Hunt-Shaw-Gabaldin group as the real assassins as early
     as September, 1975 did not interview more than one or two of them
     and did not follow up on the rest at all.  Their attention was
     diverted by the second line of defense strategy and they were also
     influenced by infiltration by the PCG.
        Part three of the strategy was the control of the Congress and
     the committees in the House and the Senate concerned with
     investigations of the intelligence community and the JFK
     assassination.  This subject will be covered in depth in Chapter
     14.  Suffice it to say here that the PCG planted people on the
     staffs of the Church committee and the Schweiker sub-committee.
     They exercised control over the other committees in the House and
     Senate (Abzug, Don Edwards, Pike committees) and they controlled
     the House Rules committee, which effectively blocked the Gonzalez
     and Downing resolutions for over a year.
        The CIA has always had its supporters in both House and Senate.
     So has the FBI.  So did J. Edgar Hoover (sometimes through
     blackmail) and Richard Helms.  There was a story published in the
     "Washington Post" about a dinner party given by Tom Braden, former
     CIA man, at which all of Richard Helms' old buddies rallied to his
     defense.  Several well-known Congressmen were there and Senator
     Symington gave a rousing speech supporting Helms in his hour of
     need.
        Gerald Ford, of course, as then titular leader of the PCG, had
     many old friends in the House.  Nixon had many supporters in both
     House and Senate and still has to this day.  Thus, control by the
     PCG over Congress and committees is not all that difficult.
     Specific examples will be given in Chapter 14 of how this really
     works.  So the cover-ups continue.  The PCG is still in the
     driver's seat.  The three parts of their strategy work very well.
     The lone assassin story is repeated at least once a month in some
     media source or other.  The "Castro did it" story will no doubt
     make its official appearance again.
        The Congress is under control.  Gonzalez was not under control,
     nor was Downing.  But they couldn't do much without the Rules
     Committee, which was controlled.
        The people are left with no effective way of doing anything
     about the PCG and their crimes.  What is worse, there is no way the
     people can elect the man of their choice.






--
                                            daveus rattus

                                  yer friendly neighborhood ratman

                              KOYAANISQATSI

  ko.yaa.nis.qatsi (from the Hopi Language)  n.  1. crazy life.  2. life
      in turmoil.  3. life out of balance.  4. life disintegrating.
        5. a state of life that calls for another way of living.



From [email protected] Mon Jun 15 08:55:21 1992
Received: by icaen.uiowa.edu ( 5.52 (84)/1.1) id AA02287
       on Mon, 15 Jun 92 08:55:17 CDT.
Received: from pl122c.eecs.lehigh.edu by ns-mx.uiowa.edu (5.64.jnf/920408)
         on Mon, 15 Jun 92 08:56:56 -0500 id AA14903 with SMTP
Received: from SGI.COM by PL122c.EECS.Lehigh.EDU (5.61/1.34)
       id AA23617; Mon, 15 Jun 92 09:43:09 -0400
Received: from [192.102.132.11] by sgi.sgi.com via SMTP (911016.SGI/910110.SGI)
       for [email protected] id AA12463; Mon, 15 Jun 92 06:45:55 -0700
Received: by ratmandu.esd.sgi.com (920110.SGI/920502.SGI.AUTO)
       for @sgi.sgi.com:[email protected] id AA01518; Mon, 15 Jun 92 06:45:54 -0700
Date: Mon, 15 Jun 92 06:45:54 -0700
From: [email protected] (dave "who can do? ratmandu!" ratcliffe)
Message-Id: <[email protected]>
To: [email protected]
Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (7/11)
Status: RO


Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (7/11)
Summary: we were robbed of our capability of electing a president we wanted
Keywords:  part 7 of 11:  chapter 13 thru chapter 14
Lines: 326


                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *




                                Chapter 13
                  The 1976 Election and Conspiracy Fever

        To dramatize what might happen and probably did happen in 1976,
     this chapter has been prepared by assuming the attitude typical of
     today's innocent Americans.  A new disease is sweeping America.
     No, it's not the flu;  it's conspiracy fever.[1]
        People afflicted by the disease imagine conspiracies everywhere.
     They believe, for example, that the CIA arranged for the takeover
     in Chile and the assassination of Salvador Allende.  They even
     think Henry Kissinger had something to do with it.  These poor
     feverish devils have the strange idea that J. Edgar Hoover was a
     fiend rather than a public hero.  They imagine that he ordered a
     vicious campaign against Dr. Martin Luther King and a conspiracy
     against most of young America called Cointelpro.  Some even think
     Hoover had King killed.  There are some Californians with the west
     coast strain of this bug who imagine that the FBI and the
     California authorities created a conspiracy in San Diego and Los
     Angeles against black citizens.  The California group also think
     there was something strange about Donald DeFreeze and the
     Symbionese Liberation Army.  They suspect an FBI or California
     state authority conspiracy, complete with police provocateurs,
     double agents, faked prison breaks, and a Patty Hearst, alias
     Tania, all thrown in by our own government to create a climate that
     would make the public accept the prevalence of terrorism and demand
     a police state.
        The disease spread to Congressmen as well.  It does not seem to
     be limited, as it was before Watergate, to people under the age of
     30.  There are even Congressmen with a more virulent form of the
     malady who are convinced their telephones are still being tapped.
     They, along with thousands of others who suffer, no doubt reached
     this conclusion just because they were told by a CIA-controlled
     media that hundreds of telephones were tapped a few years ago.
        Early forms of conspiracy fever are no longer considered to be
     dangerous.  For example, all those sick citizens who imagined
     conspiracies in the incidents at Tonkin Gulf, Songmy, Mylai, the
     Pueblo and the Black Panther murders are now considered to be more
     or less recovered, since it turns out it was not their imaginations
     working overtime after all.  Even the special variety of the fever
     which caused the impression that the CIA murdered a series of
     foreign heads-of-state is no longer on the danger list.
        There is still one form of the illness, however, that is
     officially considered to be very dangerous, virulent, and to be
     stamped out at all costs.  It is the version producing the illusion
     that all of America's domestic assassinations were conspiracies.
     Those infected believe the conspiracies are interlinked in a giant
     conspiracy to take over the electoral process in the United States
     and to conceal this from the American people.  Some citizens are
     known to have this worst form of the fever.  They include a
     Congressman or two.  Others have come down with a milder form in
     which they imagine separate conspiracies in four assassination
     cases (John and Robert Kennedy, Dr. King, and the attempted
     assassination of George Wallace).
        Members of the Ford Administration, particularly David Belin,
     Mr. Ford's staff member on the Rockefeller Commission, went along
     with an analysis made by Dr. Jacob Cohen, a professional fever
     analyst, that the disease has been spreading rapidly because of a
     small group of "carriers" traveling around the country who are
     infecting everyone else.  Some of these carriers, called
     assassination "buffs", were thought to have contracted the fever as
     many as twelve years ago.
        In the disease's worst form, the patient imagines that there
     exists a powerful, high level group of individuals, some of whom
     have intelligence experience.  The highest level of fever in these
     patients produces the idea that this high level group, usually
     called the PCG, will eliminate presidential candidates not in their
     favor or under their control.  Others imagine that Jimmy Carter has
     been brought into the PCG by threats against his children and
     careful briefings by George Bush.
        It is worth analyzing the sick people with this domestic
     assassination conspiracy fever to see how far their imaginations
     take them.  They calculate that the PCG, fearing exposure if any
     president is not under their control and influence, will go to
     whatever lengths are required to insure the election of the man
     they do control.  The idea is that Gerald Ford was nicely in the
     PCG's pocket because he has been covering up for them ever since
     1964.  He has continued to help them through 1975 and 1976 by
     maintaining a steady cover-up effort on all four cases.  Jimmy
     Carter was perhaps brought under control.  The feverish "buffs"
     figure that the PCG would have been sure to eliminate Jimmy Carter
     unless he could be controlled.
        The scenario continues into the future.  The more control
     exercised by the PCG, the stronger they become and the more people
     in the executive branch become beholden to them to continue
     covering up the cover-ups.
        So, wake up America. Wipe out this disease. It's just as
     dangerous as Communism, if not more so.  Like the general in "Z",
     Americans must realize that such a disease has to be eliminated
     whenever and wherever it appears.



____________________

[1] "Conspiracy Fever" is derived from an article with that title by
   Jacob Cohen, a psychologist, in "Commentary" magazine, October,
   1975.







                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *




                                Chapter 14
                          Congress and the People

        The last hope of the people to take back their government from
     the PCG is through Congress.  The executive branch is a captive of
     the PCG.  The legislative branch has no power in the situation.
     Where courts or judges do have some small measure of power, as in
     the hearings and appeals for a new trial for James Earl Ray, they
     have been controlled by the PCG.  The ruling of the judge in the
     Ray appeals case, for example, was obviously a decision made for
     him by someone higher up.  He ruled that Ray could not have a new
     trial after hearing a vast amount of evidence of conspiracy and
     solid evidence that Percy Foreman had duped Ray into pleading
     guilty.
        Unless a people's revolution comes along, and that hardly seems
     likely, the only possibility left is to hope that Congress can do
     it.  What are the odds?  From what has been pointed out so far, it
     is obvious that if Congress is to expose the PCG, throw the rascals
     in jail, and wipe the slate clean to seize the country back for the
     people, a tremendous battle will be required.  All of the forces of
     the PCG, including their friends in the House and Senate, will be
     focussed on preventing this from happening.  A power base within
     both houses would have to be created that could not only do battle
     with the PCG but that would not be fooled by their myriad of
     fiendishly clever techniques, methods and stratagems.  It would
     have to be a power base that protected itself from infiltration and
     usurpation of its own resources.  It would have to somehow conquer
     the media control problem;  otherwise, no American citizen would
     know what it was doing or what the battle was about.
        How would such a battle start and such a power base be
     constructed?  An important step would be to purify the special
     committee created by either resolution and to purify the staff.
     Preventing infiltration of staff by the PCG is especially
     important.  As mentioned in Chapter 12, the Church Committee staff
     and the Schweiker sub-committee staff were infiltrated by the PCG,
     and specifically the CIA.  A leading assassination researcher and
     former intelligence officer in the Defense Intelligence Agency who
     knew many, many CIA agents discovered two of them in the Church
     Committee staff offices in the fall of 1975.  The other staff
     members had not been aware that these two men were CIA agents
     because they were "deep cover" agents.
        This problem is rather complex because there is always great
     pressure from the House or Senate to create a balance on any
     appointed committee.  Thus the Church committee was hamstrung by
     several of the Senators appointed to be on it:  they were close
     friends and supporters of the CIA and FBI.  Senators Goldwater and
     Tower, for example, fought very hard to block any efforts to have
     the entire committee investigate potential CIA or FBI involvement
     in domestic assassinations.  This does not necessarily mean that
     Goldwater and Tower are members of the inner circle of the PCG.
     But it does mean that PCG members who know who killed John Kennedy
     and why can influence Goldwater and Tower to block such efforts.
        The first step in the House or Senate might be floor voting
     because of the tight control exercised by the PCG over the
     committee procedure on resolutions.  In the House, for example, the
     Rules Committee is all-powerful in determining which resolutions
     are brought to the floor.
        Henry Gonzalez introduced his resolution HR204 in 1975 and sent
     it to the rules committee.  Nearly a year passed.  On March 18,
     1976 Mr. Gonzalez, together with Mr. Downing, was tired of waiting
     for some action by Chairman Madden and they took the issue to the
     floor of the House for discussion.[1]  By this time the two
     representatives had 125 co-sponsors for their two resolutions (an
     unusually large number).  Gonzalez and Downing had taken over the
     floor of the House for two hours and had several supporting
     speakers.  No one rose in opposition.  Prior to that time,
     Representative Sisk from California and Representative Bolling from
     West Virginia had been vehemently outspoken in the Rules Committee
     against both resolutions.  Madden, Sisk and Bolling all left the
     House before Downing and Gonzalez started speaking.
        As a result of Gonzalez's and Downing's efforts, Madden was
     forced by Speaker Albert and other members of the House and by some
     of his own constituents to hold a formal hearing on the two
     resolutions on March 31, 1976.  The PCG controlled the hearing
     through Sisk, Bolling and Lott.  The resolutions were tabled,
     subject to future recall by the chairman.  The vote was nine to
     six.  Representative Bolling was called into the hearing from the
     House floor to cast the ninth vote at the last minute.  He heard
     none of the arguments.  He didn't have to.  The PCG had instructed
     him on how to vote.
        This event is described to illustrate how difficult it would be
     to overcome the control advantages on the side of the PCG.  Only on
     the Senate or House floor might it be possible to equalize things.
     The two events, the two hour discussion on the House floor on March
     18, reported by the "Congressional Record," and the hearing by the
     rules committee on March 31 illustrate another problem Congress has
     combatting the PCG.  Not one of the major news media organizations
     reported either event.  Two hours on the House floor is an
     incredibly long time for any subject.  There were many reporters
     present from television, radio, newspapers and press services. Mark
     Lane saw to that.  But nothing appeared on CBS, NBC, ABC, or in
     "Time," "Newsweek," or the "New York Times."  Why?  The answer is
     obvious.  Very tight control over the news from the House is
     exercised by the PCG.
        The larger implication is there for all to see who want to open
     their eyes.  Seeing it and believing it are two different things.
     For nearly all Congressmen who still have faith in America, the
     whole point of this book, and the existence of a Power Control
     Group which included Ford, Nixon, Kissinger, the CIA, the FBI, the
     fifteen major news media management level people, plus nearly
     anyone else of importance in the executive branch and many
     Congressmen, is too much to swallow.  They would rather have the
     whole thing go quietly away than face up to something that
     gigantic.  And that is the real source of the PCG's strength, the
     unbelievability of it all.


                          Addendum to Chapter 14

        Several truly historic and highly encouraging events occurred in
     the months of September and October, 1976 that could indicate a
     change in the tide and power and control described in earlier
     chapters.
        First, on September 15, a coalition of representatives from the
     Black Caucus, Henry Gonzalez and Thomas Downing managed to get
     Resolution H1540 through the House Rules Committee.  Mark Lane,
     Coretta King and others were responsible for creating pressures
     that finally convinced Speaker Carl Albert, Chairman Tom Madden of
     the Rules Committee and others that this was necessary and
     desirable.  The new resolution, made up of parts of the Downing and
     Gonzalez resolutions plus input from Representative Walter Fauntroy
     from the Black Caucus called for a special 12-person committee to
     reopen the JFK and Dr. King cases and any other deaths that the
     committee might decide to investigate.
        The Rules Committee voted nine to four in favor.  Representative
     Bolling, who perhaps unknowingly had lent his support to the
     opposition in the earlier vote, was an important swing vote and
     actually introduced the resolution in the meeting.  The position of
     the nine who voted for the resolution was more than vindicated two
     days later, when the House, by the extraordinary vote of 280 to 64,
     passed the resolution.  History was made.  On that day cheers
     should have gone up from several hundred dedicated researchers
     around the world, and the Power Control Group should have begun
     looking for rocks to crawl under.
        The real war was only beginning, however.  The "New York Times"
     barely reported the event, did not mention the vote, and buried the
     story in the middle of another story with one-half inch in one
     column.  The "Washington Star" and "Post" carried larger stories
     and the "White Plains Reporter Dispatch" made it a first page
     headline story.  The PCG's media control slipped a bit.
        The next hurdle was for Downing, Gonzalez and Fauntroy to
     convince Albert that the chairman of the new committee for 1977
     should be Mr. Gonzalez since Mr. Downing had announced his
     retirement.  Because elections were being held in November, Mr.
     Albert named Mr. Downing as chairman for the balance of 1976, with
     Mr. Gonzalez as next in line.  He also let it be known to the press
     that Mr. Gonzalez would be the best choice to head the committee
     next year.
        Mr. Albert then named ten other members of the committee for the
     1976 period.  Four of them, Fauntroy, Burke, Stokes and Ford, were
     members of the Black Caucus.  Stewart McKinney, Representative from
     Connecticut, is a well known supporter of the truth.  Those five,
     together with Downing and Gonzalez, could probably be counted on to
     try to arrive at the truth.  The other five representatives--Dodd
     from Connecticut, Preyer from Tennessee, Devine from Ohio, Thone
     from Nebraska and Talcott from California--were unknown quantities.
     If the PCG theory holds up, at least one of them, and perhaps two,
     will turn out to be PCG representatives.
        The next event of significance occurred on October 4 when Mr.
     Downing named Richard A. Sprague, former district attorney from
     Philadelphia and fearless prosecutor of the Yablonski murderers, as
     executive director of the committee's staff.  The main significance
     of this event was who was not named.  Bernard Fensterwald, Jr., was
     in strong contention, but he was not selected because of suspicions
     that he might be a CIA agent and also because of conflicts of
     interests among his clientele.  Fensterwald represented Otto
     Otepka, James McCord, James Earl Ray and Andrew St. George, among
     others.  There is certainly a strong CIA flavor and PCG influence
     among his clients.  Whether or not Bud Fensterwald himself works
     for the CIA or the PCG, his rejection as executive director was a
     healthy sign that the committee might be able to go through the
     purification process described as essential in Chapter 14.
        Richard A. Sprague had his hands full attempting to separate PCG
     applicants for staff positions from non-PCG members.  The PCG,
     during the same time period (September and October) these historic
     events were taking place, was very active in spreading its second
     line of defense information.  "Castro did it in revenge" stories
     began popping up everywhere.  Jack Anderson was revived to back up
     the strategy by publishing another of his "Castro did it" columns.



____________________

[1] House Resolution 204 -- Henry Gonzalez
   House Resolution 498 -- Thomas Downing







                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *

--
                                            daveus rattus

                                  yer friendly neighborhood ratman

                              KOYAANISQATSI

  ko.yaa.nis.qatsi (from the Hopi Language)  n.  1. crazy life.  2. life
      in turmoil.  3. life out of balance.  4. life disintegrating.
        5. a state of life that calls for another way of living.



From [email protected] Tue Jun 16 09:54:48 1992
Received: by icaen.uiowa.edu ( 5.52 (84)/1.1) id AA04897
       on Tue, 16 Jun 92 09:54:42 CDT.
Received: from pl122c.eecs.lehigh.edu by ns-mx.uiowa.edu (5.64.jnf/920408)
         on Tue, 16 Jun 92 09:56:09 -0500 id AA14283 with SMTP
Received: from SGI.COM by PL122c.EECS.Lehigh.EDU (5.61/1.34)
       id AA25477; Tue, 16 Jun 92 10:39:31 -0400
Received: from [192.102.132.11] by sgi.sgi.com via SMTP (911016.SGI/910110.SGI)
       for [email protected] id AA17886; Tue, 16 Jun 92 07:42:10 -0700
Received: by ratmandu.esd.sgi.com (920110.SGI/920502.SGI.AUTO)
       for @sgi.sgi.com:[email protected] id AA00714; Tue, 16 Jun 92 07:42:08 -0700
Date: Tue, 16 Jun 92 07:42:08 -0700
From: [email protected] (dave "who can do? ratmandu!" ratcliffe)
Message-Id: <[email protected]>
To: [email protected]
Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (8/11)
Status: RO


Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (8/11)
Summary: we were robbed of our capability of electing a president we wanted
Keywords:  part 8 of 11:  chapter 15
Lines: 1172


                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *




                                Chapter 15
                  The Select Committee on Assassinations,
               The Intelligence Community and the News Media


                                  Part I

                  The Top Down vs. The Bottom Up Approach
                      To Assassination Investigations


        Two vastly different views have been held by both assassination
     researchers and members of Congress during the last three years
     about the best way to arrive at the truth concerning political
     assassinations in the United States.  The conservative view
     dictates we must build an investigative base from the ground
     upward, beginning with the JFK assassination, and use "hard"
     evidence in each assassination case.  This view assumes that any
     grand, overall conspiracy to cover up the cover-ups would be
     detected and made public following exposure of the first layer of
     cover-ups.
        The less conservative view holds that the political processes
     underlying the original assassinations and the massive cover-up
     superstructure should be attacked and exposed simultaneously.
        The resolutions to establish a Select Committee to Investigate
     Assassinations, introduced by Thomas Downing and Henry Gonzalez in
     the House of Representatives in 1975, were somewhat related to both
     views.  The conservative Downing resolution called for a sole
     investigation of the JFK case.  Gonzalez's resolution called for
     the reopening of all four major cases--JFK, RFK, Dr. King and
     George Wallace--and more importantly, it called for an
     investigation of the possible links among all four.  Gonzalez
     stated that he believed the country might be experiencing an
     assassination-controlled electoral process.  His approach was
     clearly allied with the less conservative view.
        Research groups, such as Mark Lane's Citizen's Commission of
     Inquiry (CCI), Bud Fensterwald's Committee to Investigate
     Assassinations (CTIA), and Bob Katz's Assassination Information
     Bureau (AIB) were also divided in their views.  CCI and CTIA took
     the bottom-up approach and tended to support Downing.  AIB took the
     overview political approach and tended to support Gonzalez.  The
     Black Caucus, Coretta King and others were primarily interested in
     a broad overview of the King assassination.
        The coalition formed by Downing, Gonzalez and the Black Caucus
     finally brought about the creation of the Select Committee on
     Assassinations in the House, which represents a mixture of these
     views and approaches.
        The work of the Select Committee will produce results if it is
     recognized that the bottom-up approach alone cannot be used
     successfully against the group of powerful individuals that
     currently controls the environment in which any investigation
     attempts are to be made.  The best way the Select Committee can
     succeed against this group is to use what will be labelled the "top
     down" approach to investigating and exposing the truth as a
     supplement to the bottom up approach.


                          The Power Control Group

        The earlier part of this book described a group of individuals
     in the United States and labelled them the "Power Control Group."
     The PCG is that group of individuals or organizations that
     knowingly participated in one or more of the assassination
     conspiracies or related murders or attempted murders, plus the
     individuals who knowingly participated or are still participating
     in the cover-ups of those conspiracies or murders.  The PCG
     includes any people in the CIA, FBI, Justice Department, Secret
     Service, local police departments or sheriffs offices in Los
     Angeles, Memphis, Dallas, New Orleans or Florida, judges, district
     attorneys, state attorneys general, other federal government
     agencies, the House of Representatives, the Senate, the White
     House, the Congress, or the Department of Defense as well as any
     people in the media who are under the influence of any of the
     above, who participated or are participating in the cover-ups or
     the cover-ups of the cover-up.  There are indications that people
     in every one of the above organizations or groups belong to the
     PCG.


                        Hard Evidence of Conspiracy

        Anyone who has honestly and openly taken the time to examine a
     few pieces of hard evidence in any one of the four major cases has
     no trouble deciding there were individual conspiracies in each.  In
     the face of this situation, the layman wonders why the Congress
     continually demands hard evidence of conspiracy.  Statements
     continue to appear in the media to the effect that, "I've seen no
     evidence of conspiracy."  Or, "We are not sure whether there were
     others involved in addition to Lee Harvey Oswald, Sirhan Sirhan,
     James Earl Ray or Arthur Bremer."  These statements are made in
     spite of the fact that even the most casual analysis clearly shows
     that Oswald, Sirhan, and Ray did not fire any of the shots that
     struck JFK, RFK and MLK, and that they were all patsies.  Bremer
     fired some of the shots in the Wallace case, but there is evidence
     that another gun was fired.
        The hard evidence is all old evidence.  It goes back at least to
     1967 and 1968 in the JFK case, and back to 1970 through 1972 in the
     RFK and MLK cases.  The Wallace evidence is a little fresher, but
     nevertheless convincing.  The people who demand new evidence are
     either members of the PCG, or they are brainwashed by the media
     members of the PCG into ignoring the old evidence.  They do not
     choose to see or to hear the old evidence, even when it is
     literally placed before their very eyes and ears.  Thus the words
     "hard evidence" are merely substitutes for the words "no
     conspiracy".


                          The Bottom Up Approach

        The bottom up approach is doomed to failure no matter how the
     Select Committee tries and no matter how much effort any official
     body puts into attempts to offer that "bombshell" that Tip O'Neill
     and others look for to prove conspiracy in the JFK and MLK cases.
     The PCG is in complete control of the situation.  It controls the
     media and the media controls the minds of most citizens and the
     Congress.  The PCG is a living, dynamic body right now.  They can
     eliminate an investigation or investigators right now.  They can
     eliminate a member of the House or a member of the Select Committee
     right now.
        The bottom up approach will never get off the ground because the
     PCG will not allow it.  As long as the PCG controls all the sources
     of evidence that might contain the hard evidence in the FBI, CIA
     and local police files, as long as it controls the courts, and as
     long as it controls the media, no one will be allowed to prove hard
     evidence before the House, the Senate, the President, or any one in
     the Executive Branch.


                        The Events of 1976 and 1977

        That the PCG's control exists is more clearly evident now than
     it has ever been before.  The PCG is operating in an almost blatant
     fashion.  Any observer who keeps his eyes wide open and assumes
     that such a group exists, can see it operate almost every day.
        The prime objectives of the PCG in 1976 and 1977 were:


        1.  To block and eliminate the Select Committee on
            Assassinations in the House of Representatives.

        2.  To firmly implant the idea that the JFK assassination
            was a Castro plot.

        3.  To block any Congressional attempts to investigate the
            four assassination cases.

        4.  To control the Carter Administration in such a way as
            to permit only an executive branch investigation that
            will conclude there was a Castro-based JFK conspiracy
            and no conspiracy in the other cases.

        The 1977 activities of the PCG lent themselves to a new
     approach, the "top down" approach to exposing the truth.


                             Exposing the PCG

        The top down approach obviously begins with exposing the PCG's
     immediate, present activities.  The following examples are
     illustrative.  The Select Committee is certainly in a better
     position to know which individuals and actions taken by the PCG
     since the formation of the Committee in September, 1976 would be
     most easily attacked.  The first example is the leaked Justice
     Department report on the King case.


                    The Justice Department King Report

        The PCG members' actions were leaked in the February 2, 1977
     King report and released a few weeks later.  To review the list of
     PCG members involved in the cover-up of the King case:  J. Edgar
     Hoover, the Memphis FBI, Phil Canale (Memphis D.A.), Fred Vinson
     (State Department), Judge Battle, Percy Foreman, William Bradford
     Huie, Gerald Frank (author), Frank Holloman and other members of
     the Memphis police and judges at the state and federal court
     levels.
        One of the judges who became a PCG member in later years was
     Judge McCrea.  He heard James Earl Ray's plea for a new trial.
     Solid evidence of the conspiracy to frame Ray was introduced at
     that hearing.
        Everyone who read or heard the evidence, with the exception of
     Judge McCrea and his law clerk, reached the conclusion that Ray was
     framed and that his lawyer, Percy Foreman, deliberately mishandled
     the case.  Nevertheless, McCrea decided that Ray would not get a
     new trial.  The case was appealed all the way to the Supreme Court
     with no reversals of the decision.


          Leaking the Justice Department Report on the King Case

        Attorney General Levi some years later ordered a review by the
     Justice Department of the King assassination and the FBI's handling
     of its investigation.  A report was prepared by Michael J. Shaheen,
     who did most of the Justice Department work.  No public
     announcement was made in 1976 upon completion of the report.
     Suddenly, on the exact day that the House was debating whether to
     reconstitute the Select Committee (February 2, 1977), the King
     report was leaked to the Republican minority leader of the
     opposition, Representative Quillen of Tennessee.  He announced he
     had a copy of the report.  Representative Yvonne Burke from
     California, a member of the Select Committee and also a member of
     the House Committee responsible for oversight of the Justice
     Department, took strong issue with Quillen over the leak.  She said
     she had unsuccessfully tried to obtain the report that day from the
     Justice Department.  Quillen stated at first he did not have the
     report, but had an Associated Press release describing the report.
     About an hour later, he said he had received a copy of the report.
     Burke stated that was very strange;  not even the proper committee
     of the House had received a copy.
        The report was quoted to say that the Justice Department had
     closed the King case and concluded James Earl Ray was the lone
     assassin.  Placed in the hands of the opposition to the Select
     Committee, the statement was strategically useful.  Quillen argued
     against continuing the Committee on the strength of the conclusions
     reached in the report.


                           Releasing the Report

        On February 19, 1977, the King report was released by the
     Justice Department.  Blaring headlines again emphasized no
     conspiracy and exonerated the FBI's conduct in their investigation.
     A showdown meeting was scheduled for February 21 between Henry
     Gonzalez and Tip O'Neill, to be followed the same day by a meeting
     of the Select Committee to determine whether they would continue
     with Richard A. Sprague as chief counsel.
        The absurd report was published in the "New York Times" on
     February 19, 1977.  The PCG 's tactics became somewhat obvious on
     that date.  Attorney General Griffin Bell, having inherited the
     report from Mr. Levi, let slip an important opinion on the CBS
     program, "Face the Nation" on the Sunday before the report was
     described as "still secret" by the UPI news release quoting Mr.
     Bell.
        Bell said he believed there were questions the report did not
     answer.  Bell clarified his concerns after the February 19 release
     of the report by stating on the 24th that he might want to
     interview Ray to find out where Ray obtained all of the money he
     had before and after King was shot, and whether anyone helped him
     obtain false passports or make travel arrangements.  Perhaps Bell
     was troubled by one of the report's conclusions--that one of Ray's
     motives in killing King was to make a "quick profit."
        This indicates that Mr. Bell, and presumably Mr. Carter, are not
     members of the PCG cover-up on the King case.  It also seems
     obvious that Mr. Levi and the people preparing the report and
     conducting the review had become members of the PCG.  The timed
     release and leaking of that report and the total whitewash of the
     King conspiracy are too patently obvious to be coincidental.  This
     is one area in which the Select Committee has an excellent chance
     to expose a raw nerve of the PCG.


                       Michael Shaheen -- PCG Member

        A key PCG member in the situation would appear to be Mr.
     Shaheen, Judge McCrea's law clerk mentioned earlier in the PCG
     cover-up in Memphis.  Shaheen was deeply involved in the old
     cover-up as well as the new cover-up.  He is from Memphis and part
     of that closed circle of people in Tennessee who know very well
     what happened to Martin Luther King and how Ray was framed.  Mr.
     Shaheen is now planning to become a judge in Memphis with the help
     of all his co-conspirators and PCG members.
        Who called the shots in this Justice Department effort?  Was it
     Levi?  Was it the PCG members left over from the Nixon-Ford
     administration?  Was it members of the PCG still in the FBI?  Was
     it the Tennessee wing of the PCG that includes Judge McCrea, Phil
     Canale, Howard Baker, Mr. Quillen and Bernard Fensterwald, Jr.?
     The Select Committee should find out.  The report itself is easily
     attacked.  It quotes the fake Charlie Stevens testimony all over
     again, as if no one knew he had been bought off by Hoover to
     identify Ray.  Stevens was dead drunk and saw nothing on the day of
     the King assassination.


          Ignoring or Suppressing Conspiracy and Framing Evidence

        Shaheen's review did not touch upon any of the evidence
     regarding the framing of Ray that was introduced at the hearing
     that Judge McCrea and Shaheen knew so very well.  The witnesses who
     had seen Ray at a gas station several blocks from the assassination
     site when the shot was fired were ignored.  Grace Walden Stevens
     saw Frenchy (Raoul) in the rooming house, identified Frenchy as the
     man she saw, and knew Charlie had seen nothing.  She had to be
     ignored.  The witnesses who saw Jack Youngblood move away from the
     bushes from which he had fired the shot had to be ignored.  Hoover
     and Fred Vinson's use of Stevens's false testimony to extradite Ray
     from London had to be ignored.  The FBI's role in Memphis,
     including its instructions to the witnesses who had seen Frenchy to
     keep quiet was to be kept a dark secret.  The similarity between
     Frenchy's photograph and the sketch of Raoul and Ray's subsequent
     identification of Frenchy as Raoul had to be kept quiet.
        More ignored evidence was turned up by Huie.  He found three
     witnesses who had seen Ray and Frenchy-Raoul together both in
     Atlanta and Montreal.  They confirmed Ray's claim that he was
     framed.  All of the evidence involving Youngblood and Frenchy,
     uncovered by Robert Livingston and Wayne Chastain and published in
     "Computers and People" in 1974, was omitted.
        Livingston was Ray's attorney in Tennessee.  Chastain is a
     Memphis reporter.  Livingston and Chastain's sighting of Frenchy-
     Raoul at the Detroit airport during a meeting between Livingston,
     Chastain, Bud Fensterwald and the intermediary representing Frenchy
     (in an attempt to obtain immunity for him in exchange for revealing
     the identity of the Tennesseans and Louisianians who had hired him)
     was ignored.
        Exposure of this segment of the PCG would have done more to
     bolster the 1977 efforts of the Select Committee than any
     presentation of conspiracy evidence in the King case itself.


                The PCG's Tactics With the Select Committee

        In the early days of the formation of the Committee in September
     1976, the PCG might have taken the Committee very lightly.  The
     PCG's efforts to stop an investigation from beginning in the spring
     of 1976 through its control of the Rules Committee had been
     successful.  Downing and Gonzalez had given up.  But when the
     three-way coalition suddenly brought about a reversal of their
     earlier Rules Committee vote, and the House quickly and
     overwhelmingly passed a resolution to set up the Committee, the PCG
     was forced to go back to the drawing boards for retaliation.
        Before the PCG had time to react, Downing and Gonzalez hired
     Dick Sprague as chief counsel.  Sprague very rapidly hired the
     equivalent of his own FBI.  He sensed from the start that he might
     be up against both the FBI and the CIA, so he carefully screened
     his investigators, lawyers, researchers and other personnel to
     prevent intelligence penetration of the staff.  However, some
     personnel were "handed" to him by both Gonzalez and Downing.
        It goes almost without saying that the PCG would have tried to
     infiltrate the staff.  What they learned by their early
     infiltration was that Sprague and his crack team were not only on
     the right track in both the JFK and MLK investigations, but also
     that the tactics used by the PCG in those weeks were making the
     staff and some of the committee members suspicious about the PCG
     itself.


                    PCG Control of Prior Investigations

        It became imperative for the PCG to either eliminate the entire
     Committee or to gain control of it and to rid it of Dick Sprague
     and the senior staff people who were loyal to him.  It was no
     longer possible to turn the investigations around and bury the
     information that had been gathered as the PCG had done with six
     prior Congressional investigations.  In each of the prior
     investigations (five Senate investigations and one House
     investigation of the JFK assassination) the PCG had controlled the
     results, disbanded the staffs and buried the evidence.  The six
     groups were:


         1.  1968--A Senate subcommittee under Senator Ed Long of
             Missouri conducted a JFK investigation.  Bernard
             Fensterwald, Jr., was in charge of a six-person team.

         2.  1974--The Ervin Committee investigated the JFK case
             during the Watergate period.  Samuel Dash headed a team
             of four that included Terry Lenzer, Barry Schochet and
             Wayne Bishop.

         3.  1975--The Church Committee.  A six-person team reported
             to FAO Schwartz III.  It included Bob Kelley, Dan
             Dwyer, Ed Greissing, Paul Wallach, Pat Shea and David
             Aaron.

         4.  1975--The Schweiker-Hart subcommittee under the Church
             Committee had a team headed by David Marston, that
             included Troy Gustafson, Gaeton Fonzi, and Elliott
             Maxwell.

         5.  1975--Pike Committee in House.  People unknown.

         6.  1976--Senate Intelligence Committee under Daniel
             Inouye.

        In addition, both Howard Baker and Lowell Weicker conducted
     their own investigations of the JFK case during the Watergate
     period.
        Sprague and his senior staff people are professionals compared
     to the amateurs listed above.  Wayne Bishop was the only
     professional investigator in all of the staff groups.  It was easy
     for the PCG to cut off or alter the directions of the prior
     investigations.  Thus, the one with the greatest hope, the
     Schweiker subcommittee, wound up not mentioning any of the
     important evidence uncovered in Florida and elsewhere in their
     final report.  The Congress and the public were left with the
     impression that there might have been a Castro conspiracy to
     assassinate JFK.

                                PCG Strategy

        Faced with the new committee and Sprague's staff, the PCG had
     devise a strategy that included:


         1.  Attacking Dick Sprague to discredit him with dirt and
             print it in the media.

         2.  Using the media to spread PCG propaganda and control
             the sources of all stories concerning the Select
             Committee.

         3.  Using PCG Congressmen to provide biased, distorted
             quotes to the media for its use.

         4.  Trying to discredit the entire committee by making it
             appear to be disorganized and unmanageable.

         5.  Controlling the voting and lobbying against the
             continuation of the committee in January and February.

         6.  Influencing members of the House to vote against the
             Committee through a massive letter and telegram
             campaign.

         7.  Exaggerating the emphasis placed on the size of the
             budget requested by Sprague without considering the
             need for such a budget.

         8.  Demanding that the committee justify its existence by
             producing new evidence.

         9.  Splitting the committee and attempting to create
             dissension;  creating a battle between Henry Gonzalez
             and Richard Sprague and between Gonzalez and Downing.

        10.  Hamstringing the staff so they could not receive
             salaries, could not travel, did not have subpoena
             power, could not make long distance telephone calls;
             blocking access to the key files at the FBI, Justice
             Department, CIA and Secret Service.

        11.  Trying to insert their own man at the head of the
             staff.

        12.  Brainwashing Henry Gonzalez into believing that Sprague
             and others were agents.

        13.  Sacrificing Henry Gonzalez when it became obvious the
             PCG could not control him as their chairman.

        14.  Leaking stories that seemed to make the committee's
             efforts unnecessary.


                               Media Control

        The primary technique used by the PCG is its nearly absolute
     control of the media.  This is not as difficult to achieve as one
     might imagine.  Since most of the stories about the committee
     originate in Washington under rather tightly-knit conditions, it is
     necessary to control only a small number of key reporters and their
     bosses.  The rest of the media follow along like sheep.
        The PCG trotted out some of their old-timers in the media to
     initiate the public and congressional brainwashing program against
     the committee.  They used the same tactic against Jim Garrison
     between 1967 and 1969.  The old-timers included Jeremiah O'Leary,
     George Lardner, Jr., and David Burnham.  Jeremiah O'Leary of the
     "Washington Star" was on the CIA's list of reporters exposed the
     year before.  George Lardner Jr. had been in David Ferrie's
     apartment until 4 AM on the morning he was murdered.  Lardner was a
     PCG member in 1967, while he worked as a reporter for the
     "Washington Post" (he is still with the "Post").  David Burnham at
     the "New York Times," one of the several reporters in Harrison
     Salisbury's and Harding Bancroft, Jr.'s stable of PCG workers, was
     called upon to carry the brunt of the "Times"' attack.
        There were, of course, others.  As in 1967 and at other times
     during the first decade of media cover-ups, the major TV, radio,
     wire service, magazine and newspaper media acted as a cover-up
     unit.  Ben Bradlee, the PCG chieftain at the "Washington Post,"
     made sure that "Newsweek" did their hatchet jobs.  Time, Inc., CBS
     (with Eric Sevaried, Dick Salant and Leslie Midgeley), NBC (with
     David Brinkley), and ABC (with Bob Clark and Howard K. Smith) all
     went on the attack.  The overall theme was that the committee would
     soon die out.


                               Media Tactics

        The tactics first used were to create the impression that the
     Committee was not going to find anything of importance.  Then Dick
     Sprague became the chief target.  One of the dirty tricks used
     against him portrayed him as arrogant, flamboyant, power-mad, and
     as a man who usurped the powers of the Committee.  The writers and
     editors of the PCG are very good at this sort of thing.  The "New
     York Times," with Burnham writing and Salisbury and Bancroft
     directing, did a real hatchet job on Sprague.  These techniques
     convinced congressmen and much of the public.  Sqrague was forced
     to stay very quiet and away from reporters and cameras.  That did
     not deter the PCG people.  Once an image of a man has been created
     by the media, it is not necessary for him to appear in public.  He
     could even disappear for several weeks, but the flamboyant, noisy
     image would go on uninterrupted.  This technique is much less
     obvious than murder, but it works nearly as well.  When the time
     comes to destroy or eliminate the man, all the PCG has to do is
     create an image.


                           The Vote to Continue

        The man chosen to eliminate Sprague was the new chairman of the
     Select Committee, Henry Gonzalez.  Before setting up a classic
     "personality conflict" between Gonzalez and Sprague, the PCG used
     another tactic.  It attempted to kill the Committee with a vote not
     to continue it in the 1977 Congress.
        The House and media PCG members overemphasized the large budget
     requested by Dick Sprague, the use of the polygraph, the use of the
     psychological stress evaluator and the telephone monitoring
     equipment.  Rather than telling the truth about the budget,
     describing how the money would be spent, and describing why and how
     the equipment was going to be used, the media (aided and abetted by
     PCG members in the House itself) made it seem as though the budget
     was totally out of line and that citizen's rights would be violated
     by the use of such equipment.  The PCG planted false information
     that led Don Edwards of California to play into their hands on the
     equipment issue.
        The year-end report of the Committee, which they and the staff
     hoped would make these subjects clear, countered the media attacks.
     *But*, of course, the PCG controls the media, and the report was
     completely blacked out.  Most citizens do not even know it exists.
     Almost every U.S. citizen has heard and seen Dick Sprague called a
     rattlesnake and an unscrupulous character.  However, the PCG lost
     the vote against continuing the Committee and used a new method to
     try to kill it.


                              The New Tactic

        The PCG decided to use Gonzalez to control the Committee.  The
     stage was set for the PCG to knock off Sprague and to install one
     of their own men.  The plan was to do this by brainwashing Henry
     Gonzalez into distrusting Sprague and selected members of the
     Committee and the staff.
        The idea was to use Gonzalez in this way to install a PCG man
     (the fact that he was a PCG man was unknown to Gonzalez) as chief
     of staff.  Gonzalez would fire Sprague and the key staff members,
     first blocking their access to important files and witnesses.  The
     PCG would then have been in a position to either fold up the
     Committee by March 31, or to direct its efforts toward finding a
     Castro-did-it conspiracy in JFK's case and no conspiracy in the
     King case.


                             Tactic Backfires

        The PCG did not forecast one important effect their tactics
     would have.  By the time Henry Gonzalez became chairman, the other
     eleven members of the Committee and its staff had begun to smell a
     rat.  They noted with curiosity all of the strange coincidences
     that occurred.  During the floor debate on February 2, 1977 over
     continuing the Committee, Representatives Devine, Preyer, Burke and
     Fauntroy let the rest of the House know that they believed
     something peculiar was happening to them.  The appearance of the
     Justice Department report on that same day disturbed them very
     much.  The attacks on Sprague upset them also.
        The staff were even more disturbed.  Most of them had assumed
     they were being asked to conduct a thorough and unbiased
     investigation of two homicides.  The power of the PCG became
     obvious to them over a period of several weeks.  The effect of this
     on both the Committee and its staff was to drive all eighty-four
     people (73 staff and 11 Committee members) into a solid block (the
     only exceptions were Gonzalez's people on the staff), more
     determined than ever to get at the truth.  Some staffers began
     using their own money for travel.  All of them took pay cuts.  Many
     of them decided they would work for nothing if necessary to keep
     going.  The PCG's strategy had backfired.  The eighty-four loyal
     people were like one giant lion backed into a corner, spurred on to
     greater heights to fight back.
        For this reason, the PCG tactic to use a brainwashed Henry
     Gonzalez failed.  The eighty-four people resisted that manuever by
     threatening to resign en masse.  Tip O'Neill and others were forced
     to go against Gonzalez.  Gonzalez resigned.  The House voted by a
     large majority to accept his resignation and Tip O'Neill appointed
     Louis Stokes as the new chairman.  At this point, the PCG decided
     to abandon Gonzalez and to try another tactic, signalled by an
     article in the "Washington Star" on March 3, 1977.  Written by
     "Star" staff writer Lynn Rosellini, the article was entitled,
     "Gonzalez' Action Stuns Panel but Not the Home Folks."  It was
     manufactured by the PCG to discredit Gonzalez and his final demise.
     (It was the first anti-Gonzalez article to appear.)  The PCG had
     obviously decided to throw Gonzalez to the wolves.  The significant
     quote was supposedly from a "source familiar with Gonzalez' career"
     that said "Henry focuses in on conspiracies, the weird angle of
     things.  Once he gets involved in something, he shakes it by the
     throat until it's dead."  That was a dead giveaway that the PCG no
     longer wanted Henry around.


                    Next Tactic -- Death By Acclamation

        The PCG's next tactic was to convince a majority of the House
     that the Committee had had it because of the feuding as portrayed
     in the press.  They hoped to either eliminate the Committee
     altogether or eliminate the JFK investigation or to force Sprague
     to resign.  (After all, the King conspiracy can always be blamed on
     J. Edgar Hoover, if it comes down to that.  There is no particular
     spillover from the King case into JFK, RFK or Wallace, provided
     Frenchy can be kept out of the limelight.)  It might have been
     possible for the PCG Congressmen to propose dropping the JFK case
     or to propose postponing it in favor of continuing just the King
     case with a reduced budget.  Prior to March 31, a House floor vote
     or a vote in the Rules Committee could have been proposed that
     might have limited the investigations and the authority of the
     Select Committee in this way.  The rules under which the Select
     Committee would operate were not passed by the Committee due to the
     conflict between Henry Gonzalez and the rest of the members, so the
     proposal could have included restrictive rules.  The PCG media
     could have boosted this idea with the PCG loyalists in the House.
     Jim Wright appeared to be the new leader of the opposition to kill
     the Select Committee.  More ground was being laid every day for a
     negative vote on continuation.  The hint was that the Committee
     must come up with a bombshell or that it will die.
        The Committee fought off this tactic by diverting the attention
     of the media through a series of very rapidly developing activities
     and a substantial reduction in the proposed budget, which plummeted
     to 2.8 million for the remainder of 1977.  The House finally voted
     to continue the Committee by a very narrow margin, with a swing of
     25 votes determining the result.
        The final weapon used to obtain a vote to continue the Committee
     on March 30 was the resignation of Dick Sprague.


                             Exposing the PCG

        The best way to expose the PCG is to demonstrate that it has
     been influencing or controlling the media and attempting to control
     Congress.  How can this be done?  It will be necessary to show who
     the PCG members are in the House and the media and exactly what
     they have been doing while they are doing it.  Getting this kind of
     information out to the public will be very difficult, since the
     entire media group seems to be controlled.  Live TV is not easily
     controllable.  If unannounced exposures of PCG members are made on
     live TV there would be no way for the PCG to stop it.  About the
     only way to set up such a situation would be to hold public
     hearings with live TV coverage.
        Exposing the PCG to Congress might be accomplished on the floor
     of the House.  Evidence of the clandestine activities of PCG
     members in the tactics described above could be introduced on the
     floor without media coverage.  This happened to a minor extent on
     March 30 when some of the Committee members began to accuse the
     media of improper influence.


                          Who Are The PCG Members

        The PCG members presently attempting to control the Select
     Committee must be clearly identified.[1]  There are, no doubt, some
     media people and Representatives who sincerely believe that there
     were no conspiracies and who have been playing into the hands of
     the PCG without realizing it.  Other Representatives, and media
     people by the definition of the term PCG, are purposefully
     controlling the situation.  It may be difficult to distinguish
     between these two groups without tracing back some PCG connection
     of the culprits.  Any CIA or FBI clandestine relationship or any
     direct connection with any of the assassination cases would be a
     tip.  An example of this is George Lardner, Jr.'s direct connection
     with the JFK case ten years ago.  (Lardner was in David Ferrie's
     apartment for four hours after the midnight time of death estimated
     by the New Orleans coroner.  Ferrie was killed by a karate chop to
     the back of his neck.)  Jim Garrison interrogated Lardner at some
     length, but he never received a satisfactory explanation of what he
     had been doing there.
        While it may be difficult to tell which congressmen are sincere
     and which are knowingly trying to extend the cover-ups, the Select
     Committee must turn its attention to any member of the House who
     throws up roadblocks or who speaks out strongly against the
     continuation of the investigations.  On this basis, one must
     suspect every one of the Representatives cited below.
        Many questions should be asked of this group.  For example, who
     encouraged Mr. Bauman during that autumn and on March 30, Mr. Sisk
     last spring and Mr. Quillen in February to suddenly become so
     vehement about stopping investigations of the assassinations?
     Their stated reasons were that the Kennedys were opposed, costs,
     the lack of new evidence, the Warren Commission, etc.  But these
     reasons can no longer be their own true beliefs.  On whose behalf
     were they acting?  How did Trent Lott find out that the Committee
     staff made a telephone call to Cameroon, which he discussed on
     March 28 at the Rules meeting?
        Who talked Frank Thompson into a campaign to shut off the Select
     Committee's financial resources?  (The Thompson efforts cannot be
     explained away by the ordinary controller's motivations.)  Who
     convinced Jim Wright that the Committee was doomed and that he
     should personally intervene in the Gonzalez, Sprague and Committee
     members' battle?  And, most importantly, who brainwashed both Henry
     Gonzalez and Gail Beagle into mistrusting the people they had
     always trusted?  Answer these questions and publicize the answers,
     and the top-down approach to exposing the PCG and solving the
     assassination conspiracies will be well along the path to success.



                                 Part II

                   "Hard" and "Soft" Propaganda in 1977


        When the time approached for the Select Committee on
     Assassinations to ask the House of Representatives for its 1978
     budget, it was interesting to once again examine the PCG's control
     over the American news media and the Congress.  To those who
     observed the assassination scene with blinders removed, it was
     patently obvious that the December 1977 date for the Select
     Committee's budget approval was a target.  The PCG attempted to
     defeat the Committee's efforts to get at the truth underlying the
     John Kennedy and Martin Luther King assassinations and the cover-up
     crimes associated with them.
        An all-out effort was mounted by the PCG to influence the
     thinking of citizens and the votes of the members of the House.
     This effort manifested itself in the major news media--over the
     three TV networks, the "New York Times," "Washington Post,"
     "Newsweek," "Time," book publishers, book reviewers, TV talk shows,
     etc.
        This massive campaign is a useful test to prove the validity of
     contentions made by this author and others in 1976 and 1977
     concerning the relationships between the Power Control Group and
     the American news media, as utilized in the continuing cover-ups of
     the domestic assassinations, and in the PCG's efforts to destroy
     the reputations of assassination researchers[2] and the two
     official investigations of the John Kennedy assassinations.[3]
        New evidence surfaced in 1977 to support these contentions:  a
     CIA document released under the Freedom of Information Act and an
     article by a new potential ally for assassination truth seekers,
     Carl Bernstein.  Both of these documents were provided to the
     author by Ted Gandolfo in New York, who now has his own weekly
     cable TV show on Friday nights on Manhattan TV entitled,
     "Assassination USA."


                   Evidence of Media Control by the CIA

        Carl Bernstein wrote an article exposing the CIA's methods of
     controlling the news media.[4]  The basic technique dictates
     planting a Secret Team member at the top of each major media
     organization, or obtaining tacit agreements from the top man to use
     reporters working for the CIA, and to use CIA people, stories, and
     policies on the inside of the organization.  Bernstein named men
     above the level named by this author as CIA people in certain
     organizations.  For example, the author's claim was that Harding
     Bancroft, Jr. has been the CIA control point at the "New York
     Times."  Bernstein named Arthur Hays Sulzberger, the owner of the
     "Times" and Bancroft's boss, as the CIA's man at the "Times."  At
     CBS, the author named Richard Salant.  Bernstein names William C.
     Paley.  At the "Washington Post" and "Newsweek" Bernstein names
     Philip Graham, Katherine Graham's husband, former owner of the
     "Post" and "Newsweek," and by inference, Mrs. Graham since her
     husband's death.  The author named Ben Bradlee.  But Bernstein's
     information confirms the author's contention that the CIA controls
     the 15 news media organizations in the U.S.
        The other CIA top level individuals named by Bernstein are as
     follows:

             "Louisville Courier Journal"--Barry Bingham, Sr.
             NBC--Richard Wald
             ABC--Sam Jaffe
             Time, Inc.--Henry Luce
             Copley News Service--James Copley
             Hearst--Seymour Freiden

        The PCG, through their prime intelligence members, are today
     still controlling what the media do and say about the subject of
     assassinations and the Select Committee on Assassinations.[5]  They
     do this by influencing the heads of each organization who determine
     media editorial policies that are carried out by their
     subordinates.  In some cases, however, lower level people are also
     planted as reporters, editors or producers to execute the policies,
     write the stories, produce the programs, review the books, or write
     or publish the books.  The CIA also owns and controls many
     publishing houses, freelance writers or reviewers who can also be
     used in this massive campaign.
        However, the reader should not immediately jump to the
     conclusion that all of the media people knowingly continue to
     cover-up of the assassination conspiracies.  It is only necessary
     that they actually believe the CIA's stories and positions against
     conspiracies.  For example, Anthony Lewis at the "New York Times"
     participates in this entire fraud, actually believing that Oswald
     was the lone madman assassin.
        It is inconceivable, however, that men intelligent enough to
     rise to the top of CBS, NBC, ABC, the "New York Times et al." could
     actually believe that Oswald was the lone assassin.  Some or most
     of them must be cooperating fully in the PCG cover-up efforts.


               Proof of CIA Efforts to Discredit Researchers

        A recently released CIA document[6] was a dispatch issued from
     CIA headquarters in April 1967 to certain bases and stations to
     mount a campaign through media contacts (called assets) against
     certain assassination researchers.  The targets included Mark Lane,
     Joachim Joesten, Penn Jones, Edward Epstein and Bertrand Russell.
        The document describes an entire program to be used to discredit
     the "critics."  Many of the exact expressions that were used by the
     CIA-controlled media to attack the researchers can be found in this
     document.  One example is:  "The CIA should use this argument in
     general.  Conspiracy on the large scale often suggested (by
     critics) would be impossible to conceal in the United States,
     especially since informants could expect to receive large
     royalties, etc."  Another argument suggested is:  "Note that Robert
     Kennedy, Attorney General at the time and John F. Kennedy's
     brother, would be the last man to overlook or conceal any
     conspiracy."
        How many times did we hear that between 1967 and 1969?
        The document also suggests using an article by Fletcher Knebel
     to attack Ed Epstein's book and to attack it rather than Mark
     Lane's book because "Lane's book is much more difficult to answer
     as a whole, as one becomes lost in a morass of unrelated details."
        The timing of this document is particularly important.  April 1,
     1967 was approximately two months after Jim Garrison's
     investigation surfaced, and only shortly after Garrison found David
     Ferrie murdered in his own apartment and had Clay Shaw arrested.
     Since we now know that both men were contract agents for the CIA
     and that the CIA went to great lengths under Richard Helms'
     direction to protect Clay Shaw and to keep his true identity from
     being revealed, the chances are good that this document was
     triggered by Garrison's investigation.
        The names of the authors of the document have been blacked out
     of the copy that was released.  Further research might reveal who
     actually wrote it and "pulled it together" (as a note in hand print
     at the top states).


                      The Trial of Lee Harvey Oswald

        The top level media control was demonstrated by the ABC-TV
     program, "The Trial of Lee Harvey Oswald", whose co-director,
     Lawrence Schiller, had to have been selected at the suggestion of
     the PCG.  Schiller, one of the worst people in the PCG's stable of
     freelancers, is best known for his book supporting the Warren
     Commission and attacking the researchers, called "The
     Scavengers."[7]
        Schiller is perhaps the biggest scavenger ever created.  He
     supposedly obtained a "deathbed" statement from Jack Ruby by
     illegally and unethically sneaking a tape recorder into his
     hospital room.  He then parlayed this into a wide-selling record
     with distasteful and untruthful propaganda.  More recently he
     seized the opportunity to interview Gary Gilmore before his
     execution, practically holding a mike to his mouth while the
     commands were being given to the firing squad.
        How, the reader may ask, could Schiller become a co-producer of
     a major ABC television show?  The answer is simple.  He is
     available to attack and ridicule the assassination researchers and
     reinforce the no-conspiracy idea for the PCG.
        The ABC production crew had the full cooperation of the Dallas
     police in re-enacting the assassination event in Dealey Plaza.
     There is no way that could have happened without PCG influence.
     The Dallas police, quite guilty of cover-up in the case and having
     some individual members on the assassination team, would not permit
     anyone to film a reenactment of the assassination showing
     conspiracy or the truth.  The PCG had to assure them that the
     program's editorial position would be anti-conspiracy.
        The "Trial of Lee Harvey Oswald" was given extensive publicity
     on TV, in magazines, in newspapers. In England, a special article
     about it appeared in the Sunday magazine section of a London
     newspaper complete with photographs from the shooting sequence as
     filmed.[8]  The PCG spent an enormous amount of money on the
     program and a publicity campaign.  There is no way ABC-TV could
     have done that on their own.  More than 80% of the people believe
     there was a conspiracy:  why wouldn't ABC go along with the 80% of
     their viewers and portray the truth?  The answer again is simple:
     ABC is controlled from the very top, probably much higher than the
     Sam Jaffe level, by the PCG and the CIA.


                              Other TV Shows

        Both NBC and CBS are planning major TV specials on the
     assassinations.  CBS is planning a show on Ruby and Oswald.  The
     theme will be that the Warren Commission was right and that both
     Oswald and Ruby were lone nuts.  Mr. Paley and Mr. Salant are the
     PCG people calling the shots.  NBC is planning a show on Martin
     Luther King which will have a section on the assassination.  Even
     though Abbey Mann is directing the show and he would like to bring
     out some of the facts, it is certain that the PCG members of NBC,
     including Richard Wald, will not permit any conclusions about Ray's
     innocence or information about Frenchy-Raoul or Jack Youngblood
     (the real assassins) to be included.


                       Priscilla McMillan--CIA Agent

        One of the more remarkable things about the massive 1977
     campaign of the CIA and the PCG is their blatant use of freelance
     writers and news reporters who are well known CIA agents to nearly
     anyone who has taken the time to pay attention.  Three agents are
     Priscilla McMillan and her husband, George McMillan, and Jeremiah
     O'Leary of the "Washington Star."  Priscilla (in particular) is so
     obviously an agent that even Dick Cavett indirectly accused her of
     being one when she appeared on his show with Marina Oswald to plug
     her new book.
        The CIA decided the perfect time to publish McMillan's book[9],
     which had been completed for several years.  A publisher under CIA
     control was selected, and the book was published in time for the
     December committee budget vote.  The CIA arranged that Marina
     appear with Pat on several national TV shows.  Priscilla had Marina
     well rehearsed for these shows--she even retold the old lies about
     Oswald shooting at General Walker.  The commentators selected to
     interview both women, including Dick Cavett, David Hartmann (ABC),
     and Tom Snyder (NBC) had their orders to deal delicately with them
     and not to ask any embarrassing questions.  Cavett came closest
     with his essentially accusatory question about whether Priscilla
     was a CIA agent.
        No one asked Marina the one embarrassing question she would have
     had the greatest difficulty answering regarding the picture of
     Oswald holding the rifle and the communist newspaper that Marina
     claimed she took of him:  "How was it possible for you to have
     taken a photograph that since has been demonstrated to be a
     composite of three photographs, with your husband's head attached
     to someone else's body at the chin line?"  (flashing on the screen
     Fred Newcomb's slide showing the chin level discontinuity).  Cavett
     actually flashed the fake photograph on the screen at the beginning
     of his show, but he never mentioned it.
        This monumental PCG effort that involved controlling at least
     three TV networks, a CIA publisher, Marina Oswald, a CIA agent,
     Priscilla McMillan, an enormous amount of time and money, and a
     special book review by the "New York Times"[10] demonstrates how
     much power the PCG has.
        Some of those people who watched "Good Morning America" and the
     "Tomorrow Show" and the "Dick Cavett Show" (three different types
     of national viewing audiences) who believe the lone assassin theory
     and the Warren Commission had those beliefs reinforced by Priscilla
     McMillan and Marina Oswald.  It is wise for researchers, the Select
     Committee on Assassinations and others who know what is really
     going on, not to underestimate this power of the PCG.


                            Fensterwald's Book

        A book by Bud Fensterwald appeared in 1977 under the sponsorship
     of the PCG.[11]  This clever effort on the part of one of the CIA's
     best agents was designed to throw people off the track who have a
     somewhat deeper interest in the JFK assassination.  It was meant to
     divert attention away from the CIA by omitting at least twelve of
     the CIA conspirators who were in the files of the Committee to
     Investigate Assassinations (co-founded by Fensterwald and the
     author in 1968).
        No excuse can be given for leaving these key people out of the
     book, because the CIA had extensive files on most of them.  Bud
     Fensterwald even had a personal correspondent relationship to the
     key informant of the group, Richard Case Nagell.  The twelve are:
     William Seymour, Emilio Santana, Manuel Garcia Gonzalez, Guy
     Gabaldin, Mary Hope, Richard Case Nagell, Harry Dean, Ronald
     Augustinovich, Thomas Beckham, Fred Lee Crisman, Frenchy, and Jack
     Lawrence.  All of them were included in a description of the
     details of the assassination team earlier in this book and in an
     article by the author.[12]
        Zebra Books, the publisher of Fensterwald's book, is a CIA-
     controlled organization that has also published another
     disinformation book, "Appointment in Dallas," by Hugh
     MacDonald.[13]  In both cases, the PCG intended to misdirect
     attention away from the CIA participants while at the same time
     admitting conspiracy.  There is no way the story in MacDonald's
     book can be true.  It maintains that Oswald at least planned to
     fire from the sixth floor window of the TSBD Building.  As all good
     researchers know, the photographs of the window, inside and
     outside, prove there was no one firing from that window that day.


                        The de Mohrenschildt Murder

        The Murder Inc. branch of the PCG killed George de Mohrenschildt
     when he became too dangerous for them.  The media branch of the PCG
     then undertook a campaign to discredit Willem Oltmans and NOS-TV
     (in Holland) who happened to be in possession of a series of video
     and audio tapes of de Mohrenschildt that will be very damaging for
     the PCG.
        The de Mohrenschildt murder has so far been concealed by the PCG
     with the help of the media and portrayed as the suicide of a man
     who had become insane.  As Willem Oltmans' book clearly
     demonstrates[14] de Mohrenschildt was quite sane when he
     disappeared from Belgium.  He was in the process of giving Ed
     Epstein a story about his involvement in the JFK assassination when
     he was murdered in Florida.


                     Donald Donaldson's Disappearance

        General Donald Donaldson, alias Dimitri Dimitrov alias Jim
     Adams, was intimately acquainted with the CIA people who planned
     JFK's assassination.  He was in Holland to tell his story to NOS-TV
     and Willem Oltmans.  He told Oltmans that Allen Dulles was the key
     CIA man in planning JFK's assassination.  (Donaldson had been
     brought to the U.S. as a double agent during World War II by
     Franklin Roosevelt.)  He held back his knowledge of the
     assassination conspiracy until the Church Committee was formed.  He
     then took his information to Church, who brought him to President
     Ford rather than having him questioned by the Church Committee or
     the Schweiker sub-committee. Ford, Church and Donaldson had a
     meeting in which Ford talked both of them into keeping Donaldson's
     information under wraps.
        When de Mohrenschildt was killed, Donaldson decided it was time
     to make his information public and to offer it to the Select
     Committee.  He approached Oltmans, asked that his identity be kept
     secret, told NOS his story, and then remained in Holland while
     Oltmans attempted to tell the story to President Carter.  Oltmans
     revealed Donaldson's identity on American TV and to the Select
     Committee when Carter refused to listen to the story.  Donaldson
     then moved to England, and subsequently disappeared from a London
     hotel, leaving large unpaid bills at both his London and Amsterdam
     hotels.  The possibility is very good that he has gone the same
     route as de Mohrenschildt, murdered by the PCG.


                      Attacks on the Select Committee

        One of a series of attacks on the Select Committee in November
     and December, leading up to the December vote on the 1978 budget,
     took place in the form of an article by probable CIA agent George
     Lardner, Jr., one of the Select Committee's biggest enemies.  He is
     one of the PCG's stable of reporters.  Lardner wrote an article for
     the Sunday "Washington Post" on November 6, 1977, portraying the
     Committee as engaging in random, uncoordinated activity,
     interrogating witnesses from the Garrison investigation (which
     Lardner labelled, "the zany Garrison investigation", and "the
     fruitless investigation").  The "New York Times," "Washington Star"
     and other media can be expected to open up all barrels under PCG
     direction.  The general theme will no doubt be that the Committee
     has done nothing at all and that Oswald acted alone.[15]
        If Council Blakey or Chairman Stokes, or JFK subcommittee
     Chairman Preyer try to respond to these attacks they will be ripped
     to shreds by the PCG's media people.  As the author pointed out in
     part I of this chapter, the only chance the Committee and the House
     have to keep the investigation going is to expose the PCG and their
     media control, from the top down.  Otherwise the Committee cannot
     win the battle.



____________________

[1] Power Control Group (PCG) defined in prior articles and one book
    by the author, as follows:

      The PCG includes all organizations and individuals who
    knowingly participated in any of the domestic political
    assassinations or attempted assassinations, or in any of the
    efforts to cover-up the truth about those assassinations.  This
    includes a large number of murders of witnesses and participants.
    The assassinations involved include, but are not necessarily
    limited to the following:

       John Kennedy, Robert Kennedy, Martin Luther King, George
       Wallace and Mary Jo Kopechne.

      The PCG is a much larger group than just the clandestine parts
    of the CIA and the FBI, or the Secret Team as defined by L.
    Fletcher Prouty.  It would however, include all those members of
    the Secret Team or the CIA or the FBI falling under the
    definition.

[2] The author's contentions about media control by the PCG have
    appeared in one self-published book and several articles:

      (a) Book:  "The Taking of America, 1-2-3," R.E.  Sprague,
    self-published, Hartsdale, N.Y., 1976.  (First Edition.  This
    Third Edition contains chapters 15-17 plus the Appendix which
    were written after 1977.  --Editor)
      (b) Articles: "The American News Media and the Assassination of
    President John F. Kennedy:  Accessories After Fact," R.E.
    Sprague, "Computers and Automation," June, July, 1973.
      (c) "The Central Intelligence Agency and the `The New York
    Times,'" R.E. Sprague.  (Using pseudonym Samuel F. Thurston)
    "Computers and Automation," July, 1971.  Republished in "People
    and the Pursuit of Truth," May, 1977.
      (d) "Congressional Investigation of Political Assassinations in
    the United States:  The Two Approaches:  From the Bottom Up vs.
    From the Top Down," R.E. Sprague, "People and the Pursuit of
    Truth," May, 1977.

[3] The two official investigations of the Kennedy assassination
    referred to here are:

      (a) The investigation by the office of the district attorney of
    Orleans Parish, New Orleans, La. 1966 to 1969 (Jim Garrison).
      (b) The investigation by the Select Committee on Assassinations
    of the U.S. House of Representatives 1976-1977.

      The investigations by the Schweiker-Hart subcommittee of the
    Church committee and the Ervin Watergate committee were never
    really approved by Congress, and so lacked the power and
    influence to become a threat to the PCG.

[4] "The CIA and the Press," Carl Bernstein, "Rolling Stone," October
    4, 1977.  A copy of the full unedited manuscript of this article
    was also made available to the author.  The "Rolling Stone"
    version had selected names omitted.

[5] Bernstein's article also describes the CIA influence over several
    other media organizations without naming the top executives.
    These are:
      "New York Herald Tribune"
      "Saturday Evening Post"
      "Scripps Howard Newspapers"
      "Associated Press"
      "United Press International"
      "Reuters"
      "Miami Herald"
    And a CIA official told Bernstein, "that's just a small part of
    the list."

[6] The CIA document was obtained by Harold Weisberg under the
    Freedom of Information Act.  It is dated 4/1/67 and labelled
    "Dispatch to Chiefs, Certain Stations and Bases."  Document
    Number 1035-960 for "FOIA Review" on September 1976.  Object:
    Countering Criticism of the "Warren Report."

[7] "The Scavengers and Critics of the Warren Report," Lawrence
    Schiller, Dell Publishing Co., New York, 1967.

[8] "The Big If," "London Sunday Times," September 18, 1977.

[9] "Marina and Lee," Patricia McMillan, Harper & Row, 1977.

[10] A review of the McMillan book appeared in the "Sunday New York
    Times" book review section on November 6, 1977.  It praised the
    book to the skys, backed up the Warren Commission, and severely
    attacked the researchers and the Select Committee.

[11] "Coincidence or Conspiracy," Bernard Fensterwald, Jr., Zebra
    Books, New York, 1977.

[12] (a) "The Taking of America, 1-2-3," Richard E. Sprague,
        self-published, 1976.

    (b) "The Assassination of President John F. Kennedy:  The
        Involvement of the Central Intelligence Agency in the Plans
        and the Cover-Up", Richard E.  Sprague -- "People and the
        Pursuit of Truth," May, 1975.

[13] "Appointment in Dallas," Hugh C. McDonald, Zebra Books, New York,
    1975.

[14] "George de Mohrenschildt," Willem Oltmans, Published in The
    Netherlands, Unpublished in the United States.

[15] This chapter originally appeared as the article "Congressional
    Investigation of Political Assassinations in the United States:
    The Two Approaches:  From the Bottom Up vs. From the Top Down,"
    by the author in "People and the Pursuit of Truth," May, 1977.
    Since the original article was written, in November 1977 the
    Select Committee decided that the budget money approved in 1977
    was sufficient to carry over a few months into 1978.  No budget
    request was made in December 1977.  The PCG can now be expected
    to continue its attacks until the spring of 1978 when the
    budget request will be made. (January 4, 1978)







                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *

--
                                             daveus rattus

                                   yer friendly neighborhood ratman

                               KOYAANISQATSI

   ko.yaa.nis.qatsi (from the Hopi Language)  n.  1. crazy life.  2. life
       in turmoil.  3. life out of balance.  4. life disintegrating.
         5. a state of life that calls for another way of living.



From [email protected] Wed Jun 17 07:55:35 1992
Received: by icaen.uiowa.edu ( 5.52 (84)/1.1) id AA07136
       on Wed, 17 Jun 92 07:55:31 CDT.
Received: from pl122c.eecs.lehigh.edu by ns-mx.uiowa.edu (5.64.jnf/920408)
         on Wed, 17 Jun 92 07:57:09 -0500 id AA07930 with SMTP
Received: from SGI.COM by PL122c.EECS.Lehigh.EDU (5.61/1.34)
       id AA29041; Wed, 17 Jun 92 08:43:40 -0400
Received: from [192.102.132.11] by sgi.sgi.com via SMTP (911016.SGI/910110.SGI)
       for [email protected] id AA13139; Wed, 17 Jun 92 05:46:23 -0700
Received: by ratmandu.esd.sgi.com (920110.SGI/920502.SGI.AUTO)
       for @sgi.sgi.com:[email protected] id AA07406; Wed, 17 Jun 92 05:46:21 -0700
Date: Wed, 17 Jun 92 05:46:21 -0700
From: [email protected] (dave "who can do? ratmandu!" ratcliffe)
Message-Id: <[email protected]>
To: [email protected]
Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (9/11)
Status: RO


Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (9/11)
Summary: we were robbed of our capability of electing a president we wanted
Keywords:  part 9 of 11:  chapter 16
Lines: 867


                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *



                   1979:  The House Select Committee (1)

                                Chapter 16
                             1984 Here We Come

        George Orwell undoubtedly did not realize how accurate his 1984
     scenario would be by the year 1979.  As 1978 drew to a close,
     events in America made Orwell's descriptions of such concepts as
     Newspeak and a supposedly open but actually closed society, very
     close to reality.  By 1984, now only five short years away,
     Orwell's scenario will apparently be right on the nose.
        Any doubts about who is in charge of America and how effective
     they have become in creating our actual version of Newspeak,
     disappeared as the Carter administration, congress, the courts, and
     the media, all combined their coordinated efforts to cover up and
     distort our current history.  The hopes of thousands of Americans
     that their only true representatives in government, the members of
     the House, would expose the fabric of lies about our recent history
     and the Power Control Group's activities were dashed to smithereens
     by the House of Representative's Select Committee on
     Assassinations.  The hopes that Carter might be on our side, faded
     away in 1978 and the intentions of the executive branch were made
     quite clear by the new directors of the FBI and the CIA.
        The murder incorporated group within the Power Control Group
     continued to murder people in 1978, with efficiency and dispatch.
     The presidential race in 1980 has been foreclosed to Ted Kennedy
     for a long time, but the chances that any candidate, not willing to
     extend the assassination cover-ups, could be nominated and elected,
     are close to zero.
        The American people, by and large, do not understand or
     appreciate very much of this.  The Select Committee teamed with the
     media and by holding public hearings with almost no live coverage
     they convinced the majority of Americans that there was no
     conspiracy in the JFK case and that James Earl Ray shot Martin
     Luther King although he might have had help from his brothers.  The
     public has never heard of most of the eight men assassinated in
     1977 and 1978 by the PCG, nor do they appreciate the fact that
     future assassinations will be carried off by the same bunch.
        How the hell did the PCG control Congress and the Select
     Committee?  It wasn't easy and they very nearly didn't.
        There may also be another explanation about the committee's
     actions in which the word "control" is too strong.  Influence,
     intimidation by throwing out implied warnings or threats, or just
     plain making it obvious that personal danger could be involved,
     might have been used.  The process was very involved and it made
     use of a number of techniques and approaches, including some we can
     only guess at in 1979.  However, a number of the PCG's methods are
     known and will be described herein.
        The executive branch control by the PCG was exposed even before
     Carter's election by those whose eyes were open wide enough to see
     it.  This author frankly admits to partially closed eyes until
     1978.  The significance of the Bilderberg Society and the
     Trilateral Commission was not obvious until Carter had been in
     office for a couple of years.  Now, it is very obvious that he is
     under the complete domination of the men who really run the U.S.A.,
     and that he will never do anything to expose the truth about the
     political assassinations or their cover-ups.
        The latest indication of where the Carter administration stands
     was the testimony given by FBI director William H. Webster to the
     Select Committee on December 11, 1978.  He said that the FBI would
     freeze the scene and take full immediate control of the
     investigation of any future presidential assassination or that of
     any other elected U.S. leader.
        In case anyone has any doubt about what he meant by "freeze the
     scene", Webster went on to say, "One purpose of the FBI
     investigation would be to lay to rest untrue conspiratorial
     questions that have a way of rising, and avoid the sort of mistakes
     that followed the assassination of President Kennedy."[1]  In other
     words, the FBI will suppress or destroy any evidence of conspiracy
     even if they were not involved in the assassination itself.  One
     such "mistake" in the Dallas murder surfaced in December 1978 when
     Earl Golz of the "Dallas Morning News" found a movie that the FBI
     failed to "freeze".  It was taken by a man named Bronson and it
     shows two men, not one, in the sixth floor window of the TSBD just
     five minutes before the shots were fired.  One of the men is
     wearing a red shirt.  That filmed evidence matches the still photo
     taken by an unknown photographer earlier that morning, and
     developed at a Dallas photo lab by Ed Foley, the lab owner.  The
     author found the photo and obtained a print of it in 1967.  The
     Foley photo, as it became known, shows two men in the sixth floor
     window, one with a black shirt and one with a bright red shirt.
     Mr. red shirt matches the description of the man in the Bronson
     film.  He is not Lee Harvey Oswald.  Neither is the man in the
     black shirt.  He was most probably Buel Wesley Frazier, the man who
     drove Oswald to work on November 22, 1963.  The facial profile and
     black shirt match photos of Frazier and another man entitled to be
     on that sixth floor, were there around 10 AM and at 12:25, five
     minutes before the shots were fired.  Mr. Webster has in mind
     rounding up all such evidence and destroying it right away in the
     next assassination.
        The evidence discussed in earlier chapters of this book, also
     not "frozen" by the FBI, proves that the "snipers nest" was no
     snipers nest at all, but just an area where workers on that floor
     were piling cartons to allow the floor laying crew at the west end
     of that floor to do their job.
        Webster would like the FBI to grab such evidence the next time,
     and destroy it before "conspiracy rumors" get started.  The FBI
     came much closer to doing this in Memphis, but after all, they were
     involved directly in the planning and execution of the
     assassination of Dr. King.  They had a much greater incentive for
     cover-up in that murder.  William Sullivan's Division Five, at the
     behest of J. Edgar Hoover, carried out the King assassination using
     Raoul and Jack Youngblood plus others.
        Returning to the Select Committee, I must switch over to a more
     personal tone because of my direct involvement with the group from
     its inception.  I helped Henry Gonzalez in the early days of 1975
     and 1976 when the committee was just a wild dream for most people.
     I made a presentation to Thomas Downing's staff members who
     eventually became part of the Select Committee staff.  Mark Lane
     arranged that in the summer of 1976.  The photographic evidence of
     conspiracy in the JFK case was as overwhelming to them and to Henry
     as it was to anyone who has taken the five or six hours or so to
     look at it.  I then became an advisor to Richard A. Sprague and Bob
     Tanenbaum when the committee was formed and spent the months from
     November 1976 to July 1977 helping them with the photographic
     evidence and with evidence collected by the Committee to
     Investigate Assassinations including Jim Garrison's evidence.
        If Henry Gonzalez or Richard A. Sprague, or Thomas Downing had
     stayed with the committee their work would not have been
     controlled.  Sprague's loyal deputy counsels, Bob Tanenbaum, in
     charge of the JFK investigation and Bob Lehner in charge of the MLK
     investigation had already begun to get at the real evidence of the
     Power Control Group and the FBI and CIA's involvement in the two
     cases and in the cover-ups.  The committee members were already
     becoming very suspicious of the two agencies.  Walter Fauntroy,
     chairman of the MLK sub-committee, even dared to speak out about
     the CIA's influence.  He was beaten into the ground by the PCG's
     members in the House.
        So Gonzalez, Sprague, Tanenbaum, Lehner and others who dared
     take on the intelligence portions of the PCG, had to go.  They were
     forced out by one of the ancient techniques employed by the Romans
     known as divide and conquer.  Once Henry Gonzalez became convinced
     that Richard A. Sprague was working for the CIA and the PCG, he
     attacked Sprague bitterly.  Henry knew there was a PCG and he knew
     who had murdered John Kennedy and why.  Henry had to go.  He was
     made to look like a paranoid fool and forced out by the key PCG
     members of the House.  Two PCG agents, Mr. Z and Harry Livingstone,
     helped convince him that Sprague was a CIA man.
        Mr. Z was brought in by Henry as a lawyer for his committee and
     worked on Henry's beliefs about Richard A. Sprague.  Over some
     weeks he convinced Henry that Richard A. Sprague was a CIA
     operative.  He was supported in this activity by Harry Livingstone
     (later author of "High Treason").  Harry Livingstone engaged in
     various plagiaristic activities and scams, and over quite a period
     of time he worked on Henry to convince him that Richard A. Sprague
     was a CIA operative.  At the same time Henry was developing his
     beliefs with the help of Mr. Z and Mr. Livingstone, Richard A.
     Sprague and his staff were developing skepticism about Henry's
     integrity.  The net result was both men resigned.  In the next
     year, 1978, the author appeared with Richard A. Sprague on a cable
     television broadcast hosted by Ted Gandolfo in New York City,
     named "Assassionation USA," and the three of them had a detailed
     discussion about Sprague's reasons for resigning from the
     Committee.  To some extent his thinking was influenced by his
     skepticism about Henry Gonzalez's integrity.
        Once Louis Stokes took over as chairman, Sprague's men were
     gradually calmed down, and the so-called search for the right chief
     counsel was underway.  It is difficult to detect what was going on
     during that spring of 1977.  Suffice it to say that the PCG was
     undoubtedly pulling out every stop to get their own chief counsel
     into the committee and to build up the case for getting rid of
     Tanenbaum, Lehner, Donovan Gaye, and others who knew too much or
     who had the gall to go up against the agencies.
        The result of all this hard work by the PCG was the installation
     in July 1977 of Dr. Robert Blakey as chief counsel.  Tanenbaum
     resigned almost immediately, making Blakey's job a little easier,
     but Lehner and Gaye had to be fired by Blakey.  Many others were
     also weeded out.  We may never know exactly what they all knew or
     how they were forced out, because of the use of one of the PCG's
     cleverest techniques and one of the most insidious.
        Each committee staff member, each consultant and each committee
     member was required to sign, as a condition of continuing
     employment or membership on the committee, a nondisclosure
     agreement.  Now, nondisclosure agreements are nothing new,
     especially in classified situations or in sensitive or patent or
     copyright situations.  The committee's nondisclosure agreement was
     however, very unusual.  Many well-known attorneys have pronounced
     it illegal.  Richard A. Sprague saw it and said he would absolutely
     never have required the staff to sign anything like it.  He said it
     was illegal and unenforcable in several of its clauses.  The worst
     thing about it, or the best thing, from the viewpoint of the PCG,
     are the paragraphs giving control over the committee to the FBI and
     the CIA.[2]
        The committee, under Sprague, planned to investigate the FBI and
     the CIA in regard to both assassinations and the cover-ups.  In
     fact, Sprague had put both agencies on notice to that effect.
     Subpoenas were being prepared for access to all of their withheld
     information.  Investigations of the CIA's role in the Mexico City
     part of the assassination conspiracy, as well as Oswald's and
     Ruby's connections with both agencies were under way.
        The Blakey agreement automatically put a stop to all of that.
     Here is one excerpt from the agreement.
        "I (the staff member, committee member, or consultant) hereby
     agree never to divulge, publish or reveal by words, conduct or
     otherwise, . . . any information pertaining to intelligence sources
     or methods as designated by the Director of Central Intelligence,
     or any confidential information that is received by the Select
     Committee or that comes into my possession by virtue of my position
     with the Select Committee, to any person not a member of the Select
     Committee, or, after the Select Committee's termination, by such
     manner as the House of Representatives may determine or, in the
     absence of a determination by the House, in such manner as the
     Agency or Department from which the information originated may
     determine."
        In other words if the committee or an individual staff member,
     or a consultant discovered that the CIA or part of it, was involved
     in the assassination of John Kennedy, or that the FBI was in part
     or in whole responsible for the death of Martin Luther King, or
     that either agency was guilty of covering up the conspiracies in
     both cases, the CIA and the FBI would have the right to prevent
     these findings from being revealed to anyone outside the committee.
     Furthermore, those agencies are still in existence today while the
     Select Committee is not, so that the nondisclosure agreement which
     goes on in perpetuity, gives both the FBI and CIA continuing
     complete control over the individuals who signed it.
        Another excerpt reads as follows:
        "The Chairman of the Select Committee shall consult with the
     Director of Central Intelligence for the purpose of the Chairman's
     determination as to whether or not the material (any material
     obtained by the signer of the agreement) contains information that
     I pledge not to disclose."  If that sounds like Catch-22, it is.
     The interpretation that could be placed on that clause is that the
     CIA has the right to decide what evidence in the JFK and MLK
     assassinations should be withheld on grounds that the CIA itself
     determines.
        How could the committee possibly have investigated the CIA under
     those terms and conditions?  The answer is, they could not and did
     not.
        Can anyone doubt that the PCG prepared the agreement, implanted
     Blakey, and coerced or blackmailed or threatened the Chairman and
     the rest of the committee until they agreed to have everyone sign
     it!
        The most insidious part of the agreement is the clause that
     could be described as the threat, or blackmail clause.  It is
     perhaps this clause that has closed the mouths and pens of all the
     ex-staff members who knew what was going on, but who signed the
     agreement.  That clause reads as follows:
        "In addition to any rights for criminal prosecution or for
     injunctive relief the United Stated Government may have for
     violation of this agreement, the United States Government may file
     a civil suit in an appropriate court for damages as a consequence
     of a breach of this agreement.  The costs of any civil suit brought
     by the United States for breach of this agreement, including court
     costs, investigative expenses, and reasonable attorney fees, shall
     be borne by any defendant who loses such suit." . . . "I hereby
     agree that in any suit by the United States Government for
     injunctive or monetary relief pursuant to the terms of this
     agreement, personal jurisdiction shall obtain and venue shall lie
     in the United States District Court for the District of Columbia,
     or in any other appropriate United States District Court in which
     the United States may elect to bring suit.  I further agree that
     the law of the District of Columbia shall govern the interpretation
     and construction of this agreement."
        Those readers who have followed the performance of the U.S.
     courts in the JFK and MLK cases through the years, will recognize
     the trap in those last two sentences.  Any ex-staffer or
     consultant, or even a Congressman would have about as much chance
     against a CIA/FBI-directed suit in a court of their choice, as the
     man in the moon.  The United States Government, in this clause, is
     not your government or mine.  It is the Power Control Group.  You
     can bet they would select a court already programmed for decision.
     The clause is incredible on the face of it.
        This was a mighty powerful weapon and the committee used it to a
     maximum extent in carrying out a masterful job of continuing the
     two cover-ups.  It was masterful in the sense that they were not as
     bold and bald about it as the Warren Commission or the Rockefeller
     Commission or the Justice Department and the courts have been in
     the MLK case.  Their conclusions are inconclusive;  sort of.  They
     say that to determine whether or not there really were conspiracies
     in the two cases was beyond their means and the time they had
     available.  Nevertheless, the preponderant weight of the public
     testimony before the committee was toward no conspiracy in the JFK
     case and a, "Ray shot him, but might have been helped," conclusion
     in the King case.  But the hold they exercised over the staff and
     consultants in directing their investigations away from conspiracy
     was very smoothly done, with the nondisclosure agreement always
     lurking in the background as a possible threat.
        The agreement was used as an excuse by the committee to avoid
     answering questions.  For example, I wrote to Louis Stokes on April
     5, October 30, and November 24, 1978 asking why the committee had
     not called several important witnesses in the JFK case, including
     Richard Case Nagell.  Stokes had told me in a letter written on May
     15, 1978, that the suggestion that Nagell be called was being
     followed and that the staff was being alerted about him.  Blakey
     took no action and did not contact Nagell or Richard Russell, the
     only person who knew where Nagell was to be found.[3]
        Stokes sent me this reply to my inquiries about the witnesses on
     December 4,1978.

        "Dear Mr. Sprague:
        Thank you for your letter of November 24, 1978.  I am aware of
     the amount of time you have spent analyzing the assassination of
     President John F. Kennedy and your interest in the work of the
     Select Committee on Assassinations since its inception.  However, I
     regret that *under our Rules*, it is impossible for us to respond
     to your letter in a manner which would reveal the substance or
     procedure of our investigation, or the names of those persons who
     will be called to testify before the committee.  The committee is,
     of course, grateful for your suggestions and those of the many
     other concerned citizens who have taken the time to write."
     (Underlining for emphasis is the author's)
                                                  Sincerely,
                                                  Louis Stokes
                                                  Chairman

        "The Rules" Stokes refers to include the nondisclosure
     agreement.  This letter implies that subsequent to December 4,
     1978, the committee might be calling more JFK witnesses.  Of
     course, that didn't happen.  Except for some high level FBI, Secret
     Service and other government officials testifying about
     Presidential safety and future assassination investigations, the
     committee's show was already over, and Louis Stokes was well aware
     of that.  I'm sure Louis Stokes had his own personal reasons, not
     necessarily sinister, for making that reply.
        The committee had no intention of risking the appearance of any
     of the more knowledgeable or involved witnesses whose names I had
     given them in October 1978 as well as in May 1978 and November
     1978.  A list of these names appears later in this chapter.
        The Warren Commission proved how easy it is to avoid finding a
     conspiracy if you don't look for one, even one that seems to jump
     up and smack you in the face.  The Select Committee did this in
     spades.  The procedure was orchestrated by Robert Blakey by various
     means.  One of his methods was to split up the hard core Dealey
     Plaza evidence and investigations into sections.  He formed an
     advisory panel of outside "experts", for each section;  one on
     medical evidence, photographic evidence, ballistics evidence,
     trajectory evidence, etc.  Then he made sure there was almost no
     coordination, cross talk, or feedback among the panels or even
     among the staff members assigned to each section, except at his
     level.
        There was a great amount of internal complaining about this, but
     to no avail.  Again, the nondisclosure agreement worked wonders.
     An investigating team, in New Orleans and Dallas, headed by the JFK
     task force leader Cliff Fenton, was never allowed to surface either
     publicly or internally to other staff people or the committee.
     Their findings alone would have blown Dr. Blakey and his CIA/FBI
     friends right out of the water.  They spent a lot of time with Jim
     Garrison, and with many of the witnesses and the assassination
     participants described in Chapter 5 of this book.  The public does
     not even know who these staffers are, and undoubtedly will not hear
     or see what they discovered either in the committee's final report
     or in the public hearings.
        The separation of assignments worked wonders in explaining away
     much of the hard evidence of conspiracy.  Some of it during the
     public hearings was like watching a magic show, for knowledgeable
     researchers.  For example, the medical panel and staff members
     determined that the path of bullet 399 through JFK's body rear to
     front was slightly upward, given that he was sitting erect.  But
     since the medical panel and the photographic panel were never
     permitted coordination, the medical panel never realized that JFK
     was sitting erect at the time bullet 399 supposedly struck.
     Neither panel was allowed to communicate with the trajectory panel,
     so that their representative Thomas Canning testified that bullet
     399's trajectory backward from JFK's body, passed through the TSBD
     sixth floor window.  That erudite gentleman, a government employee
     from NASA, was forced to make up his own medical evidence, which he
     proceeded to do.  He merely moved the exit wound in JFK's throat
     down somewhat and the back of the neck wound up somewhat from where
     Dr. Baden of the medical panel had placed them.  He then tilted JFK
     forward at about 17 or 18 degrees based on his personal observation
     of one photograph, rather than on the photographic panel's
     conclusions.  Presto;  the trajectory tilted upward and leftward
     enough to pass through the sixth floor window.
        Another bit of magic was presented by Canning to support the
     single bullet theory.  He drew a straight line between governor
     Connally's back entry wound position and JFK's back entry wound
     position and found that the line also passed through the sixth
     floor window.  To do this he moved Connally on the seat to his left
     and JFK to his right, and lifted JFK up a bit on the rear seat.
     Again he did this without consultation with the photographic panel.
        Some hard evidence was not dealt with at all and other hard
     evidence of conspiracy was presented without identifying it as such
     and then just left dangling.  An example of the former is all of
     the photographic evidence cited earlier in this book and in my
     "Computers and Automation" magazine articles, showing that the
     sniper's nest was not a sniper's nest, that no one was in the
     window, and that no one could have fired shots from that position
     that day.  I showed pictures of the nest from the inside and the
     window from the outside to the JFK sub-committee in July 1977 and I
     reviewed them at length for their evidenciary value with the JFK
     staff, notably Ken Klein, Cliff Fenton, Bob Tanenbaum, Jackie Hess,
     Donovan Gaye, Pat Orr, Chellie Mason, and Richard A. Sprague.
        So the Committee cannot claim they didn't know about these
     photos.  They saw the Foley photo over a long period of time, and
     were no doubt quite embarrassed by the unexpected appearance of the
     Bronson film.  Not one word about the sixth floor window, the
     cartons, the planted shells, the planted rifle, and the extra rifle
     found on the roof, the impossible shot, no one in the window when
     the shots were fired;  not one word was mentioned in the public
     hearings about the photos and other evidence.  Where was the
     photographic panel?  Asleep?  Frightened by the agreement they
     signed?
        An example of evidence of conspiracy left dangling was the
     testimony given by the photographic panel spokesman, Calvin S.
     McCamy.  The panel examined all of the photos of JFK during the
     early part of the shot sequence, and took a vote on when the first
     shot struck the President.  It came out as around Z189 to Z196.
     Perfect.  That matches.  But no one asked the trajectory panel or
     the ballistics spokesman how Oswald was able to fire bullet 399
     right through the center of that big oak tree at Z189-Z196.  Not
     even the Warren Commission would make that claim, preferring to put
     the timing at Z210 or later after JFK came out from behind the
     tree.
        There were some anxious moments for the Select Committee, even
     as well orchestrated as the whole farce was.  Dr. Cyril Wecht was
     his usual grand self.  He blasted the committee.  They said he was
     part of the medical panel and therefore was asked to present a
     minority view.  Cyril said they weren't planning to call him until
     he demanded to be allowed to testify.  They tried to bamboozle him,
     to discredit him (a tough assignment), to attack him and to knock
     down his testimony.  Lawyer Gary Cornwell was particularly
     obnoxious in his questioning of Dr. Wecht.  Favorable witnesses
     testifying to no conspiracy were handled with kid gloves and
     treated politely or dragged through an obviously rehearsed series
     of questions.  It was the Warren Commission revisited.  Two
     witnesses they couldn't mistreat were Governor and Mrs. Connally.
     They politely and calmly presented believable testimony destroying
     the single bullet theory.  That didn't bother the committee any
     more than it bothered the Warren Commission.  They resurrected the
     theory a few days later when the trajectory panel testified.
        Dr. Barger of Bolt Baranek & Newman shook them up a little with
     his acoustical analysis of the police radio tape that reveals the
     sounds of four, not three, shots.  If Dr. Barger had been given all
     of the facts initially, he probably could have helped prove where
     the shots came from.  Except for the grassy knoll position behind
     the fence and the sixth floor TSBD window, he was not told about
     any other possible firing points.  For example, he knew nothing
     about the Dal Tex building, the west end roof or high floor of the
     TSBD, or other positions on the grassy knoll.  In fact, Barger did
     not know the location of the motorcycle where the microphone had
     been left open, picking up the sound of the shots.  His assignment
     included a determination of where the motorcycle was, from the
     sounds on the tape and sounds made during a re-enactment of the
     firing in Dealey Plaza.  The only test shots Barger had fired were
     from the TSBD sixth floor window and from behind the grassy knoll
     fence.  The net result was that he decided the motorcycle was
     trailing the Presidential limousine by 120 feet.  No one on the
     committee or the photographic panel ever showed Barger the Altgens
     photo, the Hughes film, the Martin, Nix, Couch, Weigman, Bell or
     Muchmore films or any other pictures showing there was no
     motorcycle anywhere near 120 feet behind the limousine.[4]  Again,
     Blakey divided and conquered.  Barger told me that if he had known
     about the motorcycle trailing the limousine by a few feet, driven
     by policeman D.L. Jackson, who disappeared completely after the
     assassination, he could have altered his analysis completely.  The
     sounds of the last two shots may well have been from the knoll
     behind the wall, and from the TSBD roof or the Dal Tex second
     floor.  Barger's analysis shows that the last shot sound, made by a
     rifle occurred just a faction of a second after the next to the
     last shot, possibly made by pistol.  This would fit a pistol shot
     from behind the fence fired almost simultaneously with a rifle shot
     from either the TSBD west end or Dal Tex.  The delay of the sound
     traveling from Dal Tex is about right so that the Dal Tex shot
     would strike at Z312 and the pistol or rifle shot from the right
     front would strike at Z313.  Prof. Mark Weiss of Queens College and
     Barger were called into an executive session on December 20 after
     the hearings were finished.  They testified that there were
     definitely four shots fired, at least one of which was from the
     knoll.
        This new analysis was conducted by Weiss independently from the
     one done by Bolt Baranek and Newman.  Weiss said that his work
     proved to a 95% certainty that the third shot was a rifle shot from
     a position on the knoll.  He said the data pinpointed the position
     to within two feet.  The position was behind the fence, which
     eliminates man number two at the corner of the wall and also
     eliminates a pistol.  However, the photos show man number two did
     make a puff of smoke, whether or not he fired a shot.
        Congressman Sawyer broke the news about Weiss' testimony during
     a radio broadcast in Michigan, his home state.  A furor broke
     loose.  The committee went into an executive session Friday
     December 22 to discuss what to do since there were only nine days
     left to the end of their existence.  The radio tape and the Bronson
     film seemed to shake them up considerably.  Or was it all rehearsed
     and planned this way by the committee.  It seems incredible that
     the 12 members of the committee would be shaken by the sounds from
     a tape when they weren't bothered at all by photos of the Oswald
     window showing that no one was there when the shots were fired.
     The committee members could see those photos with their own eyes.
     They had to take the word of experts about the sounds on the tape,
     which cannot be heard because of the noise of the engine of the
     policeman's cycle where the microphone was stuck open.[4]  This was
     the most blatantly dishonest stunt pulled by the Committee during
     the Blakey period.  Yet, the research community cannot complain too
     much because it did produce a conspiracy conclusion.
        The committee's distortions and omission respecting the hard
     Dealey Plaza evidence is overshadowed by the key witnesses that the
     committee did not call.  None of the players listed in Chapter 5
     were called, nor ever mentioned.  One key witness, James Hosty,
     insisted that he testify about Oswald's FBI involvement, but was
     turned down.  Hosty told the "Dallas Morning News," "They don't
     want to hear what I have to say."
        He might have told them the same story he told the author,
     through an intermediary in 1971.  Namely, that Oswald was reporting
     to Hosty on the assassination plans of the CIA group based in
     Mexico City.  FBI agent witness, Regis Kennedy might have given
     private interview evidence, but he was killed the day before he was
     to meet with the committee.
        Gordon Novel, Ronald Augustinovich, Richard Case Nagell, Mary
     Hope, Guy Gabaldin, Manuel Garcia Gonzalez, William Seymour, Emilio
     Santana, Victor Marchetti, Jack Lawrence, Major L.M. Bloomfield,
     Frenchy, Sergio Arcacha Smith, Harry Williams, James Hicks, Sylvia
     Odio, Jim Braden, James Hosty, Warren Du Brueys, Louis Ivon, E.
     Howard Hunt and Jim Garrison were not called and no interest was
     shown in having them as witnesses.  Some key witnesses who were
     called were not asked any important questions, or cross examined at
     all.  Marina Oswald Porter was one of these.  Another was Gerald
     Ford.  Richard Helms told his standard lies, and no one asked him
     about Victor Marchetti's statement about Helms protecting Clay
     Shaw, or about E. Howard Hunt and Guy Gabaldin in Mexico City in
     October, 1963, or about Harry William's statement that he, Helms,
     Hunt, and Lyman Kirkpatrick were reconsidering another Cuban
     invasion at the moment JFK was shot, in a Washington, D.C., CIA
     location.
        With respect to the assassination of Dr. King, the committee
     also performed admirably for the PCG, in this case, the FBI wing.
     They failed to deal with the important evidence of conspiracy,
     failed to call the prime witnesses, and distorted or omitted
     evidence.  They spent a great amount of time trying to prove,
     rather unsuccessfully except for media accounts, that James Earl
     Ray was guilty and that he had help from his family and was
     possibly financed by some wealthy sountherners.
        Briefly, here is the evidence they did not cover.  The witnesses
     who saw a man in the rooming house--all of whom said it was not
     James Earl Ray--were not called.  Charles Stephens, who was bribed
     and coerced by the FBI into identifying the man as Ray, but who was
     dead drunk, and saw nothing, was not put on the stand with his
     common law wife Grace and a cab driver who saw how drunk he was.
     Confronting his testimony by cross examination and by using counter
     witnesses should have been done.
        The three bar maids in Montreal and Atlanta who saw Ray and
     Raoul together were not called.  William Bradford Huie found them
     and Ray knew where they were.  The committee didn't look for them.
     Huie and Foreman were not put on the stand and asked all of the key
     questions about why Huie changed his entire approach toward Ray as
     soon as I showed him the Raoul-Frenchy photos.  Foreman's role was
     never explored under fierce cross examination as it would be if
     Mark Lane were able to get a new trial for Ray.  He should have
     been asked why he told Ray he got the Frenchy photos from the FBI
     when he actually got them from me!
        The Frenchy-Raoul sketch comparison, made by Bill Turner and I
     in the summer of 1968, should have been produced and shown to
     Foreman, Huie, Ray and other witnesses.
        The complete list of witnesses who saw Ray and Raoul together,
     as well as the complete list who saw Ray at the gasoline station a
     few blocks away from the crime at the time the shot was fired, were
     not called.  The committee adopted the stance that it was up to
     Mark Lane and Ray to produce those witnesses, as though the
     investigation of the King killing was a trial instead.  The
     committee, not Ray, had the responsibility of investigating and
     locating those witnesses.  Bob Lehner wanted to do that, but he was
     fired.
        The evidence about the rooming house bathroom window as an
     impossible firing point, presented so well in Harold Weisberg's
     book "Frame-Up:  The Martin Luther King/James Earl Ray Case," was
     either ignored or distorted.  The evidence about the trajectory of
     the shot was completely distorted.  The ballistics, medical and
     trajectory panels discussed the vertical angle of difference
     between the "grassy knoll" firing point and bathroom window firing
     point trajectories to the Lorraine Motel balcony.  They stated that
     the differential angle between the two trajectories was too small
     to determine, from the medical evidence, whether the shot came from
     the window or the knoll.
        But, they failed to discuss the horizontal differential angle
     between the two trajectories which was much larger, large enough to
     determine the firing point.
        They also failed to present a number of witnesses who saw the
     actual assassin, Jack Youngblood, both before and after he fired
     from the knoll.  Wayne Chastain should also have been called to
     testify about this evidence and those witnesses.
        The evidence concerning who Jack Youngblood and Frenchy-Raoul
     worked for, and their involvement, was not dealt with at all.  The
     committee should have presented the photographic evidence showing
     Raoul was Frenchy, and should have asked Ray and the witnesses who
     saw Raoul to identify him from the Frenchy photos.  Jeff Paley
     actually showed Frenchy's photo to witnesses in 1968 while Raoul's
     face was still fresh in their minds.  They recognized the face.
     They certainly should have since the sketch of Raoul was made from
     their recollections.  They should have called Frenchy as a witness
     in both JFK & MLK cases.  I know from an inside source on the
     committee that they found Frenchy alive in 1978.  They certainly
     knew about Jack Youngblood because they read Wayne Chastain's
     series of articles in "Computers and People."
        In summary, the Select Committee performed reasonably well on
     behalf of the PCG.  There are no public outcrys over what they did
     because the media wouldn't air them.  Mark Lane held a number of
     press conferences during the committee's life span, and no media
     organization reported on any of them.  The media, of course, were
     quite willing servants of the PCG, as they always have been since
     1963.  The combination of the PCG, the CIA, the FBI, the Select
     Committee, the House spokesmen for the PCG and the cooperative
     media is really nearly unbeatable.
        Some researchers hoped against hope that the Select Committee,
     under Stokes, Blakey, Preyer and Fauntroy, would still unveil the
     truth, as the public hearings began in August.  The hopes
     disappeared during the first week of hearings on the King case as
     the committee demonstrated quite clearly that they were going to
     continue the cover-ups and to get James Earl Ray and Mark Lane in
     the bargain.  Still, the hopes would not quite die.  The letters I
     wrote to Louis Stokes in the fall of 1978, expressed the last ditch
     thought that maybe they were conducting a charade designed to fool
     the FBI, CIA and the rest of the PCG into believing they were going
     to cover-up the truth.  It turned out be for real, no charade.
        The eight people assassinated by the PCG in 1977-78 during the
     Select Committee's life span are probably the best proof of who is
     in charge of the U.S. and what their intentions are.  The murders
     are all part of the cover-up efforts and were all successfully
     carried out, a la The Parallax View, with very few suspicions
     raised on the part of the American media or the public.  They
     included William Sullivan, Regis Kennedy, George de Mohrenschildt,
     Sam Giancana,[5] John Roselli, Carlos Prio Socarras, Thomas
     Karamessines, Rolando Masferrer, and an attempt on the life of
     Larry Flynt.
        Each of these murders was carried out with great success and for
     varying reasons.  One common thread connects them all.  Each man
     knew too much about the assassinations of President Kennedy or
     Martin Luther King and the subsequent cover-up conspiracies.  All
     but Flynt were witnesses to be called by the Select Committee or
     ones that had given some information and were scheduled to give
     more.  Of the nine people including Flynt, the two most important
     were William Sullivan and Regis Kennedy.
        Regis Kennedy was one of two FBI agents in New Orleans assigned
     as contact men for Lee Harvey Oswald in his role as FBI informer.
     The other agent was Warren du Brueys.  James Hosty was his contact
     agent in Dallas.  Kennedy knew a lot, but was under strict orders
     from the FBI not to reveal any of it.  He was called as a witness
     at the trial of Clay Shaw and asked by Jim Garrison whether he
     hadn't been searching for Clay Shaw under the name Clay Bertrand,
     before it was known that Clay Bertrand wanted to hire a lawyer for
     Lee Harvey Oswald.  Kennedy took executive privilege, a popular
     dodge at that time with the Nixon administration.  When the judge
     pressed him, he said he would have to check with the FBI and the
     attorney general, John Mitchell, in Washington, D.C.  Word came
     through that he could answer that one question, so he said yes it
     was true.  He went no further however.  The significance is that
     the FBI knew all about Clay Shaw's involvement in the assassination
     because Oswald was reporting back to them as a paid infiltrator of
     Shaw's team.  There is a distinct possibility that Kennedy was sent
     by Hoover and Sullivan to Dallas immediately after the
     assassination, to help coordinate the FBI/CIA cover-up.  Beverly
     Oliver, the Babushka lady, whose film was confiscated by three
     government agents on Sunday November 24, 1963 at the Carousel Club
     owned by Jack Ruby, made a tentative identification of Regis
     Kennedy from his photograph as one of those three agents.  The film
     has never surfaced.  It should show the assassins on the grassy
     knoll quite clearly since Beverly was much closer than either
     Orville Nix or Marie Muchmore and had her camera trained on JFK all
     the way down Elm Street.
        Kennedy died of a supposed heart attack the day before he was to
     meet with the Select Committee staff.  Heart attacks, as most
     Americans know by now from watching the Church Committee hearings,
     and seeing the Parallax View, are easily induced by a CIA-developed
     pill, which leaves no trace in the autopsy, if there is one.
        William Sullivan was eliminated by a clever, but simple
     technique.  The PCG agents who killed him knew about his hunting
     haunts in New England.  They also knew about a teenage son of a
     state policeman living near Sullivan's country place who liked to
     hunt in the same area.  Two of them intercepted Sullivan early one
     morning as he set out for a walk in the woods.  They shot him with
     a deer rifle and took his body to a spot in the woods where they
     knew the boy would be.  They carried a decoy inflated to the shape
     resembling a deer and probably acted like one.  The boy shot at him
     and thought he hit a deer.  The agents dropped Sullivan's body at
     that spot and left.  They accidentally left the pair of gloves one
     of them was wearing.  The boy went over to the spot in the early
     morning semi-darkness, found Sullivan's body, and thought he had
     killed him by mistake.  He still thinks so.  There was no
     investigation and no questions asked.
        Why was Sullivan killed?  As mentioned before, William Sullivan
     was J. Edgar Hoovers' right hand man in charge of Division Five,
     the FBI's clandestine domestic operation that included an
     assassination squad.  Every likelihood exists that Hoover ordered
     Sullivan's division to kill King and that Sullivan used
     Frenchy/Raoul and Jack Youngblood to do the job.  Sullivan was also
     due to meet with the Select Committee within a day or two after the
     day he was shot.  Whether he would have talked or not probably
     makes little difference.  The PCG couldn't take the chance.
        Thomas Karamessines died of an apparent heart attack at the age
     of 61 on September 4, 1978 at his vacation home in Grand Lake,
     Quebec.  He headed the covert operations part of the CIA after
     Richard Helms was promoted from that position to head of the CIA.
     David Phillips, the CIA dirty tricks operative who is making public
     speeches supporting the Deputy Director of Plans (dirty tricks)
     function, worked for Karamessines.  His knowledge of the JFK
     assassination and the CIA's cover-up role was undoubtedly complete
     since he inherited the whole thing from Helms.
        The other dead people were bumped off figuratively, on the very
     doorstep of the committee.  Roselli was killed and dumped into
     Miami Bay.  Giancana was shot full of holes in his Chicago
     residence.  De Mohrenschildt was shot with a shotgun in his
     daughter's friends house in Florida.  All three were scheduled to
     meet with the committee.  Socarras was killed in a garage in
     Florida.  Masferrer was blown up in his car in Florida.  Flynt was
     shot on the street in Georgia.
        Florida.  Why does it keep popping up in these cases?  Bay of
     Pigs, No Name Key Group, anti-Castro forces, Mafia operations;  it
     all fits together somehow.  Jim Garrison's first real breakthrough
     came when he found Masferrer in Florida through Manuel Garcia
     Gonzalez.  That led him and the District Attorney in Dade County,
     Florida, to William Seymour, Emilio Santana, Howard, Hall, Hemming
     and Frenchy, all part of Socarras' and Banister's Florida-based, No
     Name Key anti-Castro operations.  It figured that some of them
     would die in their own backyard when the committee was getting too
     close.  Gaeton Fonzi can personally vouch for that.  He was the
     committee's Florida investigator.
        Why wouldn't men like Fonzi, Fenton, Fauntroy, Stokes, Preyer,
     and a woman like Yvonne Burke, tell us the truth.  I spent a lot of
     time with all of them and got to know some of them very well.  They
     all impressed me as being very honest and dedicated people.
        There may be another explanation, as I mentioned in the
     beginning of this last chapter.  A committee, is, after all, made
     up of a bunch of individuals.  So is a staff.  Now, except for
     Cliff Fenton, Ed Evans (MLK investigator) and one or two others,
     these people were not professionals in the investigations and
     certainly none of them had been involved in the really big game of
     espionage and clandestine operations.  They were, and still are,
     ordinary mortals, like you and me, with fears and cautionary
     attitudes toward personal safety and danger.  They also have
     families.
        Not even Cliff Fenton had ever been involved with the kind of
     monstrous game played by the spooks of the world.  It is a game for
     keeps, of life and death, mostly death.  Let's look at it from the
     viewpoint of Louis Stokes, just to take an example.  He took over
     the chairmanship of the committee with the following knowledge.
        He suspected there was a conspiracy in the JFK case and at least
     wanted to find out whether the CIA and FBI were involved in
     covering it up.  He may not have known all of the details, but he
     was aware of the fact that many people had died.  He knew that
     Henry Gonzalez had nearly been killed by a rifleman while driving
     through a Texas desert with his wife.  This occurred just after
     Henry made public statements about all four political
     assassinations being related and the intelligence agencies possibly
     being involved.  Stokes saw how the PCG swung their weight around
     in the Rules Committee and on the floor of the House when the
     Select Committee in January and February 1977, asked for a new
     budget and a reconstituted authority to subpoena records and
     continue the investigation.  He also knew that something strange
     had happened to Henry Gonzalez.  He told me so in a luncheon
     meeting on May 10, 1977.  He said Henry had cut off all
     communications with him and other committee members just as he had
     with me.  I told Louis that I believed Henry had purposefully been
     fed information by the PCG that I, Richard A. Sprague, and some of
     the committee members were working for the CIA.  Otherwise, why
     would he have instructed the CIA and FBI to close access to their
     files to the committee staff, just after he had won the fight he
     fought so hard to get the subpoena power back.
        Stokes agreed it must have been something like that.  Stokes
     also must have had a frightened reaction during 1977 and 1978 to
     these eight bodies dumped on his doorstep.  As in the scene in "The
     Godfather", it only takes one horse's head in your bed to get the
     idea you should keep your mouth closed and play it cool.
        Given all of this, each committee member may have reached his or
     her decision that this game was not for congressmen.  In April 1977
     it is possible that all of those executive sessions the committee
     held were partially devoted to a discussion of the personal safety
     of each member, each staffer, and all of their families.  They may
     have reached unanimous agreement that the only safe approach would
     be to avoid sensitive areas, and not to attack the CIA or FBI, and
     certainly to avoid going after any of the dangerous guys in both
     assassination cases.
        Yet, to keep an honest approach going they would have to listen
     to any credible hard evidence of conspiracy, comment on it, but
     refrain from taking a stronger course than just listening.  As Dr.
     Blakey told me more than once, "I'm just going to let the facts
     speak for themselves."  This is somewhat like the position the
     Warren Commission took when Richard Russell, Hale Boggs and John
     Sherman Cooper refused to sign the draft of the Warren Report until
     a qualifying statement was inserted.  The statement read, "Because
     of the difficulty of proving negatives to a certainty the
     possibility of others being involved with either Oswald or Ruby
     cannot be established categorically but if there is any such
     evidence it has been beyond the reach of all the investigative
     agencies and resources of the United States and has not come to the
     attention of this Commission."
        The committee has, in its final report, taken a stronger
     position than that by saying, in effect, that new evidence of
     conspiracy has surfaced and that the Congress should turn the job
     of pursuing that evidence and a continuing investigation over to
     the executive branch.  The recommendation is for the Justice
     Department to determine whether further investigations are
     warranted.  Thus the Committee members would be off the hook and,
     more importantly, still alive and safe.  They can claim that the
     funds they had and the time they had were not enough.  Whose fault
     was that?  Certainly not the committee's, they can claim.
        This scenario, if true, is really the only hope, though very
     slim, any of us have left.  All other avenues have been closed.



____________________

[1] "New York Daily News" -- Tuesday, December 12, 1979.


[2] See the letters in the Appendix for a copy of the nondisclosure
   agreement itself as well as correspondence between the author
   and Louis Stokes.

[3] See copies of this correspondence in the Appendix.

[4] Following the December 22 executive session a public hearing was
   held on December 29, the last weekday of the Committee's
   existence.  Weiss and Barger presented the acoustical evidence
   proving four shots, one from the knoll, thereby causing the
   Committee to conclude there was a probable conspiracy.
     But, the fact that the Couch and Weigman films prove the
   acoustical analysis was incorrect because there is no motorcycle
   where there was supposed to be one, was completely covered-up by
   the Committee staff.  Why?  The answer obviously is that the
   Committee wanted to close shop with a conspiracy conclusion but
   one that wouldn't shake up the intelligence community and the PCG
   too much.  If the correct acoustical analysis had been presented,
   with the motorcycle directly behind the presidential limousine,
   the net result would have been the elimination of that 6th floor
   window as the source of the shots.  Eliminate that window and you
   eliminate Oswald and open up a can of worms with a completely
   different kind of conspiracy.  One with a patsy and intelligence
   ramifications, written all over it.
     So Cornwell and Blakey, and perhaps the entire Committee decided
   to prove by implication that the motorcycle was 120 feet behind
   the JFK car at the time of the shot from the knoll.  They showed
   publicly frames from the Hughes film which shows the motorcycle
   they fudged, somewhat more than 120 feet behind the limousine.
   But the Hughes film ends with the cycle on Houston Street.  The
   cycle can be seen in the Hughes film trailing Couch's camera car.
   Couch took film all the way down Houston and around the turn onto
   Elm Street.  The limo can be seen in all of this footage.  The
   cycle can not.  The cycle finally catches up to Couch and passes
   him after the limo is beyond the triple overpass.  Couch is, at
   all times including the time of the knoll shot, more than 200 feet
   behind the limousine.  Ergo, the cycle is more than 200 feet
   behind at the critical point.
     Cornwell presented the cop driving the Houston Street cycle and
   attempted to elicit testimony from him that it was his microphone
   that was open.

[5] Giancana actually died in 1975 before testifying to the Schweicker
   JFK assassination subcommittee of the Church Committee.






                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *


--
                                             daveus rattus

                                   yer friendly neighborhood ratman

                               KOYAANISQATSI

   ko.yaa.nis.qatsi (from the Hopi Language)  n.  1. crazy life.  2. life
       in turmoil.  3. life out of balance.  4. life disintegrating.
         5. a state of life that calls for another way of living.
From [email protected] Thu Jun 18 09:38:16 1992
Received: by icaen.uiowa.edu ( 5.52 (84)/1.1) id AA10172
       on Thu, 18 Jun 92 09:38:11 CDT.
Received: from pl122c.eecs.lehigh.edu by ns-mx.uiowa.edu (5.64.jnf/920408)
         on Thu, 18 Jun 92 09:39:52 -0500 id AA04694 with SMTP
Received: from SGI.COM by PL122c.EECS.Lehigh.EDU (5.61/1.34)
       id AA04846; Thu, 18 Jun 92 10:25:52 -0400
Received: from [192.102.132.11] by sgi.sgi.com via SMTP (911016.SGI/910110.SGI)
       for [email protected] id AA23140; Thu, 18 Jun 92 07:28:19 -0700
Received: by ratmandu.esd.sgi.com (920110.SGI/920502.SGI.AUTO)
       for @sgi.sgi.com:[email protected] id AA10904; Thu, 18 Jun 92 07:28:15 -0700
Date: Thu, 18 Jun 92 07:28:15 -0700
From: [email protected] (dave "who can do? ratmandu!" ratcliffe)
Message-Id: <[email protected]>
To: [email protected]
Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (10/11)
Status: RO


Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (10/11)
Summary: we were robbed of our capability of electing a president we wanted
Keywords:  part 10 of 11:  chapter 17
Lines: 769


                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *



                   1985:  The House Select Committee (2)


                                Chapter 17
                THE FINAL COVER UP:  How The CIA Controlled
               The House Select Committee On Assassinations


                               Introduction

        The final report of the House Select Committee on Assassinations
     (HSCA), issued in 1979, concluded that a conspiracy existed in the
     assassination of President Kennedy.  This news should have
     delighted hundreds of researchers who had disagreed with the no-
     conspiracy finding of the Warren Commission.  The fact that it did
     not, is due to the HSCA conspiracy being a simple one, with Lee
     Harvey Oswald still firing all but one of the shots from the sixth
     floor window of the Texas School Book Depository Building.  The
     existence of another shooter and another shot, from the grassy
     knoll, was "proved" by the HSCA, based primarily on acoustical
     evidence presented in the very last month of their public hearings.
     Dr. Robert Blakey and Richard Billings, chief counsel and report
     editor for the HSCA, co-authored, in 1981, a book, "The Plot to
     Kill the President," following the publication of the HSCA's final
     report.  The book claimed that the other shooter and Oswald were
     part of a Mafia plot to kill JFK.
        To over simplify the current (1985) situation, most JFK
     researchers feel that the American public had been deceived once
     again.  The HSCA reaffirmed all but one of the Warren Commission's
     findings, including even the famed single bullet theory.  The
     simplified conspiracy finding is now subject to review by the
     Justice Department and the FBI because it is based on very
     questionable acoustical evidence.  Justice commissioned the so-
     called Ramsey Panel[1] to review this evidence, in 1981, under the
     auspices of the National Academy of Sciences.  It found no evidence
     from the acoustics that a grassy knoll shot was fired.  So, we are
     back to no-conspiracy and Oswald being the lone assassin.  And even
     if there was a conspiracy, Blakey claims it involved the Mafia and
     not the CIA.  The HSCA report and all of its volumes of evidence
     omitting any reference to CIA involvement, concluded that the CIA
     was not involved, and did not reveal any evidence that the HSCA
     staff had collected showing that CIA people murdered JFK, and that
     the CIA has been covering up that fact ever since.
        Any followers of CIA activities connected with the JFK
     assassination, since 1963, must ask the question, how did they do
     it?  How did the CIA turn things completely around from the 1976
     days when Henry Gonzalez, Thomas Downing, Richard A. Sprague,
     Robert Tanenbaum, Cliff Fenton and others were pursuing the truth
     about the assassination, to essentially the same status as when the
     Warren Commission finished its work?  How did they produce the
     final cover-up?  The answer is that the CIA controlled the HSCA and
     its investigation and findings from the early part of 1977,
     forward.  The methods they used were as clever and devious as any
     they had used previously to control the Warren Commission, the
     Rockefeller Commission, the Garrison Investigation, the
     Schweiker/Hart Committee[2] and the efforts of independent
     researchers.


                          The Situation in 1976

        In 1976, Henry Gonzalez, member of the House from Texas, and
     Thomas Downing from Virginia, were both convinced there was a
     massive conspiracy in the JFK assassination.  They introduced a
     joint bill in the House which resulted in the formation of the HSCA
     and an investigation of the JFK and King assassinations.  Gonzalez
     believed there were at least four conspiracies in the
     assassinations of JFK, MLK, Robert Kennedy and in the attempted
     assassination of George Wallace.  He introduced an original bill to
     have the House investigate all four and the cover-ups and links
     among them.  Downing was primarily interested in the JFK case and
     his original bill dealt only with that conspiracy.  Mark Lane and
     his committee members and supporters around the country joined
     forces with Coretta King and the Black Caucus in the House to
     pressure Congressmen and Tip O'Neill to investigate the King and
     John Kennedy assassinations.  The net result was a merging of the
     Gonzalez and Downing bills into a Final HSCA bill dealing with only
     two of the cases.
        In the fall of 1976, with Downing as chairman, the HSCA selected
     Richard A. Sprague, from the Philadelphia District Attorney's
     office, to be chief counsel.  Sprague hired four professional
     investigators and criminal lawyers from New York City.  They were
     very good and completely independent of the CIA and FBI, having
     been trained by one of the best professionals in the business, D.A.
     Frank Hogan of New York.
        Sprague and his JFK team, headed by Bob Tanenbaum, attorney, and
     Cliff Fenton, chief detective, were going after the real assassins
     and their bosses, whether this led them to the CIA or FBI or
     anywhere else.  Sprague had already made it clear to the HSCA that
     he would investigate CIA involvement, and subpoena CIA people,
     documents and other information, whether classified or not.  He had
     also had meetings with several researchers, including the author,
     and made it known privately that he was going to use the talent and
     knowledge of every reliable researcher on a consulting basis.  He
     had contacted Jim Garrison in New Orleans and informed him he would
     be following up on all of his information and leads.  He had
     initiated an investigation of the CIA activities in Mexico City
     connected with the JFK assassination, including information
     supplied to Sprague by the author.[3]
        R.A. Sprague and Tanenbaum were aware of the CIA connections of
     the individuals involved in the JFK assassination in Dealey Plaza,
     in Mexico City, in New Orleans and in the Florida Keys.  They had,
     in November 1976, exposed the entire HSCA staff to all of the
     photographic evidence showing these people in Dealey Plaza and
     elsewhere.  They were aware of the assassination planning meetings
     held by CIA people in Mexico City and knew who the higher level
     conspirators were.  They had initiated searches for the real
     assassins;  Frenchy, William Seymour, Emilio Santana, Jack
     Lawrence, Fred Lee Crisman, Jim Braden, Jim Hicks, et al.  They
     were planning to interview CIA contract agents, Richard Case
     Nagell, Harry Dean, Gordon Novel, Ronald Augustinovich, Mary Hope
     and Guy Gabaldin.  Cliff Fenton had been appointed head of a team
     of investigators to follow up on the New Orleans part of the
     conspiracy which had included CIA agents and people;  Clay Shaw,
     David Ferrie, Guy Banister, Manuel Garcia Gonzalez, Sergio Arcacha
     Smith, Gordon Novel and others.  They were going to contact people
     who had attended assassination planning meetings in New Orleans.
        From the photographic evidence surrounding the sixth floor
     window, as well as the grassy knoll, Sprague, Tanenbaum and most of
     the staff knew Oswald had not fired any shots, knew no shots came
     from the sixth floor window, and knew there had been shots from the
     Dal Tex Building and the knoll.  They knew the single bullet theory
     was not true, and knew there had been a well-planned crossfire in
     Dealey Plaza.  They were not planning to waste a lot of time
     reviewing and rehashing the Dealey Plaza evidence, except as it
     might lead to the real assassins.
        They had set up an investigation in Florida and the Keys, of the
     evidence and leads developed in 1967 by Garrison.  Gaeton Fonzi was
     in charge of that part of Sprague's team.  They were going to check
     out the people in the CIA that had been running and funding the No
     Name Key group and other Anti-Castro groups.  Seymour, Santana,
     Manuel Garcia Gonzalez, Jerry Patrick Hemming, Loran Hall, Lawrence
     Howard, Frenchy and Cubans Rolando Masferrer and Carlos Prio
     Socarras were to be found and interrogated.
        Tanenbaum and his research team had seen the photo collection of
     Dick Billings from "Life Magazine" which was, by 1976, deposited in
     the Georgetown University Library's JFK assassination collection.
     The No Name Key people and others showing up in Garrison's
     investigation appeared in these photos with high level CIA agents.
        In 1977, Henry Gonzalez, who was far more supportive of a CIA
     conspiracy idea than Tom Downing, was to become chairman of the
     HSCA.  Downing did not run for re-election in 1976 and was
     retiring.  At that point, December 1976, Gonzalez and Sprague were
     of the same mind and getting along fine.  Researchers were very
     pleased with the way things were going and believed Sprague would
     expose the CIA's involvement in the JFK cover up.


                            The CIA's problem

        Given this background of the HSCA status in late 1976, it can
     easily be seen that the CIA was up against much more serious
     opposition than it ever had been before in the JFK murder and
     cover-up.  They had ruined Jim Garrison's reputation and curtailed
     his investigation by various dirty trick means.  They had been in
     solid control of the Warren Commission by the simple expedient of
     having four of the Commissioners belonging to them;  Dulles, Ford,
     McCloy and Russell.  They were also able to kill enough people who
     knew the truth, to slow down any truth-seeking that might have
     taken place.  They also hid documents, destroyed and altered
     evidence, lied about other evidence, and bald facedly (Dulles)
     admitted that they wouldn't tell the President or the Commission if
     Lee Harvey Oswald had been a CIA agent (which he had been).  In the
     Rockefeller Commission situation they were in complete control of
     that attempt to reinforce the Warren Commission's findings.  And in
     the Church Committee investigation, the Schweiker/Hart subcommittee
     on the JFK case was very limited and controlled in what they could
     do.
        But in the new situation, in Richard A. Sprague and his
     professionals with so much knowledge of the CIA's role in the
     murder and the cover-up, they faced a crisis.  They knew they had
     to do several things to turn it around and to continue to keep the
     American public from realizing what was happening.  Here is what
     they had to do:


         1.  Get rid of Richard A. Sprague.

         2.  Get rid of Henry Gonzalez.

         3.  Get rid of Sprague's key men or keep them away from CIA
             evidence or keep them quiet.

         4.  Install their own chief counsel to control the
             investigation.

         5.  Elect a new HSCA chairman who would go along, or who
             could be fooled.

         6.  Cut off all Sprague's investigations of CIA people.
             Make sure none of the people were found or bury any
             testimony that had already been found, or murder CIA
             people who might talk.

         7.  Keep the committee members from knowing what was
             happening and segregate the investigation from them.

         8.  Create a new investigative environment whose purpose
             would be to confirm all of the findings of the Warren
             Commission and divert attention away from the who-did-
             it-and-why approach.

         9.  Control the committee staff in such a way as to keep
             any of them from revealing what they already knew about
             CIA involvement.

        10.  Control committee consultants in the same way, and
             staff members who might leave or who might be fired.

        11.  Continue to control the media in such a way as to
             reinforce all of the above.

        12.  Continue to murder witnesses or assassins in emergency
             situations if necessary.

        The CIA successfully did all twelve of these things.  The
     techniques they used were much more subtle and devious than those
     they had used before, although they did continue with murders of
     potential HSCA witnesses and with media control.


                           How The CIA Did It

        The first step taken by the CIA was to use the media they
     control, along with some members of Congress they control, and two
     planted agents on the staff of and consulting for, Henry Gonzalez,
     to get rid of both Henry and Richard A. Sprague.  In taking this
     step, they used the old Roman approach of divide and conquer.  They
     made Gonzalez and his closest staff assistant, Gail Beagle, believe
     that Sprague was a CIA agent and that Gonzalez must get rid of him.
     They also made Gonzalez believe that some of his other associates,
     both in the HSCA and outside, were CIA agents.  At the same time,
     they used the media to attack Sprague mercilessly.  The key people
     in doing this attack on Sprague were three CIA reporters, George
     Lardner of the "Washington Post," Mr. Burnham of "The New York
     Times," and Jeremiah O'Leary of the "Washington Star."  In all HSCA
     committee meetings and in Rules Committee and Finance Committee
     meetings, these three reporters sat next to each other, passed
     notes back and forth, and wrote articles continually attacking and
     undermining both Sprague and Gonzalez, as well as the entire
     committee.  The CIA had the support of top management in all three
     news organizations in doing this.
        Gonzalez eventually tried to fire Sprague, was over-ruled by the
     committee, and then resigned from the committee.  Sprague
     eventually resigned, because it became obvious that the CIA
     controlled members of the Finance and Rules Committees and other
     CIA allies in the House, were going to kill the committee unless he
     resigned.  There are many more details to this story, which
     requires a book to describe.  Suffice it to say, the CIA
     accomplished their first two goals by March 1977. The next steps
     were to install a CIA-controlled chief counsel and to get a
     chairman elected who could be fooled or coerced into appointing
     such a counsel.  Lewis Stokes was a perfect choice for chairman.
     He was, and probably still is, a good and honest man.  But he was
     completely bamboozled by what the CIA did and is still doing.  The
     selection and implementation of a CIA man as chief counsel had to
     be done in an extremely subtle manner.  It could not be obvious to
     anyone that he was a CIA man.  Stokes and the other committee
     members had to be fooled into believing *they* had made the choice,
     and had picked a good man.  Professor Robert Blakey, an apparently
     scientifically oriented, academic person, with a history of work
     against organized crime, was the perfect CIA choice.  Once Dr.
     Blakey took over as chief counsel, he accomplished goals numbered
     3, 6, 7, 8, 9 and 10 very nicely.  The fourth and fifth goals
     having been achieved, Blakey set about the other parts of his
     assignment very rapidly after he arrived.  For Goal 3, he fired Bob
     Tanenbaum, Bob Lehner, and Donovan Gay, three loyal Sprague
     supporters, quickly.


                        The Nondisclosure Agreement

        The most important weapon used by the CIA and Blakey to pursue
     goals 9 and 10 was instituted within one week after Blakely
     arrived.  It is by far the most subtle and far reaching technique
     used by the CIA to date.  It is called the "Nondisclosure
     Agreement" and it was signed by all members of the committee, all
     staff members including Blakey, all consultants to the committee,
     and several independent researchers who met with Blakey in 1977.
     Signing the agreement was a condition for continued employment on
     the committee staff or for continuing consulting on a contract
     basis.  The choice was, sign or get out.  The author signed the
     agreement in July 1977, without realizing its implications at the
     time, in order to continue as a consultant.  The agreement is
     reproduced in full in the Appendix and is labelled "Exhibit A."
     The author's consulting help was never sought after that and the
     obvious objective was to silence a consultant and not use his
     services.
        This CIA weapon has several parts.  First, it binds the signer,
     if a consultant, to never reveal that he is working for the
     committee (see paragraph 13).  Second, it prevents the signer from
     ever revealing to anyone in perpetuity, any information he has
     learned about the committee's work as a result of working for the
     committee (see paragraphs 2 and 12).  Third, it gives the committee
     and the House, after the committee terminates, the power to take
     legal action against the signer, *in a court named by the
     committee* or the House, in case the committee believes the signer
     has violated the agreement.  Fourth, the signer agrees to pay the
     court costs for such a suit in the event he loses the suit (see
     paragraphs 14 and 15).
        These four parts are enough to scare most researchers or staff
     members who signed it into silence forever about what they learned.
     The agreement is insidious in that the signer is, in effect, giving
     away his constitutional rights.  Some lawyers who have seen the
     agreement, including Richard A. Sprague, have expressed the opinion
     it is an illegal agreement in violation of the Constitution and
     several Constitutional amendments.  Whether it is illegal or not,
     most staff members and all consultants who signed it *have*
     remained silent, even after three and a half years beyond the life
     of the committee.  There are only two exceptions, the author and
     Gaeton Fonzi, who published a lengthy article about the HSCA
     cover-up in the "Washingtonian" magazine in 1981.
        The most insidious parts of the agreement, however, are
     paragraphs 2, 3 and 7, which give the CIA very effective control
     over what the committee could and could not do with so-called
     "classified" information.  The director of the CIA is given
     authority to determine, in effect, what information shall remain
     classified and therefore unavailable to nearly everyone.  The
     signer of the agreement, and remember, this includes all of the
     Congressman and women who were members of the committee, agrees not
     to reveal or discuss any information that the CIA decides he should
     not.  The chairman of the committee supposedly has the final say on
     what information is included, but in practice, even an intelligent
     and gutsy chairman would not be likely to override the CIA.  Lewis
     Stokes did not attempt any final decisions.  In fact, the CIA did
     not have to do very much under these clauses.  The fact that Blakey
     was their man and kept nearly all of the CIA sensitive information,
     evidence, and witnesses away from the committee members was all
     that was necessary.  Stokes never knew what he should have argued
     about with the CIA director.  It is this document which proves
     beyond doubt that the CIA controlled the HSCA.
        The author attempted to point out to Stokes in a letter dated
     February 10, 1978, "Exhibit B," the type of control the agreement
     gives the CIA over the HSCA.  Stokes replied in a March 16, 1978
     letter, "Exhibit C," that he retained ultimate authority and was
     not bound by the opinion of the Central Intelligence Director.  He
     also claimed that paragraphs 12 and 14, on extending the agreement
     in perpetuity and giving the government the right to file a civil
     suit in which the signer will pay all costs, were legal.  He said
     in the letter that the purpose of the agreement was to give the
     HSCA control over the conduct of the investigation including
     *control over the ultimate disclosure of information to the
     American public*.  That is a key admission about what has actually
     happened.  The only question is, who is controlling the information
     in the heads of the staff investigators who discovered CIA
     involvement?  Was Louis Stokes working for the public or for the
     CIA?


                          Examples of CIA-Control

        Some specific examples will serve to illustrate how well the CIA
     techniques have worked and are still working.

                  Garrison Evidence and Witnesses Example

        As mentioned earlier, when Blakey arrived, an investigating team
     headed by Cliff Fenton, reporting to Bob Tanenbaum, had already
     been hard at work tracking down leads to the CIA conspirators
     generated by Jim Garrison's investigation in New Orleans.  This
     team eventually had four investigators, all professionals, and
     their work led them to believe that the CIA people in New Orleans
     had been involved in a large conspiracy to assassinate JFK.  As
     Garrison told Ted Gandolfo, a New York City researcher, the Fenton
     team went much further than Garrison, in locating witnesses and
     other evidence of assassination planning meetings held in New
     Orleans, Mexico City and Dallas.  In fact, they found a CIA man who
     attended those meetings, and who was willing to testify before the
     committee.  The evidence was far more convincing than the testimony
     presented at the trial of Clay Shaw.  In the Shaw Trial, CIA people
     were involved in meetings in addition to the one brought out in the
     trial.  Clay Shaw, David Ferrie, William Seymour and others were
     involved.  Fenton's team discovered a lot of other facts about how
     the CIA people planned and carried out the assassination.  Their
     report about the conspiracy was solid and convincing and they were
     convinced.  The CIA, through Robert Blakey, buried the Fenton
     report.  Committee members were not told about the team's findings.
     The evidence was not included in the HSCA report, nor was it even
     referred to in the volumes.  The witnesses in New Orleans were
     never called to testify.  That included the CIA man at the
     meetings.  Fenton and the other three members of his team, having
     signed the nondisclosure agreement, were legally sworn to secrecy,
     or at least they thought so.  To this day they refuse to discuss
     anything with anybody.
        There may also have been threats of physical violence against
     them.  There is no way to determine this.  However, Fenton and the
     others are well aware of the witnesses that the CIA murdered just
     before they were about to testify before the HSCA.  These included:
     William Sullivan, the FBI deputy under J. Edgar Hoover, who headed
     Division V, the domestic intelligence division;  George de
     Mohrenschildt, Oswald's CIA contact in Dallas;  John Roselli, the
     Mafia man involved in the CIA plots to assassinate Castro;  Regis
     Kennedy, the FBI agent who knew a lot about Clay Shaw, alias Clay
     Bertrand, in New Orleans and who was one of Lee Harvey Oswald's FBI
     contacts;  Rolando Masferrer, an anti-Castro Cuban murdered in
     Miami;  and Carlos Prio Socarras, former Cuban premier, killed in
     his garage in Miami.
        With the knowledge of these murders, Fenton and his team would
     not have required any more than a gentle hint, to keep quiet.

                              Frenchy Example

        The "tramp," Frenchy, who appears in seven photos taken in
     Dealey Plaza, is one of the most important CIA individuals in the
     JFK assassination.  Researcher Bill Turner discovered that Frenchy
     had been in the Florida Keys working with CIA sponsored anti-Castro
     groups.  Richard A. Sprague and Bob Tanenbaum knew about his role,
     and intended to go after him when the HSCA restored its subpoena
     power and obtained enough money.  They were aware of the evidence
     that Frenchy fired the fatal shot from the grassy knoll.  They had
     assigned a team of investigators to follow a lead to Frenchy
     provided by the author in the early part of 1977.
        Unfortunately, the CIA managed to keep both the subpoena power
     and the funds away from the committee until after they had forced
     the resignations of Gonzalez, Sprague and Tanenbaum.  The power and
     funds were restored after Stokes was elected and after they
     installed their own man, Blakey.  The investigative team remained,
     however, and they did search for and find Frenchy.  But Blakey and
     the CIA suppressed that fact, and suppressed anything they may have
     learned from Frenchy.  He is not mentioned in the report and was
     not called as a witness.  The author dares not reveal the source of
     the above information because of the danger to staff people from
     the nondisclosure agreement.

                  Nagell, Dean, Novel, and Augustinovich

        The Garrison investigation and a subsequent series of
     investigations by the author and other members of the Committee to
     Investigate Assassinations in 1967 to 1973, turned up several
     witnesses who were willing to talk privately about the CIA
     assassination team that murdered JFK.  Harry Dean and Richard Case
     Nagell had been Lee Harvey Oswald's CIA contacts while he was in
     Mexico City and knew about assassination planning meetings held in
     Guy Gabaldin's apartment.  Dean knew about William Seymour, CIA
     contract agent, attending those meetings and how Seymour had been
     pretending to be Oswald on many occasions.  Gordon Novel knew how
     the CIA had covered up the truth about the assassination and how
     they went to extreme lengths to ruin Jim Garrison and his
     investigation.  Novel had been employed by the CIA in this effort.
     Ronald Augustinovich and his friend, Mary Hope, had attended some
     of the Mexico City meetings.
        Richard Russell and the author tracked down all four of these
     witnesses prior to the arrival of Robert Blakey at the HSCA.
     Russell interviewed them and knew they would be willing to talk,
     given protection and some form of immunity.  The author presented
     their names and their involvement to Richard A. Sprague, Henry
     Gonzalez, Lewis Stokes and Robert Tanenbaum in the fall of 1976.
     This was done as part of the author's consulting assignment for the
     HSCA.  The names were in a memorandum to Sprague, which outlined
     the overall JFK conspiracy and the CIA's role, along with a
     recommendation of the sequence in which witnesses should be called.
     The idea was to base each witness interrogation on what had been
     established from interviewing prior witnesses, working slowly from
     cooperative witnesses, to non-cooperative witnesses, to actual
     assassins, to higher level CIA people.[4]  The highest level
     people, E. Howard Hunt and Richard Helms, would be faced with
     accusers.
        As indicated earlier, Sprague and Tanenbaum could do nothing and
     did nothing up to the day they left.  By early 1978 it became
     obvious that Blakey had done nothing about calling these CIA
     witnesses.  The author initiated a series of letter exchanges with
     Blakey and Stokes, reminding them of these witnesses, and the
     possibility that their lives could be in danger prior to their
     being interviewed by HSCA.  Dick Russell had obtained an agreement
     from Nagell to meet with the committee, but no contact had been
     made up to April 5, 1978, the date of the author's first letter to
     Stokes on this subject, "Exhibit D."  Nagell was hiding in fear of
     his children's lives, not so much his own life.  He was a real CIA
     agent and knew how they operated.  Russell was the only person who
     knew where Nagell was.  In the April 5th letter, a recommendation
     was given to Stokes that the committee contact Nagell through
     Russell, and contact the other witnesses on the original list.
     Stokes wrote on May 15, 1978, "Exhibit E," that the Nagell matter had
     been referred to Blakey for follow-up.  Blakey never mentioned it
     by telephone or by letter.
        By September 1978, when the public hearings had begun, there was
     no indication that Blakey was going to call the CIA witnesses.
     Nagell was standing by but had not been contacted.  The published,
     intended witness list did not contain any of these CIA names.  The
     author wrote to Stokes and Representative Yvonne Burke on September
     22 and 23, 1978, "Exhibits F," expressing dissatisfaction with
     the committee's failure to call the CIA witnesses, and suggesting
     that if they did not not, history would eventually catch up with
     them.  The names were repeated in the letter to Burke, and specific
     mention made that the committee had never contacted Richard Case
     Nagell.  Louis Stokes sent back a letter dated October 10, 1978,
     "Exhibit G."  It is what one might call a non-answer, stating "that
     the committee will make every effort to tell the whole story to the
     American people."  Seven years later (1985) it can be said that the
     committee did not make an effort to call the most important
     witnesses and therefore did not tell the whole story.  Nor did
     their report even mention these witnesses or any of the evidence
     exposed earlier by the CTIA or Jim Garrison.  Louis Stokes was
     either totally fooled or he is part of the CIA's cover-up.
        The author responded to Stokes' non-answer letter of October
     10th with two more letters, dated October 30, 1978 and November 24,
     1978, "Exhibits H & I."  Stokes finally answered them on December
     4, 1978 with another non-answer letter, "Exhibit J."  He says the
     committee cannot reveal the procedure of the investigation or the
     names of those persons who will be called to testify before the
     committee.  This implies they were planning to call more witnesses
     in December 1978.  The committee's life ended on January 1, 1979.
     The CIA witnesses were never called nor ever mentioned right up to
     the very end and the report was silent about them.

                            The Umbrella Man

        One last example illustrates the way the CIA and Blakey worked
     together to cancel-out any evidence linking the CIA people and/or
     techniques used in the JFK assassination.  For may years, various
     researchers, including Josiah Thompson[5] and the author, had
     speculated about the role of a man appearing in the photographs in
     Dealey Plaza with an open umbrella.  He became known as "The
     Umbrella Man," or TUM for short.  Thompson speculated that TUM had
     been giving the various shooters in Dealey Plaza visual signals
     with the umbrella, and the author agreed this could have been true.
        In *1976*, the Church committee took the public testimony of
     Charles Senseney, a CIA contract weapons employee at the Army
     Chemical Center in Ft. Detrick, MD.  Senseney described a system
     used by the CIA in Vietnam and elsewhere, for killing or paralyzing
     people with poisons carried in self-propelled Flechette darts.  The
     darts were self-propelled like solid fuel rockets and launched
     silently and unobtrusively from a number of devices, including an
     umbrella.  A CIA catalog of available secret weapons shows a
     photograph of the umbrella launching device and photos of the
     Flechettes which were self-propelled from one of the hollow spokes
     of the umbrella.  They could even be launched through soda straws.
        Researcher Robert Cutler, former Air Force Liason officer, L.
     Fletcher Prouty, and the author did some additional research on the
     photographic evidence and the weapon system, especially research on
     the movements of JFK in the Zapruder film and various photos of TUM
     and a friend he had with him in Dealey Plaza.  The friend had a
     two-way radio device.  As a result of this research, an article was
     published in "Gallery" magazine in June, 1978.  The article
     presented the hypothesis that TUM launched, from his umbrella, a
     poison Flechette at JFK, which struck him in the throat at Zapruder
     frame 189, causing complete paralysis of his upper body, hands,
     arms, shoulders and head, in less than two seconds.  The photos
     show this paralysis and the timing matches the testimony given by
     Senseney about how fast the CIA poison works and what its
     paralyzing effects look like.
        Whether one agrees with this hypothesis or not is incidental to
     what Blakey and the HSCA did in reaction to it.  Until the summer
     of 1977, official investigators for the HSCA, or any of its
     predecessors, had shown no more than passing curious interest in
     TUM.  They just paid no attention and did not take the researcher's
     ideas seriously.  On August 8, 1977, the author informed Robert
     Blakey, in a letter of that date, about the TUM hypothesis.  The
     letter concerned a discussion the author and Blakey had on July 21,
     1977, two days after the nondisclosure agreement had been signed.
     Blakey had said that if there was a conspiracy it would not have
     involved a very large number of people.  He was probably already
     laying the foundation for a small, Mafia type, conspiracy involving
     Oswald and a Mafia friend, backed by a few Mafia Dons.
        The August 8th letter maintained that the CIA had been involved
     and that it had been a massive intelligence operation, rather than
     a conspiracy in the sense Blakey was using the term.  The CIA
     Flechette, umbrella launching weapons system, if indeed it had been
     used by TUM, the letter pointed out, would be solid proof of high
     level CIA involvement, since that system would not have been
     available to lower level agents or contract people.
        Blakey did not respond right away to this letter and the author
     decided to make the TUM hypothesis public by publishing it with
     Cutler as co-author, in the spring of 1978, in "Gallery" magazine.
     Contact was also made with Senator Richard Schweiker who had been
     the member of the Church Committee responsible for interrogating
     Charles Senseney.  Schweiker agreed to try and find out from
     Senseney what had happened to the umbrella launchers he had
     constructed for the CIA;  that is, who in the CIA had had access to
     a launcher.
        The information to be published in "Gallery" had been generated
     by Bob Cutler and the author independently of any information
     obtained from the HSCA, but the safest approach seemed to be an
     application to them for permission to print the article under the
     terms of the nondisclosure agreement.  So, on January 9, 1978, the
     author submitted a draft of the "Gallery" article to Blakey and, on
     January 16, 1978, he wrote back stating that publishing the article
     would not violate the terms of the nondisclosure agreement, "Exhibit
     K."  The article was published in the June 1978 issue of "Gallery"
     which actually appeared in May 1978.  Blakey knew in advance when
     it would appear.
        On August 3, 1978, the author wrote to Blakey stating that
     photographic evidence showed a high probability that TUM was
     actually Gordon Novel, the CIA contract agent from New Orleans, who
     had been hired to ruin the Garrison investigation, "Exhibit L."
     The reason that some new photo evidence was just then coming to
     light was that the committee had discovered a never-before seen
     film of TUM and had released a frame from this film to the press in
     July 1978.  Shortly after the TUM photo was released by the HSCA,
     with an appeal to him to come forward, an unknown caller contacted
     Penn Jones in Texas to tell him he knew who TUM was.  Penn visited
     Louis Witt, having been given his address, and upon seeing him,
     jumped to the conclusion that he *was* TUM.  This led to Mr. Witt
     appearing before the committee in their televised hearings and
     making the claim he was TUM.  He showed the umbrella on TV that he
     claimed he used.
        It was immediately obvious to Bob Cutler and the author that
     Witt was not TUM.  He displayed the umbrella he said he had used in
     Dealey Plaza and *it contained the wrong number of spokes*.  His
     height, weight and facial appearance did not match TUM's, and his
     description of his actions did not match at all the actions TUM
     took, as shown in the photos.  On November 24, 1978, the author
     wrote to Stokes telling him he had been fooled by a CIA plant, or
     by his own staff, planting Mr. Witt, and that he should call Gordon
     Novel as a witness because it was likely that Novel was TUM.  HSCA
     never did call Novel as a witness.  Novel had visited the HSCA
     during the days Richard A. Sprague was still there, but he had not
     mentioned being in Dealey Plaza or that the CIA had hired him to
     ruin Garrison.  Blakey and Stokes avoided contacting Novel.
        Now, the important thing to focus on, in this example, is the
     sequence of events.  The HSCA had done nothing about TUM until they
     were faced with the possibility of a public article linking TUM to
     the CIA through a CIA weapons system and through Gordon Novel.
     They also found out that Senator Schweiker was looking into the CIA
     end of it.  At about the time the "Gallery" article was being
     widely read, the HSCA suddenly released to the press a photo of TUM
     and asked that people identify him or that he come forward.  The
     photo did not show his umbrella or where he was sitting in Dealey
     Plaza, nor did the release mention the umbrella or the theories
     about it.  Just his photo.  An earlier photo used by Cutler and the
     author to identify Novel as TUM was not released.
        In a surprisingly short time after the photo appeared, an
     unknown person calls a well-known researcher and leads him to Louis
     Witt.  Witt in turn lies about who he was and where he was, by
     claiming to be TUM.  Blakey and the committee put Witt on center
     stage as though it was a play, and eliminate the TUM problem by
     pulling off a charade.  The fine hand of the CIA can be seen in
     this whole series of linked events.  Blakey had to have known what
     was going on, and he knows today that Witt was not TUM and the high
     probability that TUM was Gordon Novel, CIA agent.
        The extreme lengths that the CIA and Blakey went to in this
     charade, made one believe that the umbrella probably *was* the
     Charles Senseney weapon.  Otherwise, why bother with TUM?


                             Goal Number Eight

        What has been presented so far in this article represents direct
     actions by the CIA to cover-up CIA involvement.  Blakey played
     another important role and that was to achieve the eighth goal on
     the list, namely to change the public impression of HSCA's main
     effort.  Researchers who concentrated on attacking the Warren
     Commission's Dealey Plaza or Tippit shooting findings had created
     a big problem.  If Oswald had fired no shots, then he must have
     been framed.  If Oswald was framed, the evidence against him was
     planted, and multiple gunmen were involved.  All of this line of
     reasoning would point to a very well-organized and very well-
     planned conspiracy, which would in turn point to an intelligence
     style involvement.
        So, Blakey set out from the beginning to create an investigative
     environment and image that appeared to be based on a *highly
     scientific, objective study of the Dealey Plaza evidence*.  The
     overall objective of this approach was to prove "scientifically"
     that the Warren Commission was right, and that Lee Harvey Oswald
     fired all the shots that had struck John Kennedy, Governor Connally
     and policeman Tippit.  That required scientific proof of the
     single bullet theory, among other things.  Blakey did just that.
     Right up to the moment when the acoustical evidence on the Dallas
     police tape reared its ugly head, only one month from the end of
     the life of the committee, Blakey managed to control and manipulate
     the Dealey Plaza evidence to back up the Warren Commission
     completely.  The author described how Blakey did this in chapter
     16.  One of his "magical" methods was to split up the scientific
     work into subcommittees or panels of advisors, and various staff
     groups, and keep them all from communicating with each other.
     *Thus, even though the medical panel gave testimony showing an
     upward trajectory of the single bullet (399) shot*, the trajectory
     panel turned it into a downward trajectory.  The photographic panel
     was so isolated they never did see the most important evidence of
     the sixth floor window, inside and outside.
        The photo panel had a number of government and military people
     on it, as did all of the other panels.  Thus it was not surprising
     that they testified that the fake photos of Oswald holding a rifle
     were not fakes.  Blakey rode roughshod over the evidence that these
     photos were fakes, presenting only one witness, Jack White, to show
     why they were fakes, and giving him a very rough time.  Other
     researchers, like Fred Newcomb and the author, who had done a lot
     of work on the fake photos, were not called and not consulted by
     the photo panel or Blakey and his staff.  There are many more
     examples of how Blakey managed this magic show on public TV, too
     numerous to describe here.
        One important result of this drastic change of investigative
     environment compared to that existing under Richard A. Sprague, was
     to draw the attention of the public during the hearings away from
     the evidence and the witnesses pointing to the real assassins, and
     to the fact that Oswald was framed and did not fire any shots.  It
     thus provided an additional shield for the CIA and in effect,
     completed the cover-up.


                                  Summary

        Now, in the spring of 1985, the CIA appears to have under
     control the final cover-up engineered by Robert Blakey with the
     support of a few murders of key witnesses and the existence of the
     insidious, illegal, nondisclosure agreement silencing the HSCA
     staff, committee members, and consultants.  The situation for the
     American public appears to be hopeless.  The CIA effectively
     controlled all three branches of government when the chips were
     down, and have had no problems controlling the fourth estate, the
     media, or the independent researchers.  By what means could the
     American public combat this awesome power?  It is hard to see that
     there is any means available.  And we have now reached and passed
     1984.  Would an election of Edward Kennedy to the presidency in
     1988 change anything?  If he lived through a presidency following
     an election campaign, it probably would.  Most Americans react to
     that by saying, "he would be assassinated."  Somehow they have
     received the messages about what has gone wrong with the United
     States.


____________________

[1] Chaired by Prof. Norman Ramsey of M.I.T.

[2] Senators Richard Schweiker of Penn. and Gary Hart of Colo. formed
   a sub-committee of the Church Committee.

[3] The author became an advisor to Richard A. Sprague as soon as he
   was appointed counsel to the HSCA.

[4] The names of the witnesses in the memo were:
   Cooperative Witnesses:
     Louis Ivon (Jim Garrison's chief investigator), Richard Case
     Nagell, Harry Dean, James Hosty, Carver Gaten, Warren du Bruys,
     Regis Kennedy, Victor Marchetti, Gordon Novel, Manuel Garcia
     Gonzalez, Harry Williams, Jim Garrison, George de
     Mohrenschildt, Charles Senseney, Mary Hope and Jim Hicks.

   Non-Cooperative Witnesses or Assassins or Planners:
     Ronald Augustinovich, Guy Gabaldin, Frenchy, William Seymour,
     Emilio Santana, Jack Lawrence, Jim Braden, Sergio Arcacha
     Smith, Fred Lee Crisman, William Sullivan, Carlos Prio
     Socarras, Rolando Masferrer, Major L.M. Bloomfield, E. Howard
     Hunt, and Richard Helms.

[5] In his book, "Six Seconds in Dallas," Thompson showed photos of
   TUM.








                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *

--

  I see in the near future a crisis approaching that unnerves me and causes
  me to tremble for the safety of my country. . . .  Corporations have been
  enthroned, an era of corruption in high places will follow, and the
  money-power of the country will endeavor to prolong its reign by working
  upon the prejudices of the people until the wealth is aggregated in a few
  hands and the Republic is destroyed.

             --- Abraham Lincoln (quoted in Jack London's "The Iron Heel").



From [email protected] Fri Jun 19 09:59:20 1992
Received: by icaen.uiowa.edu ( 5.52 (84)/1.1) id AA12962
       on Fri, 19 Jun 92 09:59:15 CDT.
Received: from pl122c.eecs.lehigh.edu by ns-mx.uiowa.edu (5.64.jnf/920408)
         on Fri, 19 Jun 92 10:00:55 -0500 id AA28160 with SMTP
Received: from SGI.COM by PL122c.EECS.Lehigh.EDU (5.61/1.34)
       id AA10490; Fri, 19 Jun 92 10:44:51 -0400
Received: from [192.102.132.11] by sgi.sgi.com via SMTP (911016.SGI/910110.SGI)
       for [email protected] id AA21909; Fri, 19 Jun 92 07:47:33 -0700
Received: by ratmandu.esd.sgi.com (920110.SGI/920502.SGI.AUTO)
       for @sgi.sgi.com:[email protected] id AA14482; Fri, 19 Jun 92 07:47:30 -0700
Date: Fri, 19 Jun 92 07:47:30 -0700
From: [email protected] (dave "who can do? ratmandu!" ratcliffe)
Message-Id: <[email protected]>
To: [email protected]
Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (11/11)
Status: RO


Subject: "The Taking of America, 1-2-3" (11/11)
Summary: we were robbed of our capability of electing a president we wanted
Keywords:  part 11 of 11:  Appendix
Lines: 1151


                            *  *  *  *  *  *  *



                                 Appendix

    The Secrecy Oath the Author signed after Robert Blakey took over
    the HSCA, and correspondence between the author and various
    committee members.





                                 Exhibit A
     ____________________________________________________________



      Select Committee on Assassinations Nondisclosure Agreement


         [Richard E. Sprague]
      I, ____________________, in consideration for being
      employed by or engaged by contract or otherwise to perform
      services for or at the request of the House Select Committee
      on Assassinations, or any Member thereof, da hereby make the
      representations and accept the obligations set forth below as
      conditions precedent for my employment or engagement, or for
      my continuing employment or engagement, with the Select Com-
      mittee, the United States House of Representatives, or the
      United States Congress.

           1.  I have read the Rules of the Select Committee, and I
      hereby agree to be bound by them and by the Rules of the House
      of Representatives.

           2.  I hereby agree never to divulge, publish or reveal by
      words, conduct or otherwise, any testimony given before the
      Select Committee in executive session (including the name of any
      witness who appeared or was summoned to appear before the Select
      Committee in executive session), any classifiable and properly
      classified information (as defined in 5 U.S.C. Section 552(b)(1)),
      or any information pertaining to intelligence sources or methods
      as designated by the Director of Central Intelligence, or any con-
      fidential information that is received by the Select Committee
      or that comes into my possession by virtue of my position with
      the Select Committee, to any person not a member of the Select
      Committee or its staff or the personal staff representative of
      a Committee Member unless authorized in writing by the Select
      Committee, or, after the Select Committee's termination, by
      such manner as the House of Representatives may determine or,
      in the absence of a determination by the House, in such manner
      as the Agency or Department from which the information origin-
      ated may determine.  I further agree not to divulge, publish
      or reveal by words, conduct or otherwise, any other information
      which is received by the Select Committee or which comes into
      my possession by virtue of my position with the Select Committee,
      for the duration of the Select Committee's existence.

           3.  I hereby agree that any material that is based upon or
      may include information that I hereby pledge not to disclose,
      and that is contemplated for publication by me will, prior to
      discussing it with or showing it to any publishers, editors or
      literary agents, be submitted to the Select Committee to deter-
      mine whether said material contains any information that I
      hereby pledge not to disclose.  The Chairman of the Select Com-
      mittee shall consult with the Director of Central Intelligence
      for the purpose of the Chairman's determination as to whether
      or not the material contains information that I pledge not to
      disclose.  I further agree to take no steps toward publication
      until authorized in writing by the Select Committee, or after
      its termination, by such manner as the House of Representatives
      may determine, or in the absence of a determination by the
      House, in such manner as the Agency or Department from which
      the information originated may determine.

           4.  I hereby agree to familiarize myself with the Select
      Committee's security procedures, and provide at all times the
      required degree of protection against unauthorized disclosure
      for all information and materials that come into my possession
      by virtue of my position with the Select Committee.

           5.  I hereby agree to immediately notify the Select Com-
      mittee of any attempt by any person not a member of the Select
      Committee staff to solicit information from me that I pledge
      not to disclose.

           6.  I hereby agree to immediately notify the Select
      Committee if I am called upon to testify or provide information
      to the proper authorities that I pledge not to disclose.  I
      will request that my obligation to respond is established by
      the Select Committee, or after its termination, by such manner
      as the House of Representatives may determine, before I do so.

           7.  I hereby agree to surrender to the Select Committee
      upon demand by the Chairman or upon my separation from the
      Select Committee staff, any material, including any classified
      information or information pertaining to intelligence sources
      or methods as designated by the Director of Central Intelligence,
      which comes into my possession by virtue of my position with the
      Select Committee.  I hereby acknowledge that all documents
      acquired by me in the course of my employment are and remain the
      property of the United States.

           8.  I understand that any violation of the Select Committee
      Rules, security procedures or this agreement shall constitute
      grounds for dismissal from my current employment.

           9.  I hereby assign to the United States Government all
      rights, title and interest in any and all royalties, remunera-
      tions and emoluments that have resulted or may result from any
      divulgence, publication or revelation in violation of this
      agreement.

          10.  I understand and agree that the United States Government
      may choose to apply, prior to any unauthorized disclosure by
      me, for a court order prohibiting disclosure.  Nothing in this
      agreement constitutes a waiver on the part of the United States
      of the right to prosecute for any statutory violation.  Nothing
      in this agreement constitutes a waiver on my part of any defenses
      I may otherwise have in any civil or criminal proceedings.

          11.  I have read the provisions of the Espionage Laws,
      Sections 793, 794 and 798, Title 18, United States Code, and
      of Section 783, Title 50, United States Code, and I am aware
      that unauthorized disclosure of certain classified information
      may subject me to prosecution.  I have read Section 1001, Title
      18, United States Code, and I am aware that the making of a
      false statement herein is punishable as a felony.  I have also
      read Executive Order 11652, and the implementing National
      Security Council directive of May 17, 1972, relating to the
      protection of classified information.

          12.  Unless released in writing from this agreement or any
      portion thereof by the Select Committee, I recognize that all
      the conditions and obligations imposed on me by this agreement
      apply during my Committee employment or engagement and continue
      to apply after the relationship is terminated.

          13.  No consultant shall indicate, divulge or acknowledge,
      without written permission of the Select Committee, the fact
      that the Select Committee has engaged him or her by contract
      as a consultant until after the Select Committee has terminated.

          14.  In addition to any rights for criminal prosecution or
      for injunctive relief the United States Government may have for
      violation of this agreement, the United States Government may
      file a civil suit in an appropriate court for damages as a
      consequence of a breach of this agreement.  The costs of any
      civil suit brought by the United States for breach of this
      agreement, including court costs, investigative expenses, and
      reasonable attorney fees, shall be borne by any defendant who
      loses such suit.  In any civil suit for damages successfully
      brought by the United States Government for breach of this
      agreement, actual damages may be recovered, or, in the event
      that such actual damages may be impossible to calculate, liquidated
      damages in an amount of $5,000 shall be awarded as a reasonable
      estimate for damages to the credibility and effectiveness of the
      investigation.

          15.  I hereby agree that in any suit by the United States
      Government for injunctive or monetary relief pursuant to the
      terms of this agreement, personal jurisdiction shall obtain and
      venue shall lie in the United States District Court for the
      District of Columbia, or in any other appropriate United States
      District Court in which the United States may elect to bring
      suit.  I further agree that the law of the District of Columbia
      shall govern the interpretation and construction of this
      agreement.

          16.  Each provision of this agreement is severable.  If a
      court should find any part of this agreement to be unenforceable,
      all other provisions of this agreement shall remain in full force
      and effect.

           I make this agreement without any mental reservation or
      purpose of evasion, and I agree that it may be used by the
      Select Committee in carrying out its duty to protect the security
      of information provided to it.






               [July 19, 1977]            [Richard E., Sprague]
      Date: _____________________      _________________________________


 [  I am submitting a list of
    material and information
    which has already been             _________________________________
    given to the committee,            LOUIS STOKES, Chariman
    or which I intend to               Select Committee on Assassinations
    give to the committee in
    the near future.  I intend
    to publish some of this
    information.]









                                Exhibit B
     ____________________________________________________________





                                                  193 Pinewood Road
                                                  Hartsdale, NY  10530

                                                  February 10, 1978



   Mr. Louis Stokes
   Chairman, Select Committee on Assassinations
   U.S. House of Representatives
   Washington, D.C.  20515

   Dear Louis:

   As I am sure you know, I signed a non disclosure agreement for the
   Select Committee, given to me on July 19, 1977 by Robert Blakey.  Not
   being a lawyer, I did not really appreciate some of the provisions of
   that agreemont at the time I signed it, even though some things in it
   seemed strange to me.

   In the last fow months I have gone over the agreement several times,
   with particular attention to those strange portions.  The more I re-
   read the agreement, the more puzzled I have become.

   I was finally triggered into writing you this letter by a conversation
   I had with Richard A. Sprague.  As you may recall I helped him and Bob
   Tanenbaum from November 1976 forward with the photographic evidence in
   the JFK case, and several other areas derived from my relationship with
   Jim Garrison and the Committee to Investigate Assassinations.  I had no
   written agreement with the Committee at that time and did not ask for
   compensation for the work I had been doing.  I had signed no non dis-
   closure agreement and such an agreement had never been mentioned.

   The first time I had any idea that the Committee would want to pay me
   for my assistance was some time after Dick Sprague resigned, when Mr.
   Blakey approached me about it through Bob Tanenbaum, shortly before
   Bob resigned.  My recent meeting with Dick Sprague naturally led to
   discussion about my continuing work for the Committee.  He raised the
   subject of the non disclosure agreement signed by each staff member,
   saying that he would never have enforced such a document while he was
   chief counsel because he believes it gives the CIA and other agencies
   too much power to control the activities of the Committee.  It was
   because of that statement that I read the agreement again in the
   light of what he said.

   I know that you had a lot of faith in Richard A. Sprague and did not
   personally want him to resign.  For that reason I'm writing to you
   rather than Mr. Blakey, seeking answers to my questions.

   Encloged is a copy of the agreement with my signature.  I have circled
   on it the paragraphs in question, and underlined the key words.  My
   questions, Mr. Stokes are as follows:

   1.  Are paragraphs 2, 3 and 7 inserted for the purpose of giving the
       CIA power over the Select Committee to investigate the CIA's
       role in the assassinations or the cover up crimes following the
       assassinations of President Kennedy or Dr. King?  I believe those
       paragraphs could be so interpreted, especially if each committee
       member and each staff member signed a similar agreement.

   2.  If the purposes of paragraphs 2, 3 and 7 are not as questioned
       above, then how can the Select Committee, its staff or its con-
       sultants, *ever* discover whether the CIA was involved in the
       assassinations or whether the CIA, as I maintain, is *still*
       involved in covering up the conspiracies?

       For example, paragraph 3 states that you as chairman, shall con-
       sult with the Director of Central Intelligence--to determine
       whether or not the material I might receive contains information
       that I pledge not to disclose.

       Assuming that all committee staff people signed that paragraph,
       it would seem to me that you would really be hamstrung in investi-
       gating the CIA's possible role.  Your staff could not be working
       with any documents or other materials pointing toward CIA agents'
       involvement in the assassinations, without you personally having
       to show those documents to the Director of Central Intelligence
       and to obtain his agreement to disclose the information to the
       public.

       The CIA Director has the power of judging what can be released.
       Obviously, anything incriminating to the CIA, especially higher
       level people who may have been involved, would be judged unreleas-
       able.

       None of this would take on the significance that it does, were it
       not for my belief that the CIA itself has continued to cover up
       the original conspiracy and that several CIA agents or contract
       employees carried out the murder.

   3.  Is paragraph 12 really logical, or even legal?  Can an agreement
       with a body be extended ad infinitum after the body has dissolved?

   4.  Paragraph 14 bothers me.  It seems to say that I agree to allow
       the government to sue me and to bear the expenses of such a suit.
       Is it really legal to ask me to agree to be sued as a condition
       of my consulting contract?  Couldn't the government sue me and
       collect expenses anyway if I did something wrong, without such a
       clause?  Paragraph 16 seems to anticipate that Paragraph 14 may
       not stand up in court.  (Or some other paragraph.)

   I want to make it clear that my concerns in this matter are not related
   to any obligation I may have.  Rather, I am concerned about the
   purposes of those clauses in the agreement, as they affect the
   investigations.  I believe every staff member signed them.

   I would appreciate hearing directly from you on these questions Mr.
   Stokes, rather than referring this letter to Mr. Blakey.

                              Yours sincerely,


                              Richard E. Sprague








                                Exhibit C
     ____________________________________________________________



               LOUIS STOKES, OHIO, CHAIRMAN

RICHARDSON PREYER, N.C.           SAMUEL L. DEVINE, OHIO
WALTER E. FAUNTROY, D.C.          STEWART B. MCKINNEY, CONN.
YVONNE BRATHWAITE BURKE, CALIF.   CHARLES THONE, NEBR.
CHRISTOPHER J. DODD, CONN.        HAROLD S. SAWYER, MICH.
HAROLD E. FORD, TENN.
FLOYD J. FITHIAN, IND.
ROBERT W. EDGAR, PA.
                       ------------
                      (202) 225-4624


                                   Select Committee on Assassinations
                                      U.S House of Representatives
                                   3331 HOUSE OFFICE BUILDING, ANNEX 2
                                        WASHINGTON, D.C.  20515


                                               MAR 16 1978





           Richard E. Sprague, Esq.
           193 Pinewood Road
           Hartsdale, New York 10530

           Dear Mr. Sprague:


                  In response to your letter of February 10, 1978
           concerning the non-disclosure agreement which you signed
           with the Committee, I wish to first remind you that the
           agreement was explicitly explained to you provision by
           provision by Mr. Blakey, and that you were given the
           opportunity to ask any questions that you desired prior
           to your signing the agreement.  I want to assure you that
           the intent of the agreement is not to prevent information
           from ultimately being disclosed to the American public.
           The non-disclosure agreement only governs the timing of
           disclosure of information to the public.  In response to
           your specific questions:

                  I.  Paragraphs 2, 3 and 7 obviously are not for
           the purpose of giving the CIA power over the Select Committee
           to investigate the CIA's role in the assassination.  If
           you read these paragraphs carefully, they clearly provide
           that the Select Committee, during its existence, will be in
           full control and have access to all information.  The paragraphs
           do prevent you from disclosing the information, without the
           authorization of the Select Committee.

                      Paragraph 3 does state that I, as Chairman, will
           consult with the Director of Central Intelligence to determine
           whether or not material contains information which you pledge
           not to disclose.  I, however, retain ultimate authority and
           I only consult with the Director of Central Intelligence -
           I am not bound by his opinion.

                  II.  Paragraphs 12 and 14 are indeed legal.  Should
           you have any specific questions concerning the legality of
           any of the provisions, I suggest you consult your own attorney.

                  I assure you that the very purpose of the non-
           disclosure agreement is to give the Select Committee full
           control over the conduct of the investigation, including
           the ultimate disclosure of information to the American
           public.  In no manner should it be construed as the Committee
           being restricted in its investigation by the CIA or any other
           federal agency or department.

                  In closing, I remind you of paragraph 13 of the
           non-disclosure agreement which provides that you may not
           "indicate, divulge or acknowledge" the fact that you have
           been retained as a consultant until after the Select Committee
           has been terminated.  I have seen a press release concerning
           yourself issued by Mr. Altmans in conjunction with a new article
           in Gallery magazine.  I note that while you technically did
           not violate the non-disclosure agreement which you signed,
           by carefully wording the release to describe the work you
           had done for the Committee in the past, this is the exact
           kind of exploitation of a consultant relationship that the
           Committee desires to avoid during its existence.

                  If you have any other questions or comments on the
           non-disclosure agreement, they should be addressed to Mr.
           Blakey as Chief Counsel.

                                         Sincerely,

                                       [Louis Stokes]

                                         Louis Stokes
                                         Chairman

           LS:jwc








                                Exhibit D
     ____________________________________________________________




                                    193 Pinewood Road
                                    Hartsdale, NY  10530

                                    April 5, 1978


      Representative Louis Stokes
      U.S. House of Representatives
      Raybur House Office Building
      Washington, D.C. 20515

      Dear Louis,

      Thank you for your most reassuring letter of March 16, 1978.
      As you know I have great faith in your own personal integrity
      and your goals as discussed with you at lunch nearly a year
      ago.  I understand the necessity for non disclosure and
      sensitive discretion in the way the Select Committee is pro-
      ceeding.  I believe I understand it more than most researchers
      because of my close working relationship with the staff and the
      committee ever since it started.

      You can rest assured that it is my intention to continue to
      assist you and to support your efforts right up to the finish
      line.  I want to avoid as much as you do any exploitation of my
      relationship to the committee that would cause problems for you
      or for me, especially with the media.

      In this regard, the press release you mentioned in your letter
      from Gallery magazine was initially prepared by their public
      relations department, and included a statement taht I am a
      consultant to the Select Committee.  I asked them to delete the
      statement and they insisted on retaining something about my
      assistance to the committee in order to help establish my
      credibility with their readers.  After some discussion I was
      able to get them to modify the statement to apply to the past
      work for Richard A. Sprague and Henry Gonzalez.

      There will be another article in the June 1978 issue using this
      same statement.  I believe I mentioned the article to you several
      months ago.  It is about the CIA weapon system developed by
      Charles Senseney at Fort Detrick, Maryland using rocket propelled
      flechettes carrying paralyzing poison launched by an umbrella.
      I described in the article the evidence pointing toward the use
      of this weapons system in Dealey Plaza.  The article will appear
      on May 2 on the newsstands.

      I read your March 16 letter, on March 22, upon my return from a
      trip to Japan and a vacation.  I contacted Gallery asking them to
      delete entirely the statement about me and the Select Committee.
      They told me it was too late, that the issue had already gone to
      press.  However, they did agree to delete the statement from any



      [the remainder of this letter was missing from the copy of the
       edition used to make this on-line version.  --Editor]







                                Exhibit E
     ____________________________________________________________



               LOUIS STOKES, OHIO, CHAIRMAN

RICHARDSON PREYER, N.C.           SAMUEL L. DEVINE, OHIO
WALTER E. FAUNTROY, D.C.          STEWART B. MCKINNEY, CONN.
YVONNE BRATHWAITE BURKE, CALIF.   CHARLES THONE, NEBR.
CHRISTOPHER J. DODD, CONN.        HAROLD S. SAWYER, MICH.
HAROLD E. FORD, TENN.
FLOYD J. FITHIAN, IND.
ROBERT W. EDGAR, PA.
                       ------------
                      (202) 225-4624


                                   Select Committee on Assassinations
                                      U.S House of Representatives
                                   3331 HOUSE OFFICE BUILDING, ANNEX 2
                                        WASHINGTON, D.C.  20515


                                               May 15, 1978




          Mr. Richard Sprague
          193 Pinewood Road
          Hartsdale, NY 10530

          Dear Mr. Sprague:

               Thank you for your thoughtful letter of April 5
          and I hope that you will excuse my delay in responding.

               I appreciate your expression of confidence in me
          and your reassurance of your continued support. With
          regard to the matter of the press release, I understand
          your situation and it was most thoughtful of you to
          advise me in advance about the article in the June issue
          of Gallery magazine.

               Your letter has been sent on to the Committee staff
          in order that they might share your recommendations about
          Richard Case Nagell.

               Thank you again for your continuing support.

                                        Sincerely,


                                       [Louis Stokes]

                                        LOUIS STOKES
                                 Chairman

          LS:thn







                                Exhibit F
     ____________________________________________________________




                                     193 Pinewood Road
                                     Hartsdale, New York  10530

                                     September 22, 1978


            Representative Yvonne Burke
            U.S. House of Representatives
            Washington, D.C.  20515

            Dear Mrs. Burke:

                I don't know whether you recall our meeting on
            July 21, 1977 when Jack White, Robert Groden and I
            made presentations to the J.F.K. subcommittee of the
            Select Committee on Assassinations.  You may
            remember my showing a summary of photographic evidence
            of conspiracy in the Kennedy assassination.  You asked
            some very pertinent questions which I answered about
            how to obtain films and photos from media organizations
            that were stonewalling at the time.

                I am truly sorry that you have missed the first
            three weeks of the J.F.K. hearings because I feel that
            your presence would have created at least a minority
            of one against the carefully orchestrated cover up that
            is now takinq place.  I had great faith in the committee,
            especially after a luncheon meeting with Louis Stokes
            in 1977 and after the presentation to you.

                I want you personally to know that I have now lost
            all of that faith.  The farce that is going on is really
            almost unbelievable to an honest researcher.  All
            witnesses (except Cyril Wecht), all panels employed by
            the committee, the staff and the committee members doing
            the questioning, obviously made up their minds a long
            time ago that Lee Harvey Oswald was the lone assassin,
            that there was no conspiracy and that the Warren
            Commission was right.

                I cannot understand how this came about.  As the
            most likely committee member to still keep an open mind,
            I would like to ask your opinion.

                How did the committee staff ignore all of the
            evidence of conspiracy.  I am speaking not only
            about the photographic evidence, but about the
            information that Clifford Fenton and his team
            uncovered in New Orleans.  I know you know about
            that from my conversations with Ted Gandolfo and
            Jim Garrison.

                Do you believe there was a conspiracy?  If you
            do, will you say so when you return to Washington?
            Will you insist that the committee hear from the
            important New Orleans witnesses as well as the
            others I recommended long long ago.  Specifically,
            will you insist that the committee call as witnesses:
            James Hosty, Warren du Bruys, Regis Kennedy, Richard
            Case Nagell, Harry Dean, Ronald Augustinovich, Mary
            Hope, Guy Gabaldin, Frenchy, William Seymour, Emilio
            Santana, Jack Lawrence, Jim Braden, E. Howard Hunt,
            Richard Helms and the others listed in the document
            I gave Louis Stokes in 1977.  If you can't or won't,
            God help this country.


                                    Yours sincerely,


                                    Richard E. Sprague



            P.S.  In the case of key witness Richard Case Nagell,
            Mr. Stokes assured me this spring that the committee
            would contact him.  As of this date, he has never
            been contacted.  He knows who killed President Kennedy.







                                Exhibit G
     ____________________________________________________________




               LOUIS STOKES, OHIO, CHAIRMAN

RICHARDSON PREYER, N.C.           SAMUEL L. DEVINE, OHIO
WALTER E. FAUNTROY, D.C.          STEWART B. MCKINNEY, CONN.
YVONNE BRATHWAITE BURKE, CALIF.   CHARLES THONE, NEBR.
CHRISTOPHER J. DODD, CONN.        HAROLD S. SAWYER, MICH.
HAROLD E. FORD, TENN.
FLOYD J. FITHIAN, IND.
ROBERT W. EDGAR, PA.
                       ------------
                      (202) 225-4624


                                   Select Committee on Assassinations
                                      U.S House of Representatives
                                   3331 HOUSE OFFICE BUILDING, ANNEX 2
                                        WASHINGTON, D.C.  20515


                                           October 10, 1978




          Mr. Richard Sprague
          193 Pinewood Road
          Hartsdale, New York 10530

          Dear Mr. Sprague:

                 I was greatly disturbed by your letter of September
          23, 1978 in which you stated that, "I have one last hope
          that what we are witnessing in your hearings is a charade
          meant to fool the FBI and the CIA.  If it is, you have fooled
          me.  If it is not, your statements to me over the past year
          about getting at the truth were all meaningless.  I have
          lost all faith in you and the committee."

                 I must say that I deeply regret the fact that you
          have lost faith in the performance of my committee.  We
          have attempted to do a thorough, competent and professional
          job which would be a source of pride for you and other
          concerned Americans.

                 I should state here for the record, Mr. Sprague, that
          I find nothing inconsistent in my statements to you over the
          year indicating that the committee would be seeking the truth
          and nothing but the truth during the course of the investigation
          and the testimony that the committee has received during its
          public hearings.  Perhaps you are confused because I did not
          explicitly state that the truth the committee is seeking is
          not your truth or my truth, but truth supported by the weight
          of the evidence.

                 Thanks again for your past and current concerns.  I
          assure you that the committee will make every effort to tell
          the whole story to the American people.

                                    Sincerely,

                                     [Louis Stokes]
                                    Chairman


          LS: icmj







                                Exhibit H
     ____________________________________________________________





                                               193 Pinewood Road
                                               Hartsdale, NY  10530



                                               October 30, 1978




        Representative Louis Stokes
        Select Committee on Assassinations
        U.S. House of Representatives
        3369 House Office Building, Annex 2
        Washington, D.C.  20515

        Dear Louis:

        I appreciate your responding to my September 23 letter.
        I am truly sorry to be so disturbing to you concerning
        the committee's hearings.  I wish I could be more
        complimentary and positive about your work.

        I could not agree with you more that the "truth supported
        by the weight of the evidence" is what we are all after.
        I'm enclosing for your information one more copy of the
        document I gave to Henry Gonzalez, Richard A. Sprague,
        Bob Tannenbaum, and you in 1976 and 1977.

        Unless you call the witnesses listed on pages 4-6 of this
        document, Louis, you have not dealt with the most impor-
        tant evidence of all.  How can you possibly claim to have
        unearthed anything approximating the truth, unless you
        and the rest of the committee interrogate with strength,
        the following important witnesses that you missed:

        Richard Case Nagell, James P. Hosty, Louis Ivon, Victor
        Marchetti, Gorden Novel, Ronald Augustinovich, Mary Hope,
        Manuel Garcia Gonzalez, William Seymour, Emilio Santana,
        Guy Gabaldin, Major L.M. Bloomfield, Harry Williams,
        Sylvia Odio and Jim Garrison.

        The document explains how each of these witnesses was
        involved in the assassination of investigations of it.
        It is based, not just on my research, but on painful
        hours of investigative efforts of many, many people,
        including Jim Garrison's professional staff, the
        Committee to Investigate Assassinations and others.

        I understand that James P. Hosty is finally ready to
        tell his real story, at the risk of physical harm to
        himself and his family.  You have not called him.
        Richard Case Nagell has been ready to testify for a
        long time.  Despite my requests to Dr. Blakey and to
        you, he has not been called and no effort has been
        made to locate him through the only person who knows
        where he is, Dick Russell.

        If you will pardon my saying so Louis, something about
        just those two failures stinks, not to mention all of
        the others.

        It is not too late to save your reputations.  You can
        still call those witnesses in December.  I hope you do.


                                         Yours Sincerely,



                                         Dick Sprague






                                Exhibit I
     ____________________________________________________________





                                               193 Pinewood Road
                                               Hartsdale, NY  10530

                                               November 24, 1978




        Representative Louis Stokes
        Select Committee on Assassinations
        U.S. House of Representatives
        3369 House Office Building, Annex 2
        Washington, D.C.  20515

        Dear Louis:

        I am still waiting for a reply to my letter of October 30,
        1978.  I thought I should write again to remind you that
        the witnesses you should call in December are not going to
        be around much longer.  I'm afraid that Gorden Novel,
        Richard Case Nagell, James Hosty and Warren de Brueys, in
        particular may go the same way that Regis Kennedy, William
        Sullivan, and George de Mohrenschildt went.  You really
        must call them before they die.

        Regis Kennedy reportedly died of natural causes the day
        before you were to talk with him.  I do not believe that.
        How many more key witnesses have to die before you would
        be convinced?  Kennedy, du Brueys and Hosty were Oswald's
        points of contact in the FBI, receiving his reports on the
        conspiratorial group planning JFK's assassination.  I have
        known this since 1971 directly from Hosty's own lips via
        Carver Gaten and Jim Gochenaur.  Regis Kennedy also knew
        why the FBI was searching for Clay Shaw under his alias
        Clay Bertrand in New Orleans, *before* Dean Andrews received
        that phone call from him about defending Oswald.  Kennedy
        may also have been one of the three agents who took the
        Babushka lady's film away from her.  At least she told me
        he was one of them from his photo.

        So Regis Kennedy had to die.  So do Warren du Brueys and
        James Hosty.  If they die of "natural causes" in the next
        month or two, don't say I didn't warn you.

        Nagell and Novel are in even greater danger.  Nagell may
        now be safe.  He fled the country recently.  However, the
        CIA has tentacles everywhere, so he will not really be safe
        wherever he is.  Novel could easily be killed, since he is
        in prison.  That is one of the easiest places for the death
        squad to catch up with him.

        As I have had told you in previous letters, the reason you
        *must* call Novel is that there is a very strong possibility
        that he is the umbrella man.  If you laugh at that and try
        to tell me that you found the umbrella man, Mr. Witt, I'll
        laugh right back at you and tell you that farce you put on
        for the American public didn't fool anyone with his eyes
        even half way open.  In addition to the obviously planned
        sequence of events and the way in which Mr. Witt surfaced,
        his umbrella was certainly not the one used in Dealey Plaza.
        It was the wrong size, had the wrong number of ribs, and was
        missing the two round white bulbs on either end when folded
        up.

        No, Louis, Mr. Witt was either planted upon you or else
        your staff planted him.  I'll give you the benefit of the
        doubt for the moment and assume that you do not know he
        was a plant.  If you let it go as is, you and Mr. Preyer
        and the rest of the committee are going to look pretty
        silly.

        You absolutely must call as witnesses, Gorden Novel, and
        at the other end, Charles Sensenay and the CIA people asso-
        ciated with Fort Detrick, Maryland, where that umbrella
        launching system was made.  Incidentally, two Bulgarian
        intelligence agents have recently been assassinated in
        England with an umbrella weapon using poison flechettes,
        very similar to the one used on JFK.

        I would appreciate a response to this letter telling me
        what you plan to do about those witnesses.


                                          Best regards,



                                          Dick Sprague







                                Exhibit J
     ____________________________________________________________



               LOUIS STOKES, OHIO, CHAIRMAN

RICHARDSON PREYER, N.C.           SAMUEL L. DEVINE, OHIO
WALTER E. FAUNTROY, D.C.          STEWART B. MCKINNEY, CONN.
YVONNE BRATHWAITE BURKE, CALIF.   CHARLES THONE, NEBR.
CHRISTOPHER J. DODD, CONN.        HAROLD S. SAWYER, MICH.
HAROLD E. FORD, TENN.
FLOYD J. FITHIAN, IND.
ROBERT W. EDGAR, PA.
                       ------------
                      (202) 225-4624


                                   Select Committee on Assassinations
                                      U.S House of Representatives
                                   3331 HOUSE OFFICE BUILDING, ANNEX 2
                                        WASHINGTON, D.C.  20515


                                           December 4, 1978





            Mr. Dick Sprague
            193 Pinewood Rqad
            Hartsdale, New York  10530

            Dear Mr. Sprague:

                 Thank you for your letter of November 24, 1978.

                 I am aware of the amount of time you have spent
            analyzing the assassination of President John F. Kennedy
            and your interest in the work of the Select Committee on
            Assassinations since its inception.

                 However, I regret that under our Rules, it is
            impossible for us to respond to your letter in a manner
            which would reveal the substance or procedure of our
            investigation, or the names of those persons who will be
            called to testify before the committee.

                 The committee is, of course, grateful for your
            suggestions and those of the many other concerned citizens
            who have taken the time to write.

                                         Sincerely,

                                       [Louis Stokes]

                                         LOUIS STOKES
                                         Chairman



            LS:jl






                                Exhibit K
     ____________________________________________________________



               LOUIS STOKES, OHIO, CHAIRMAN

RICHARDSON PREYER, N.C.           SAMUEL L. DEVINE, OHIO
WALTER E. FAUNTROY, D.C.          STEWART B. MCKINNEY, CONN.
YVONNE BRATHWAITE BURKE, CALIF.   CHARLES THONE, NEBR.
CHRISTOPHER J. DODD, CONN.        HAROLD S. SAWYER, MICH.
HAROLD E. FORD, TENN.
FLOYD J. FITHIAN, IND.
ROBERT W. EDGAR, PA.
                       ------------
                      (202) 225-4624


                                   Select Committee on Assassinations
                                      U.S House of Representatives
                                   3331 HOUSE OFFICE BUILDING, ANNEX 2
                                        WASHINGTON, D.C.  20515


                                               JAN 16 1978





           Richard E. Sprague, Esq.
           193 Pinewood Road
           Hartsdale, New York 10530

           Dear Mr. Sprague:

                     In response to your letter of January 9,
           1978, I have reviewed your proposed article "The
           CIA Weapon System Used in the Assassination of
           President Kennedy."  It is my opinion that the article
           is derived from your own sources of information, and
           contains no information that has come into your
           possession by virtue of your consulting work with the
           Committee.  Accordingly, your proposed publication of
           the article does not violate the terms of your non-
           disclosure agreement.  As I am sure you can appreciate,
           further comment by myself upon the article or its
           proposed publication would be inappropriate, and
           consequently I decline to express any review or
           comment upon it.

                     Thank you for your continuing cooperation
           with the Select Committee.

                                       Sincerely,

                                   [G. Robert Blakey]

                                   G. Robert Blakey

           GRB:jwc






                                Exhibit L
     ____________________________________________________________






                                                      193 Pinewood Road
                                                      Hartsdale, NY  10530

                                                      August 3, 1978


         Mr. Robert Blakey
         Select Committee on Assassinations
         U.S. House of Representatives
         Washington, D.C.  20515

         Dear Bob:

         Following our telephone conversation on Tuesday August 1,
         I checked with Bob Cutler, my co-author on the Umbrella
         Weapon System article in Gallery June 1978.  Bob told me
         he left with Mr. Preyer and with you, photographic material
         showing that The Umbrella Man (TUM) was quite probably
         J. Gordon Novel.

         Your news photo of him reinforces that belief for both of
         us.  I did not have that portion of the Couch film from
         WFAA and so had never seen TUM's face as clearly as it
         appears there.  The Bothun photo of him has a light
         reflection around his nose, as I'm sure you know.

         We have a 1962-3 photo of Novel taken from the same angle
         as the Couch, film of TUM and a photo comparison convinces
         us more than ever that Novel is TUM.  Mr. Preyer no doubt
         told you back in April that Novel is in a jail in Georgia,
         framed for a crime he and Jim Garrison, his former lawyer,
         both claim he didn't commit.


                                        Best regards,



                                        Dick Sprague

         DS/mc

         P.S.  I am still waiting for a response to my letters to
               Louis Stokes about attending the hearings beginning
               August 14.

         cc:   L. Stokes
               R. Cutler



--

  I see in the near future a crisis approaching that unnerves me and causes
  me to tremble for the safety of my country. . . .  Corporations have been
  enthroned, an era of corruption in high places will follow, and the
  money-power of the country will endeavor to prolong its reign by working
  upon the prejudices of the people until the wealth is aggregated in a few
  hands and the Republic is destroyed.

             --- Abraham Lincoln (quoted in Jack London's "The Iron Heel").